MC68HC08SR12MFA [MOTOROLA]
8-BIT, MROM, 8MHz, MICROCONTROLLER, PQFP48, PLASTIC, LQFP-48;![MC68HC08SR12MFA](http://pdffile.icpdf.com/pdf2/p00303/img/icpdf/MC68HC08SR12_1831303_icpdf.jpg)
型号: | MC68HC08SR12MFA |
厂家: | ![]() |
描述: | 8-BIT, MROM, 8MHz, MICROCONTROLLER, PQFP48, PLASTIC, LQFP-48 时钟 微控制器 外围集成电路 |
文件: | 总415页 (文件大小:4763K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
![](http://public.icpdf.com/style/img/ads.jpg)
MC68HC908SR12
MC68HC08SR12
Technical Data
M68HC08
Microcontrollers
MC68HC908SR12/D
Rev. 4, 2/2002
WWW.MOTOROLA.COM/SEMICONDUCTORS
MC68HC908SR12
MC68HC08SR12
Technical Data
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products
herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically
disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental
damages. “Typical” parameters which may be provided in Motorola data sheets and/or
specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may
vary over time. All operating parameters, including “Typicals” must be validated for
each customer application by customer's technical experts. Motorola does not convey
any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not
designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for
surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life,
or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a
situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use
Motorola products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall
indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and
distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and
reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal
injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim
alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
Motorola and the Stylized M logo are registered in the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office.
digital dna is a trademark of Motorola, Inc.
© Motorola, Inc., 2002
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
3
Technical Data
Te c hnic a l Da ta
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our
documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed
copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information
available, refer to:
http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in
this document. For your convenience, the page number designators
have been linked to the appropriate location.
Revision History
Revision
Level
Page
Date
Description
Number(s)
PTB0/SDA0, PTB1/SCL0, PTB2/SDA1/TxD, and
PTB3/SCL1/RxD pins — clarified these open-drain pins
323, 254, 293
throughout this document.
8.4.6 Programming the PLL — deleted redundant step in
programming the PLL.
120
167
169
181
Figure 10-1 . Monitor Mode Circuit — corrected connections
for PTA1 and PTA2.
Table 10-1 . Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options
— clarified clock input requirements for monitor mode entry.
Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM) — timer
discrepancies corrected throughout this section.
February,
2002
4
18.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) and 18.5.2 Data Direction
Register C (DDRC) — added notes for PTC6 and PTC7 on
42-pin package.
327, 329
338, 339
374, 376
Figure 19-3 . IRQ2 Block Diagram and 19.5 IRQ1 and IRQ2
Pins — corrected IRQ2 for BIH and BIL instructions.
Table 24-4 . 5V DC Electrical Characteristics and Table 24-5 .
3V DC Electrical Characteristics — added additional IDD
measurements.
Table 24-13 . Current Detection Electrical Characteristics —
updated trip point values.
382
393
Appendix A. MC68HC08SR12 — added appendix for ROM part:
MC68HC08SR12.
Technical Data
4
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
List of Se c tions
Section 1. General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Section 2. Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . .61
Section 4. FLASH Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Section 5. Configuration and Mask Option Registers
(CONFIG & MOR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM). . . . . . . . . .111
Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . .141
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM) . . . . . . . . . . .181
Section 12. Timebase Module (TBM). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) . . . . . . . . . .211
Section 14. Analog Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) . . . . . .231
Section 16. Serial Communications Interface (SCI). . .251
Section 17. Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC) . . . . . . .291
Section 18. Input/Output (I/O) Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
Section 19. External Interrupt (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
5
List of Sections
List of Se c tions
Section 20. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI). . . . . . . .343
Section 21. Computer Operating Properly (COP) . . . .351
Section 22. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
Section 23. Break Module (BRK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Section 24. Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
Section 25. Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
Section 26. Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
Appendix A. MC68HC08SR12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Technical Data
6
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Sections
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Ta b le of Conte nts
Section 1. General Description
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Pin Assignments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
1.6
Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
External Reset Pin (RST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Analog Power Supply Pin (VDDA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
ADC Voltage Low Reference Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
ADC Voltage High Reference Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
1.6.1
1.6.2
1.6.3
1.6.4
1.6.5
1.6.6
1.6.7
1.6.8
1.6.9
1.6.10 Analog Input Pins (OPIN1/ATD0, OPIN2/ATD1, VSSAM) . . .44
1.6.11 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0). . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.12 Port B I/O Pins (PTB6–PTB0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.13 Port C I/O Pins (PTC7–PTC0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.14 Port D I/O Pins (PTD7/KBI7–PTD0/KBI0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Section 2. Memory Map
2.1
2.2
2.3
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
7
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Ta b le of Conte nts
2.4
2.5
Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Input/Output (I/O) Section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM)
3.1
3.2
3.3
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Section 4. FLASH Memory
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
FLASH Program Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
4.8
4.8.1
FLASH Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Section 5. Configuration and Mask Option Registers
(CONFIG & MOR)
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Mask Option Register (MOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Technical Data
8
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.1
6.2
6.3
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
6.4
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
6.4.4
6.4.5
6.5
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
6.6
6.6.1
6.6.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
6.7
6.8
6.9
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Section 7. Oscillator (OSC)
7.1
7.2
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
7.3
7.3.1
7.3.2
Clock Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
CGM Reference Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
TBM Reference Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
7.4
7.5
7.6
Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
RC Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
X-tal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
7.7
7.7.1
7.7.2
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
9
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Ta b le of Conte nts
7.7.3
7.7.4
7.7.5
7.7.6
Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
CGM Oscillator Clock (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Oscillator Clock to Time Base Module (OSCCLK) . . . . . . .109
7.8
7.8.1
7.8.2
Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
7.9
Oscillator During Break Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.1
8.2
8.3
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
8.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Oscillator Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. . . . . . . . . .118
Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
8.4.1
8.4.2
8.4.3
8.4.4
8.4.5
8.4.6
8.4.7
8.4.8
8.4.9
8.5
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
PLL Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Oscillator Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . .126
CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
CGM VCO Clock Output (CGMVCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.5.3
8.5.4
8.5.5
8.5.6
8.5.7
8.5.8
8.6
8.6.1
CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
Technical Data
10
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
8.6.2
8.6.3
8.6.4
8.6.5
PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
PLL Multiplier Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
PLL VCO Range Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
PLL Reference Divider Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
8.7
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
8.8
Special Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
CGM During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
8.8.1
8.8.2
8.8.3
8.9
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Choosing a Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
8.9.1
8.9.2
8.9.3
Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM)
9.1
9.2
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
9.3
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Clock Start-up from POR or LVI Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
9.3.1
9.3.2
9.3.3
9.4
9.4.1
9.4.2
9.4.2.1
9.4.2.2
9.4.2.3
9.4.2.4
9.4.2.5
9.4.2.6
Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . .149
Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
9.5
SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
9.5.1
9.5.2
9.5.3
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
11
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Ta b le of Conte nts
9.6
9.6.1
Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
SWI Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Interrupt Status Register 3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
9.6.1.1
9.6.1.2
9.6.1.3
9.6.1.4
9.6.1.5
9.6.1.6
9.6.2
9.6.3
9.6.4
9.7
9.7.1
9.7.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
9.8
SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.8.1
9.8.2
9.8.3
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON)
10.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
10.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
10.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.4.3 Break Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.4.4 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.4.5 Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.5 Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Technical Data
12
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM)
11.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
11.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
11.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
11.4 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
11.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
11.5.1 TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
11.5.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
11.5.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
11.5.3.1
11.5.3.2
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
11.5.4.1
11.5.4.2
11.5.4.3
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
11.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
11.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
11.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.8 TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
11.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
11.10.2 TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
11.10.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . .200
11.10.5 TIM Channel Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Section 12. Timebase Module (TBM)
12.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
12.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Table of Contents
Technical Data
13
Ta b le of Conte nts
12.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
12.5 Timebase Register Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
12.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
12.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
12.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
12.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
13.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
13.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
13.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
13.4 PWM Period and Resolution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
13.5 PWM Automatic Phase Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
13.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.7 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.8 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10.1 PWM Control Register (PWMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10.2 PWM Clock Control Register (PWMCCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
13.10.3 PWM Data Registers (PWMDR0–PWMDR2) . . . . . . . . . .219
13.10.4 PWM Phase Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Section 14. Analog Module
14.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
14.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
14.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Technical Data
14
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
14.4.1 On-Chip Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
14.4.2 Two-Stage Amplifier. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
14.4.3 Amplifier Response Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
14.4.4 Current Flow Detection Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.4.5 Current Flow Detect Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.7 Analog Module I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14.7.1 Analog Module Control Register (AMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14.7.2 Analog Module Gain Control Register (AMGCR). . . . . . . .227
14.7.3 Analog Module Status and Control Register (AMSCR) . . .228
Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
15.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
15.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
15.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
15.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
15.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
15.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
15.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
15.4.5 Auto-scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
15.4.6 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
15.4.7 Data Register Interlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.4.8 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.1 ADC Voltage In (VADIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Table of Contents
Technical Data
15
Ta b le of Conte nts
15.7.2 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.3 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.7.5 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
15.8.2 ADC Clock Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
15.8.3 ADC Data Register 0 (ADRH0 and ADRL0). . . . . . . . . . . .246
15.8.4 ADC Auto-Scan Mode Data Registers (ADRL1–ADRL3). .248
15.8.5 ADC Auto-Scan Control Register (ADASCR). . . . . . . . . . .248
Section 16. Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
16.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
16.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
16.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
16.4 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
16.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
16.5.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
16.5.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
16.5.2.1
16.5.2.2
16.5.2.3
16.5.2.4
16.5.2.5
16.5.2.6
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Character Transmission. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Inversion of Transmitted Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
16.5.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
16.5.3.1
16.5.3.2
16.5.3.3
16.5.3.4
16.5.3.5
16.5.3.6
16.5.3.7
16.5.3.8
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Baud Rate Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Error Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Technical Data
16
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
16.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.7 SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.8 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.8.1 TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.8.2 RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
16.9.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
16.9.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
16.9.5 SCI Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
16.9.6 SCI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
16.9.7 SCI Baud Rate Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
Section 17. Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
17.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
17.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
17.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
17.4 I/O Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
17.5 Multi-Master IIC System Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
17.6 Multi-Master IIC Bus Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
17.6.1 START Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.2 Slave Address Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.3 Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.4 Repeated START Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.5 STOP Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.6 Arbitration Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.7 Clock Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
17.6.8 Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
17.6.9 Packet Error Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17.7 MMIIC I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Table of Contents
Technical Data
17
Ta b le of Conte nts
17.7.1 MMIIC Address Register (MMADR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17.7.2 MMIIC Control Register 1 (MMCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
17.7.3 MMIIC Control Register 2 (MMCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
17.7.4 MMIIC Status Register (MMSR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
17.7.5 MMIIC Data Transmit Register (MMDTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
17.7.6 MMIIC Data Receive Register (MMDRR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
17.7.7 MMIIC CRC Data Register (MMCRCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
17.7.8 MMIIC Frequency Divider Register (MMFDR) . . . . . . . . . .310
17.8 Program Algorithm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
17.8.1 Data Sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
17.9 SMBus Protocols with PEC and without PEC. . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.1 Quick Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.2 Send Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.3 Receive Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.4 Write Byte/Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17.9.5 Read Byte/Word. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17.9.6 Process Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17.9.7 Block Read/Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17.10 SMBus Protocol Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Section 18. Input/Output (I/O) Ports
18.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
18.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
18.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
18.3.1 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
18.3.2 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
18.3.3 Port A LED Control Register (LEDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
18.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
18.4.1 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
18.4.2 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
18.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
18.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
18.5.2 Data Direction Register C (DDRC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
18.5.3 Port C LED Control Register (LEDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Technical Data
18
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
18.6 Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
18.6.1 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
18.6.2 Data Direction Register D (DDRD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
Section 19. External Interrupt (IRQ)
19.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
19.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
19.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
19.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
19.5 IRQ1 and IRQ2 Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
19.6 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
19.7 IRQ Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
19.7.1 IRQ1 Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
19.7.2 IRQ2 Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
Section 20. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
20.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .343
20.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .343
20.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
20.4 I/O Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
20.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
20.5.1 Keyboard Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
20.6 Keyboard Interrupt Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
20.6.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
20.6.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.8 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.9 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.10 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Table of Contents
Technical Data
19
Ta b le of Conte nts
Section 21. Computer Operating Properly (COP)
21.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
21.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
21.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
21.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.1 ICLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.2 STOP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.3 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.4 Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.5 Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.6 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.7 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.8 COPRS (COP Rate Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.5 COP Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.7 Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
21.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
21.9 COP Module During Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
Section 22. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
22.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
22.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
22.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
22.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358
22.4.1 Polled LVI Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .359
22.4.2 Forced Reset Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.4.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.4.4 LVI Trip Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.5 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
Technical Data
20
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
22.6 LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
22.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
22.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
22.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
Section 23. Break Module (BRK)
23.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
23.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
23.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
23.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
23.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6.1 Break Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23.6.3 SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23.6.4 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
Section 24. Electrical Specifications
24.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
24.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
24.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
24.4 Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24.5 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
24.7 3.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Table of Contents
Technical Data
21
Ta b le of Conte nts
24.8 5.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24.9 3.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24.10 5.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
24.11 3.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
24.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
24.13 3.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
24.14 Analog Module Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.1 Temperature Sensor Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.2 Current Detection Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.3 Two-Stage Amplifier Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . .382
24.15 Timer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
24.16 MMIIC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
24.17 CGM Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
24.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
Section 25. Mechanical Specifications
25.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
25.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
25.3 48-Pin Plastic Low Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
25.4 42-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP). . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Section 26. Ordering Information
26.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
26.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
26.3 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
Technical Data
22
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Appendix A. MC68HC08SR12
A.1
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
A.7
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Mask Option Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Reserved Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
A.8
A.8.1
Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
A.9
ROM Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
23
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Ta b le of Conte nts
Technical Data
24
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
List of Fig ure s
Figure
Title
Page
1-1
1-2
1-3
1-4
MC68HC908SR12 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
48-Pin LQFP Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
42-Pin SDIP Pin Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Power Supply Bypassing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
2-1
2-2
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Control, Status, and Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
4-5
FLASH I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
FLASH Control Register (FLCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
FLASH Programming Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
FLASH Block Protect Start Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
5-1
5-2
5-3
5-4
CONFIG and MOR Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Mask Option Register (MOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
6-1
6-2
6-3
6-4
6-5
6-6
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Accumulator (A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Index Register (H:X) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Stack Pointer (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Program Counter (PC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Condition Code Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
7-1
7-2
7-3
7-4
Oscillator Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Mask Option Register (MOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
25
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
List of Fig ure s
Figure
Title
Page
7-5
7-6
RC Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Crystal Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
8-1
8-2
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
8-7
8-8
8-9
CGM Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
CGM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
PLL Control Register (PCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
PLL Multiplier Select Register High (PMSH) . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
PLL Multiplier Select Register Low (PMSL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
PLL VCO Range Select Register (PMRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
PLL Reference Divider Select Register (PMDS) . . . . . . . . . .134
8-10 PLL Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
9-1
9-2
9-3
9-4
9-5
9-6
9-7
9-8
9-9
SIM Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
SIM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
CGM Clock Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
External Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Internal Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Sources of Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
POR Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Interrupt Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Interrupt Recovery Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
9-10 Interrupt Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
9-11 Interrupt Recognition Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
9-12 Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
9-13 Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
9-14 Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
9-15 Wait Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
9-16 Wait Recovery from Interrupt or Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
9-17 Wait Recovery from Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
9-18 Stop Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
9-19 Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt or Break. . . . . . . . . . . . .161
9-20 SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
9-21 SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
9-22 SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Technical Data
26
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
Figure
Title
Page
10-1 Monitor Mode Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
10-2 Low-Voltage Monitor Mode Entry Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
10-3 Monitor Data Format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10-4 Break Transaction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10-5 Read Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
10-6 Write Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
10-7 Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
10-8 Monitor Mode Entry Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
11-1 TIM Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
11-2 TIM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
11-3 PWM Period and Pulse Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
11-4 TIM Status and Control Register (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
11-5 TIM Counter Registers High (TCNTH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
11-6 TIM Counter Registers Low (TCNTL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
11-7 TIM Counter Modulo Register High (TMODH) . . . . . . . . . . . .199
11-8 TIM Counter Modulo Register Low (TMODL). . . . . . . . . . . . .199
11-9 TIM Channel 0 Status and Control Register (TSC0) . . . . . . .200
11-10 TIM Channel 1 Status and Control Register (TSC1) . . . . . . .200
11-11 CHxMAX Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
11-12 TIM Channel 0 Register High (TCH0H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
11-13 TIM Channel 0 Register Low (TCH0L) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
11-14 TIM Channel 1 Register High (TCH1H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
11-15 TIM Channel 1 Register Low (TCH1L) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
12-1 Timebase Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
12-2 Timebase Control Register (TBCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
13-1 PWM I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
13-2 PWM Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
13-3 PWM Output Waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
13-4 PWM Automatic Phase Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
13-5 PWM Control Register (PWMCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13-6 PWM Clock Control Register (PWMCCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
13-7 PWM Data Register 0 (PWMDR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
13-8 PWM Data Register 1 (PWMDR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
27
List of Figures
List of Fig ure s
Figure
Title
Page
13-9 PWM Data Register 2 (PWMDR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
13-10 PWM Phase Control Register (PWMPCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
14-1 Analog Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
14-2 Analog Module I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
14-3 Analog Module Control Register (AMCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14-4 Analog Module Gain Control Register (AMGCR) . . . . . . . . . .227
14-5 Analog Module Status and Control Register (AMSCR) . . . . .229
15-1 ADC I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
15-2 ADC Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
15-3 ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
15-4 ADC Clock Control Register (ADICLK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
15-5 ADRH0 and ADRL0 in 8-Bit Truncated Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . .246
15-6 ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Right Justified Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
15-7 ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left Justified Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
15-8 ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left Justified Sign Data Mode . . . . . .247
15-9 ADC Data Register Low 1 to 3 (ADRL1–ADRL3). . . . . . . . . .248
15-10 ADC Scan Control Register (ADASCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
16-1 SCI Module Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
16-2 SCI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
16-3 SCI Data Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
16-4 SCI Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
16-5 SCI Receiver Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
16-6 Receiver Data Sampling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
16-7 Slow Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
16-8 Fast Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
16-9 SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
16-10 SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
16-11 SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
16-12 SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
16-13 Flag Clearing Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
16-14 SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
16-15 SCI Data Register (SCDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
16-16 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
Technical Data
28
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
Figure
Title
Page
17-1 MMIIC I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
17-2 Multi-Master IIC Bus Transmission Signal Diagram . . . . . . . .295
17-3 Clock Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
17-4 MMIIC Address Register (MMADR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17-5 MMIIC Control Register 1 (MMCR1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
17-6 MMIIC Control Register 2 (MMCR2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
17-7 MMIIC Status Register (MMSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
17-8 MMIIC Data Transmit Register (MMDTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
17-9 MMIIC Data Receive Register (MMDRR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
17-10 MMIIC CRC Data Register (MMCRCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
17-11 MMIIC Frequency Divider Register (MMFDR) . . . . . . . . . . . .310
17-12 Data Transfer Sequences for Master/Slave
Transmit/Receive Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
17-13 Quick Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17-14 Send Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17-15 Receive Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17-16 Write Byte/Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17-17 Read Byte/Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17-18 Process Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17-19 Block Read/Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17-20 SMBus Protocol Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
18-1 I/O Port Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
18-2 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
18-3 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
18-4 Port A I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
18-5 Port A LED Control Register (LEDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
18-6 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
18-7 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
18-8 Port B I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326
18-9 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
18-10 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
18-11 Port C I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
18-12 Port A LED Control Register (LEDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
18-13 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
18-14 Data Direction Register D (DDRD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
18-15 Port D I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
29
List of Figures
List of Fig ure s
Figure
Title
Page
19-1 External Interrupt I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
19-2 IRQ1 Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
19-3 IRQ2 Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
19-4 IRQ1 Status and Control Register (INTSCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . .340
19-5 IRQ2 Status and Control Register (INTSCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . .341
20-1 KBI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
20-2 Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
20-3 Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR) . . . . . . . . . .348
20-4 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER) . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
21-1 COP Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
21-2 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21-3 COP Control Register (COPCTL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
22-1 LVI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358
22-2 LVI Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358
22-3 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
23-1 Break Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
23-2 Break Module I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
23-3 Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR). . . . . . . . . . . .367
23-4 Break Address Register High (BRKH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23-5 Break Address Register Low (BRKL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23-6 SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
23-7 SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
24-1 RC vs. Bus Frequency (5V @25°C). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
24-2 RC vs. Bus Frequency (3V @25°C). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
24-3 MMIIC Signal Timings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
25-1 48-Pin Plastic Low Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
25-2 42-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP). . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
A-1 MC68HC08SR12 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
A-2 MC68HC08SR12 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Technical Data
30
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
List of Ta b le s
Table
Title
Page
2-1
Vector Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
CGMXCLK Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
5-1
6-1
6-2
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
7-1
7-2
CGMXCLK Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Timebase Module Reference Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . .105
8-1
8-3
8-2
Numeric Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
VPR1 and VPR0 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
PRE1 and PRE0 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
9-1
9-2
9-3
Signal Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
PIN Bit Set Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
10-1 Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options. . . . . . . . . .169
10-2 Mode Differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10-3 Monitor Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10-4 READ (Read Memory) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
10-5 WRITE (Write Memory) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
10-7 IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
10-6 IREAD (Indexed Read) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
10-8 READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
10-9 RUN (Run User Program) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
11-1 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
11-2 Prescaler Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
31
List of Tables
List of Ta b le s
Table
Title
Page
11-3 Mode, Edge, and Level Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
12-1 Timebase Rate Selection for OSCCLK = 32.768 kHz . . . . . .207
13-1 PTC0 Pin Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
13-2 PWM Counter Clock Prescaler Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
14-1 Analog Module Power Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14-2 Amplifier Channel Select Control bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
14-3 Analog Module Gain Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
14-4 Analog Module Clock Divider Select. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
15-1 MUX Channel Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
15-2 ADC Clock Divide Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
15-3 ADC Mode Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
15-4 Auto-scan Mode Channel Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
16-1 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
16-2 Start Bit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
16-3 Data Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
16-4 Stop Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
16-5 Character Format Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
16-6 SCI Baud Rate Prescaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
16-7 SCI Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
16-8 SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
17-1 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
17-2 MMIIC Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
18-1 Port Control Register Bits Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
18-2 Port A Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
18-3 PTB2 and PTB3 Pin Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
18-4 Port B Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326
18-5 PTC0 Pin Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
18-6 Port C Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
18-7 Port D Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Technical Data
32
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Tables
MOTOROLA
List of Tables
Table
Title
Page
20-1 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
22-1 LVIOUT Bit Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
24-1 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
24-2 Operating Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24-3 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24-4 5V DC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
24-5 3V DC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
24-6 5V Control Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24-7 3V Control Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24-8 5V Oscillator Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
24-9 3V Oscillator Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
24-10 5V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
24-11 3V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
24-12 Temperature Sensor Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . .382
24-13 Current Detection Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
24-14 Two-Stage Amplifier Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . .382
24-15 MMIIC DC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
24-16 MMIIC Interface Input/Output Signal Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
24-17 FLASH Memory Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
26-1 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
A-1 Summary of MC68HC08SR12 and
MC68HC908SR12 Differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
A-2 MC68HC08SR12 Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
33
List of Tables
List of Ta b le s
Technical Data
34
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
List of Tables
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 1. Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
1.1 Conte nts
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Pin Assignments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
1.6
Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
External Reset Pin (RST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Analog Power Supply Pin (VDDA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
ADC Voltage Low Reference Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
ADC Voltage High Reference Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
1.6.1
1.6.2
1.6.3
1.6.4
1.6.5
1.6.6
1.6.7
1.6.8
1.6.9
1.6.10 Analog Input Pins (OPIN1/ATD0, OPIN2/ATD1, VSSAM) . . .44
1.6.11 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0). . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.12 Port B I/O Pins (PTB6–PTB0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.13 Port C I/O Pins (PTC7–PTC0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
1.6.14 Port D I/O Pins (PTD7/KBI7–PTD0/KBI0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA General Description
Technical Data
35
Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
1.2 Introd uc tion
The MC68HC908SR12 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance
M68HC08 Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). The M68HC08
Family is based on the customer-specified integrated circuit (CSIC)
design strategy. All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08
central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with a variety of
modules, memory sizes and types, and package types.
1.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the MC68HC908SR12 include the following:
•
•
High-performance M68HC08 architecture
Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and
M68HC05 Families
•
Maximum internal bus frequency:
– 8-MHz at 5V operating voltage
– 4-MHz at 3V operating voltage
Clock input options:
•
– RC-oscillator
– 32kHz crystal-oscillator with 32MHz internal phase-lock-loop
12k-bytes user program FLASH memory with security1 feature
512 bytes of on-chip RAM
•
•
•
Two 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
with selectable input capture, output compare, and PWM
capability on each channel
•
•
Timebase module
3-channel, 8-bit high speed PWM (125kHz) with independent
counters and automatic phase control
•
Serial communications interface module (SCI)
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Technical Data
36
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
Features
•
•
System Management Bus (SMBus), version 1.0/1.1
(Multi-master IIC bus)
14-channel, 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC), with
auto-scan mode for 4 channels
•
•
•
•
•
•
Current sensor with programmable amplifier
Temperature sensor (–20°C to +70°C)
IRQ1 external interrupt pin with integrated pullup
IRQ2 external interrupt pin with programmable pullup
8-bit keyboard wakeup port with integrated pullup
31 general-purpose input/output (I/O) pins and 2 dedicated pins:
– 31 shared-function I/O pins
– Two dedicated analog input pins
•
•
•
Low-power design (fully static with Stop and Wait modes)
Master reset pin (with integrated pullup) and power-on reset
System protection features
– Optional computer operating properly (COP) reset
– Low-voltage detection with optional reset
– Illegal opcode detection with reset
– Illegal address detection with reset
•
•
48-pin low quad flat pack (LQFP) and 42-pin shrink dual-in-line
package (SDIP)
Specific features of the MC68HC908SR12 in 42-pin SDIP are:
– 29 general-purpose l/Os only
– 11-channel ADC only
Features of the CPU08 include the following:
•
•
•
Enhanced HC05 programming model
Extensive loop control functions
16 addressing modes (eight more than the HC05)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA General Description
Technical Data
37
Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
16-bit Index register and stack pointer
Memory-to-memory data transfers
Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction
Fast 16/8 divide instruction
Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions
Optimization for controller applications
Efficient C language support
1.4 MCU Bloc k Dia g ra m
Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908SR12.
Technical Data
38
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
General Description MOTOROLA
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
PTA7/T1CH1
PTA6/T1CH0
CPU
REGISTERS
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE 1
‡
PTA5/ATD7 – PTA0/ATD2
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 96 BYTES
USER FLASH — 12,288 BYTES
2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE 2
PTB6/IRQ2
TIMEBASE
MODULE
PTB5/T2CH1
PTB4/T2CH0
USER RAM — 512 BYTES
†
PTB3//SCL1/RxD
MONITOR ROM — 368 BYTES
†
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS
INTERFACE MODULE
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
†
PTB1/SCL0
†
USER FLASH VECTORS — 38 BYTES
PTB0/SDA0
MULTI-MASTER IIC (SMBUS)
INTERFACE MODULE
OSCILLATORS AND
CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE
‡ #
PTC7/ATD12
‡ #
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
PTC6/ATD11
‡
PULSE WIDTH MODULATOR
MODULE
PTC5/ATD10
RC OSCILLATOR
‡
PTC4/ATD9
OSC1
‡
PTC3/ATD8
X-TAL OSCILLATOR
OSC2
PTC2/PWM2
8-BIT KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT MODULE
PHASE-LOCKED LOOP
PTC1/PWM1
CGMXFC
* RST
PTC0/PWM0/CD
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
PTD7/KBI7 – PTD0/KBI0 ***
* IRQ1
EXTERNAL IRQ
MODULE
LOW-VOLTAGE
INHIBIT MODULE
** IRQ2
OPIN1/ATD0
OPIN2/ATD1
ANALOG
MODULE
#
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
V
SSAM
V
REFH
10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER MODULE
* Pin contains integrated pullup device.
** Pin contains configurable pullup device.
*** Pin contains integrated pullup device for KBI functions.
† Pin is open-drain when configured as output.
‡ High current drive pin (for LED).
V
REFL
V
DD
V
SS
POWER
V
DDA
V
# Pin not bonded on 42-pin SDIP.
SSA
Figure 1-1. MC68HC908SR12 Block Diagram
Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
1.5 Pin Assig nm e nts
1
36
VREFH
PTC3/ATD8
NC
2
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
VREFL
3
PTD0/KBI0
VDD
OPIN2/ATD1
PTC7/ATD12
PTA0/ATD2
VSSAM
4
5
OSC1
6
OSC2
OPIN1/ATD0
7
VSS
8
PTB4/T2CH0
PTB5/T2CH1
PTB6/IRQ2
PTD1/KBI1
IRQ1
9
10
11
PTD2/KBI2
RST
PTA6/T1CH0
25 PTD7/KBI7
PTD3/KBI3 12
NC: No connection
Figure 1-2. 48-Pin LQFP Pin Assignments
Technical Data
40
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
General Description MOTOROLA
General Description
Pin Functions
VDDA
1
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
VSSA
PTC5/ATD10
2
PTA4/ATD6
PTA3/ATD5
PTA2/ATD4
PTA1/ATD3
VREFH
3
PTC4/ATD9
PTA5/ATD7
4
5
CGMXFC
PTC3/ATD8
PTD0/KBI0
VDD
6
7
VREFL
8
PTA0/ATD2
VSSAM
OSC1
9
OSC2
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
OPIN1/ATD0
PTB4/T2CH0
PTB5/T2CH1
PTB6/IRQ2
PTA6/T1CH0
PTD7/KBI7
PTA7/T1CH1
PTC2/PWM2
PTC1/PWM1
PTC0/PWM0/CD
PTD6/KBI6
PTD5/KBI5
VSS
PTD1/KBI1
IRQ1
PTD2/KBI2
RST
PTD3/KBI3
PTB0/SDA0
PTB1/SCL0
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
PTB3/SCL1/RxD
PTD4/KBI4
Pins not available on 42-pin package
OPIN2/ATD1
Internal connection
Unconnected
PTC6/ATD11
Unconnected
PTC7/ATD12
Unconnected
Figure 1-3. 42-Pin SDIP Pin Assignment
1.6 Pin Func tions
Description of pin functions are provided here.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA General Description
Technical Data
41
Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
1.6.1 Powe r Sup p ly Pins (VDD a nd VSS)
V
DD and VSS are the power supply and ground pins. The MCU operates
from a single power supply.
Fast signal transitions on MCU pins place high, short-duration current
demands on the power supply. To prevent noise problems, take special
care to provide power supply bypassing at the MCU as Figure 1-4
shows. Place the C1 bypass capacitor as close to the MCU as possible.
Use a high-frequency-response ceramic capacitor for C1. C2 is an
optional bulk current bypass capacitor for use in applications that require
the port pins to source high current levels.
MCU
V
V
SS
DD
C1
0.1 µF
+
C2
V
DD
NOTE: Component values shown
represent typical applications.
Figure 1-4. Power Supply Bypassing
VSS must be grounded for proper MCU operation.
1.6.2 Osc illa tor Pins (OSC1 a nd OSC2)
The OSC1 and OSC2 pins are the connections for the on-chip oscillator
circuit. See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) and Section 8. Clock
Generator Module (CGM).
Technical Data
42
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
Pin Functions
1.6.3 Exte rna l Re se t Pin (RST)
A logic 0 on the RST pin forces the MCU to a known start-up state. RST
is bidirectional, allowing a reset of the entire system. It is driven low when
any internal reset source is asserted. This pin contains an internal pullup
resistor. See Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM).
1.6.4 Exte rna l Inte rrup t Pin (IRQ1)
IRQ1 is an asynchronous external interrupt pin. This pin contains an
internal pullup resistor. See Section 19. External Interrupt (IRQ).
1.6.5 Ana log Powe r Sup p ly Pin (VDDA
)
VDDA is the power supply pin for the analog circuits of the MCU.
1.6.6 Ana log Ground Pin (VSSA
)
VSSA is the power supply ground pin for the analog circuits of the MCU.
It should be decoupled as per the VSS digital ground pin.
1.6.7 ADC Volta g e Low Re fe re nc e Pin (VREFL
)
VREFL is the voltage input pin for the ADC voltage low reference. See
Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.6.8 ADC Volta g e Hig h Re fe re nc e Pin (VREFH
)
VREFH is the voltage input pin for the ADC voltage high reference. See
Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.6.9 Exte rna l Filte r Ca p a c itor Pin (CGMXFC)
CGMXFC is an external filter capacitor connection for the CGM. See
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA General Description
Technical Data
43
Ge ne ra l De sc rip tion
1.6.10 Ana log Inp ut Pins (OPIN1/ ATD0, OPIN2/ ATD1, VSSAM
)
OPIN1/ATD0 and OPIN2/ATD1 are input pins to the analog module and
ADC and VSSAM is the negative reference input. See Section 14.
Analog Module and Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.6.11 Port A Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Pins (PTA7±PTA0)
PTA7–PTA0 are special function, bidirectional port pins.
PTA7/T1CH1–PTA6/T1CH0 are shared with the TIM1, and
PTA5/ATD7–PTA0/ATD2 are shared with the ADC. See Section 18.
Input/Output (I/O) Ports, Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM),
and Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.6.12 Port B I/ O Pins (PTB6–PTB0)
PTB6–PTB0 are special function, bidirectional port pins. PTB6/IRQ2 is
shared with the IRQ2 input, PTB5/T2CH1–PTB4/T2CH0 are shared with
the TIM2, PTB3/SCL1/RxD–PTB2/SDA1/TxD are shared with the
MMIIC and SCI, and PTB1/SCL0–PTB0/SDA0 are shared with the
MMIIC. See Section 18. Input/Output (I/O) Ports, Section 19.
External Interrupt (IRQ), Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM),
Section 16. Serial Communications Interface (SCI), and Section 17.
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC).
1.6.13 Port C I/ O Pins (PTC7–PTC0)
PTC7–PTC0 are special function, bidirectional port pins.
PTC7/ATD12–PTC3/ATD8 are shared with the ADC,
PTC2/PWM2–PTC1/PWM1 are shared with the PWM, and
PTC0/PWM0/CD is shared with the PWM and analog module. See
Section 18. Input/Output (I/O) Ports, Section 15. Analog-to-Digital
Converter (ADC), Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM), and
Section 14. Analog Module.
1.6.14 Port D I/ O Pins (PTD7/ KBI7–PTD0/ KBI0)
PTD7–PTD0 are general-purpose bidirectional port pins with keyboard
wakeup function. See Section 18. Input/Output (I/O) Ports and
Section 20. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI).
Technical Data
44
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 2. Me m ory Ma p
2.1 Conte nts
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Input/Output (I/O) Section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
2.2 Introd uc tion
The CPU08 can address 64k-bytes of memory space. The memory
map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes:
•
•
•
•
12,288 bytes of user FLASH memory
512 bytes of random-access memory (RAM)
38 bytes of user-defined vectors
368 bytes of monitor ROM
2.3 Unim p le m e nte d Me m ory Loc a tions
Accessing an unimplemented location can cause an illegal address
reset. In the memory map (Figure 2-1) and in register figures in this
document, unimplemented locations are shaded.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
45
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
2.4 Re se rve d Me m ory Loc a tions
Accessing a reserved location can have unpredictable effects on MCU
operation. In the Figure 2-1 and in register figures in this document,
reserved locations are marked with the word Reserved or with the
letter R.
2.5 Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Se c tion
Most of the control, status, and data registers are in the zero page
$0000–$005F. Additional I/O registers have the following addresses:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
$FE00; SIM break status register, SBSR
$FE01; SIM reset status register, SRSR
$FE03; SIM break flag control register, SBFCR
$FE04; Interrupt status register 1, INT1
$FE05; Interrupt status register 2, INT2
$FE06; Interrupt status register 3, INT3
$FE07; Reserved
$FE08; FLASH control register, FLCR
$FE09; FLASH block protect register, FLBPR
$FE0A; Reserved
$FE0B; Reserved
$FE0C; break address register high, BRKH
$FE0D; break address register low, BRKL
$FE0E; break status and control register, BRKSCR
$FE0F; LVI status register, LVISR
$FF80; Mask option register, MOR
$FFFF; COP control register, COPCTL
Data registers are shown in Figure 2-2, Table 2-1 is a list of vector
locations.
Technical Data
46
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
$0000
↓
$005F
I/O Registers
96 Bytes
$0060
↓
$025F
RAM
512 Bytes
$0260
↓
$BFFF
Unimplemented
48,544 Bytes
$C000
↓
$EFFF
FLASH Memory
12,288 Bytes
$F000
↓
$FDFF
Unimplemented
3,584 Bytes
$FE00
$FE01
$FE02
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
$FE07
$FE08
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
$FE0C
$FE0D
$FE0E
$FE0F
SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
Reserved
SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1)
Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2)
Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3)
Reserved
FLASH Control Register (FLCR)
FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR)
Reserved
Reserved
Break Address Register High (BRKH)
Break Address Register Low (BRKL)
Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR)
LVI Status Register (LVISR)
$FE10
↓
$FF7F
Monitor ROM
368 Bytes
$FF80
Mask Option Register
$FF81
↓
$FFD9
Reserved
89 Bytes
$FFDA
↓
$FFFF
FLASH Vectors
38 Bytes
Figure 2-1. Memory Map
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
47
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
PTA6
U
5
PTA5
U
4
PTA4
U
3
PTA3
U
2
PTA2
U
1
PTA1
U
Bit 0
PTA0
U
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
PTA7
Port A Data Register
(PTA)
$0000
U
0
PTB6
U
PTB5
U
PTB4
U
PTB3
U
PTB2
U
PTB1
U
PTB0
U
Port B Data Register
(PTB)
$0001
$0002
$0003
$0004
$0005
$0006
$0007
$0008
$0009
0
PTC7
U
PTC6
U
PTC5
U
PTC4
U
PTC3
U
PTC2
U
PTC1
U
PTC0
U
Port C Data Register
(PTC)
PTD7
U
PTD6
U
PTD5
U
PTD4
U
PTD3
U
PTD2
U
PTD1
U
PTD0
U
Port D Data Register
(PTD)
DDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0
Data Direction Register A
(DDRA)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0
Data Direction Register B
(DDRB)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
Data Direction Register C
(DDRC)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0
Data Direction Register D
(DDRD)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 1 of 12)
Technical Data
48
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
$000A
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
$000B
$000C
$000D
$000E
$000F
$0010
$0011
$0012
$0013
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
Port-A LED Control
LEDA5
LEDA4
LEDA3
LEDA2
LEDA1
LEDA0
Register Write:
(LEDA)
Reset:
0
LEDC7
0
0
LEDC6
0
0
LEDC5
0
0
LEDC4
0
0
LEDC3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Port-C LED Control
Register Write:
(LEDC)
Reset:
0
DO2
0
0
DO1
0
0
DO0
0
Read:
Analog Module Control
PWR1
0
PWR0
0
OPCH1 OPCH0
AMIEN
0
Register Write:
(AMCR)
Reset:
0
0
Read:
Analog Module Gain
GAINB3 GAINB2 GAINB1 GAINB0 GAINA3 GAINA2 GAINA1 GAINA0
Control Register Write:
(AMGCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
OPIF
DOF
CDIF
Analog Module Status and
AMCDIV1 AMCDIV0
Control Register Write:
OPIFR
U
CDIFR
U
(AMSCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
LOOPS
0
ENSCI
0
TXINV
0
M
0
WAKE
0
ILTY
0
PEN
0
PTY
0
SCI Control Register 1
Write:
(SCC1)
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 2 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
49
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
TCIE
0
5
SCRIE
0
4
ILIE
0
3
TE
2
RE
0
1
Bit 0
SBK
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
SCTIE
RWU
0
SCI Control Register 2
(SCC2)
$0014
0
0
R8
T8
DMARE DMATE
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
SCI Control Register 3
(SCC3)
$0015
$0016
$0017
$0018
$0019
$001A
$001B
$001C
$001D
U
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: SCTE
Write:
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
SCI Status Register 1
(SCS1)
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BKF
RPF
SCI Status Register 2
(SCS2)
0
R7
T7
U
0
R6
T6
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
R5
T5
U
R4
T4
U
R3
T3
U
R2
T2
U
R1
T1
U
R0
T0
U
SCI Data Register
(SCDR)
0
0
SCP1
SCP0
R
SCR2
SCR1
0
SCR0
0
SCI Baud Rate Register
(SCBR)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Keyboard Status and Read:
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
IMASKK MODEK
Control Register
Write:
(KBSCR)
Reset:
0
0
KBIE6
0
0
0
0
0
KBIE1
0
0
KBIE0
0
Read:
Keyboard Interrupt Enable
KBIE7
KBIE5
KBIE4
KBIE3
KBIE2
Register Write:
(KBIER)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
IRQ2F
0
ACK2
0
IRQ2 Status and Control
PTBPUE6
IMASK2 MODE2
Register Write:
(INTSCR2)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
CDOEN
0
0
SCIBDSRC
0
Read:
0
STOP_
RCLKEN XCLKEN
STOP_
STOP_
ICLKEN
OSCCLK1 OSCCLK0
Configuration Register 2
Write:
(CONFIG2)†
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 3 of 12)
Technical Data
50
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
IRQ1F
IRQ1 Status and Control
IMASK1 MODE1
$001E
Register Write:
(INTSCR1)
ACK1
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
STOP
0
0
COPD
0
Read:
COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3 SSREC
Configuration Register 1
$001F
Write:
(CONFIG1)†
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
† One-time writable register after each reset.
Read:
TOF
0
0
TRST
0
Timer 1 Status and
Control Register Write:
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
PS0
$0020
$0021
$0022
$0023
$0024
$0025
$0026
(T1SC)
Reset:
0
0
1
0
0
0
9
0
Read: Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
Bit 8
Timer 1 Counter
Register High Write:
(T1CNTH)
Reset:
0
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 0
Timer 1 Counter
Register Low Write:
(T1CNTL)
Reset:
0
Bit 15
1
0
0
13
1
0
12
1
0
0
0
0
Read:
Timer 1 Counter Modulo
14
11
10
9
Bit 8
Register High Write:
(T1MODH)
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Timer 1 Counter Modulo
Bit 7
1
6
1
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Register Low Write:
(T1MODL)
Reset:
1
1
1
ELS0B
0
1
ELS0A
0
1
TOV0
0
1
CH0MAX
0
Read: CH0F
Timer 1 Channel 0 Status
CH0IE
0
MS0B
0
MS0A
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T1SC0)
Reset:
Read:
Timer 1 Channel 0
Bit 15
X
14
13
X
12
X
11
10
9
Bit 8
X
Register High Write:
(T1CH0H)
Reset:
X
X
X
X
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 4 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
51
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
Timer 1 Channel 0
Bit 7
Bit 7
X
6
6
5
4
4
3
2
2
1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
X
Read:
5
3
$0027
Register Low Write:
(T1CH0L)
Reset:
X
X
0
X
X
X
X
Read: CH1F
Timer 1 Channel 1 Status
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
ELS1A
0
TOV1
0
CH1MAX
0
$0028
$0029
$002A
$002B
$002C
$002D
$002E
$002F
$0030
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T1SC1)
Reset:
0
13
0
11
X
3
Read:
Timer 1 Channel 1
Bit 15
X
14
12
X
10
X
9
Bit 8
X
Register High Write:
(T1CH1H)
Reset:
X
X
X
Read:
Timer 1 Channel 1
Bit 7
6
5
4
2
1
Bit 0
X
Register Low Write:
(T1CH1L)
Reset:
X
TOF
0
X
X
X
0
X
0
X
X
Read:
Timer 2 Status and
Control Register Write:
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
PS0
TRST
0
(T2SC)
Reset:
0
0
1
0
0
0
9
0
Read: Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
Bit 8
Timer 2 Counter
Register High Write:
(T2CNTH)
Reset:
0
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 0
Timer 2 Counter
Register Low Write:
(T2CNTL)
Reset:
0
Bit 15
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Timer 2 Counter Modulo
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Register High Write:
(T2MODH)
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Timer 2 Counter Modulo
Bit 7
6
5
1
4
3
2
1
1
Bit 0
Register Low Write:
(T2MODL)
Reset:
1
1
CH0IE
0
1
MS0A
0
1
ELS0B
0
1
ELS0A
0
1
CH0MAX
0
Read: CH0F
Timer 2 Channel 0 Status
MS0B
0
TOV0
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T2SC0)
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 5 of 12)
Technical Data
52
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
Bit 15
X
6
14
X
5
13
X
5
4
12
X
3
11
2
10
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
X
Read:
Timer 2 Channel 0
9
X
$0031
Register High Write:
(T2CH0H)
Reset:
X
X
Read:
Timer 2 Channel 0
Bit 7
6
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
X
$0032
$0033
$0034
$0035
$0036
$0037
$0038
$0039
$003A
Register Low Write:
(T2CH0L)
Reset:
X
X
X
0
X
X
X
X
Read: CH1F
Timer 2 Channel 1 Status
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
0
ELS1A
0
TOV1
0
CH1MAX
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T2SC1)
Reset:
0
13
Read:
Timer 2 Channel 1
Bit 15
X
14
X
12
X
11
10
9
Bit 8
X
Register High Write:
(T2CH1H)
Reset:
X
X
X
X
Read:
Timer 2 Channel 1
Bit 7
X
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
X
Register Low Write:
(T2CH1L)
Reset:
X
X
X
X
X
X
Read:
PLLF
PLLIE
0
PLLON
1
BCS
PRE1
PRE0
VPR1
VPR0
0
PLL Control Register
Write:
(PTCL)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
LOCK
PLL Bandwidth Control
AUTO
ACQ
R
Register Write:
(PBWC)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUL11
0
0
MUL10
0
0
MUL9
0
Read:
PLL Multiplier Select
MUL8
0
Register High Write:
(PMSH)
Reset:
0
MUL7
0
0
MUL6
1
0
MUL5
0
0
MUL4
0
Read:
PLL Multiplier Select
MUL3
0
MUL2
0
MUL1
0
MUL0
0
Register Low Write:
(PMSL)
Reset:
Read:
PLL VCO Range Select
VRS7
0
VRS6
1
VRS5
0
VRS4
0
VRS3
0
VRS2
0
VRS1
0
VRS0
0
Register Write:
(PMRS)
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 6 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
53
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
PLL Reference Divider
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
RDS3
0
2
RDS2
0
1
RDS1
0
Bit 0
RDS0
1
Read:
0
0
0
0
$003B
Select Register Write:
(PMDS)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Read:
$003C
$003D
$003E
$003F
$0040
$0041
$0042
$0043
$0044
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 7 of 12)
Technical Data
54
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
$0045
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read: TBIF
0
TACK
0
Timebase Control
Register Write:
TBR2
0
TBR1
0
TBR0
0
TBIE
0
TBON
0
R
$0046
$0047
$0048
$0049
$004A
$004B
$004C
$004D
$004E
(TBCR)
Reset:
Read:
0
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
MMAD7 MMAD6 MMAD5 MMAD4 MMAD3 MMAD2 MMAD1 MMEXTAD
MMIIC Address Register
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
(MMADR)
1
MMEN
0
0
MMIEN
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MMCLRBB
0
MMCRCBYTE
MMTXAK REPSEN
SDASCL1
0
MMIIC Control Register 1
(MMCR1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMALIF MMNAKIF MMBB
MMAST MMRW
MMCRCEF
MMIIC Control Register 2
(MMCR2)
Write:
0
0
0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Unaffected
Read: MMRXIF MMTXIF MMATCH MMSRW MMRXAK MMCRCBF MMTXBE MMRXBF
MMIIC Status Register
(MMSR)
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
MMIIC Data Transmit
MMTD7 MMTD6 MMTD5 MMTD4 MMTD3 MMTD2 MMTD1 MMTD0
Register Write:
(MMDTR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMRD7 MMRD6 MMRD5 MMRD4 MMRD3 MMRD2 MMRD1 MMRD0
MMIIC Data Receive
Register Write:
(MDDRR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMCRCD7 MMCRCD6 MMCRCD5 MMCRCD4 MMCRCD3 MMCRCD2 MMCRCD1 MMCRCD0
Write:
MMIIC CRC Data Register
(MMCRDR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 8 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
55
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
MMIIC Frequency Divider
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
MMBR2 MMBR1 MMBR0
$004F
Register Write:
(MMFDR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Read:
Reserved Write:
Reset:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$0050
$0051
$0052
$0053
$0054
$0055
$0056
$0057
$0058
Read:
0
0
PWMEN2 PWMEN1 PWMEN0
PCH2
PCH1
PCH0
PWM Control Register
Write:
Reset:
Read:
(PWMCR)
0
PCLKSEL
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PCLK1
0
0
PCLK0
0
PWM Clock Control
Register Write:
(PWMCCR)
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0PWMD7 0PWMD6 0PWMD5 0PWMD4 0PWMD3 0PWMD2 0PWMD1 0PWMD0
PWM Data Register 0
(PWMDR0)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1PWMD7 1PWMD6 1PWMD5 1PWMD4 1PWMD3 1PWMD2 1PWMD1 1PWMD0
PWM Data Register 1
(PWMDR1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2PWMD7 2PWMD6 2PWMD5 2PWMD4 2PWMD3 2PWMD2 2PWMD1 2PWMD0
PWM Data Register 2
(PWMDR2)
0
PHEN
0
0
PHD6
0
0
PHD5
0
0
PHD4
0
0
PHD3
0
0
PHD2
0
0
PHD1
0
0
PHD0
0
PWM Phase Control
Register Write:
(PWMPCR)
Reset:
Read: COCO
ADC Status and Control
Register Write:
AIEN
0
ADCO
0
ADCH4
1
ADCH3
1
ADCH2
1
ADCH1
ADCH0
(ADSCR)
Reset:
Read:
0
ADIV2
0
1
0
1
0
ADC Clock Control
ADIV1
0
ADIV0
0
ADICLK MODE1 MODE0
Register Write:
R
0
(ADICLK)
Reset:
0
0
1
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 9 of 12)
Technical Data
56
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
ADx
R
6
ADx
R
5
ADx
R
4
ADx
R
3
ADx
R
2
ADx
R
1
ADx
R
Bit 0
ADx
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
ADC Data Register High 0
(ADRH0)
$0059
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
$005A
$005B
$005C
$005D
$005E
$005F
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 1
(ADRL1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 2
(ADRL3)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 3
(ADRL3)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADC Auto-scan Control
AUTO1
0
AUTO0
0
ASCAN
0
Register Write:
(ADASCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Unimplemented Write:
Reset:
Read:
SBSW
Note
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SIM Break Status Register
$FE00
Write:
(SBSR)
Reset:
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
Read: POR
Write:
PIN
0
COP
0
ILOP
0
ILAD
0
0
0
LVI
0
0
0
SIM Reset Status Register
$FE01
(SRSR)
POR:
1
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 10 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
57
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Reserved Write:
Reset:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FE02
Read:
SIM Break Flag Control
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
$FE07
$FE08
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
Register Write:
(SBFCR)
Reset:
0
IF6
R
Read:
IF5
R
IF4
R
IF3
R
IF2
R
IF1
R
0
R
0
R
Interrupt Status Register 1
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
(INT1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF14
R
IF13
R
IF12
R
IF11
R
IF10
R
IF9
R
IF8
R
IF7
R
Interrupt Status Register 2
(INT2)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF17
R
IF16
R
IF15
R
Interrupt Status Register 3
(INT3)
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
R
R
R
Reserved Write:
Reset:
Read:
HVEN
MASS
ERASE
PGM
FLASH Control Register
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
(FLCR)
0
BPR7
0
0
BPR6
0
0
BPR5
0
0
BPR4
0
0
BPR3
0
0
BPR2
0
0
BPR1
0
0
BPR0
0
FLASH Block Protect
Register (FLBPR)
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reserved Write:
Reset:
Read:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reserved Write:
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 11 of 12)
Technical Data
58
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
Bit 15
0
6
5
13
0
4
12
0
3
11
0
2
10
0
1
9
0
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
0
Read:
Break Address Register
14
$FE0C
High Write:
(BRKH)
Reset:
Read:
0
Break Address Register
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
4
3
2
Bit 0
$FE0D
$FE0E
$FE0F
Low Write:
(BRKL)
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Break Status and Control
BRKE
0
BRKA
Register Write:
(BRKSCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: LVIOUT
Low-Voltage Inhibit Status
Register Write:
(LVISR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Mask Option Register
(MOR)*
OSCSEL1 OSCSEL0
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FF80
Erased:
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
* MOR is a non-volatile FLASH register; write by programming.
Read:
Low byte of reset vector
Writing clears COP counter (any value)
COP Control Register
$FFFF
Write:
(COPCTL)
Reset:
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 12 of 12)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
59
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Me m ory Ma p
.
Table 2-1. Vector Addresses
Vector Priority Vector Address
Lowest
Vector
$FFDA
$FFDB
$FFDC
$FFDD
$FFDE
$FFDF
$FFE0
$FFE1
$FFE2
$FFE3
$FFE4
$FFE5
$FFE6
$FFE7
$FFE8
$FFE9
$FFEA
$FFEB
$FFEC
$FFED
$FFEE
$FFEF
$FFF0
$FFF1
$FFF2
$FFF3
$FFF4
$FFF5
$FFF6
$FFF7
$FFF8
$FFF9
$FFFA
$FFFB
$FFFC
$FFFD
$FFFE
$FFFF
Timebase Module Interrupt Vector (High)
Timebase Module Interrupt Vector (Low)
Analog Module Interrupt Vector (High)
Analog Module Interrupt Vector (Low)
ADC Conversion Complete Vector (High)
ADC Conversion Complete Vector (Low)
Keyboard Vector (High)
IF17
IF16
IF15
IF14
IF13
IF12
IF11
IF10
IF9
Keyboard Vector (Low)
SCI Transmit Vector (High)
SCI Transmit Vector (Low)
SCI Receive Vector (High)
SCI Receive Vector (Low)
SCI Error Vector (High)
SCI Error Vector (Low)
MMIIC Interrupt Vector (High)
MMIIC Interrupt Vector (Low)
TIM2 Overflow Vector (High)
TIM2 Overflow Vector (Low)
TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (High)
TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (Low)
TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (High)
TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (Low)
TIM1 Overflow Vector (High)
TIM1 Overflow Vector (Low)
TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (High)
TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (Low)
TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (High)
TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (Low)
PLL Vector (High)
IF8
IF7
IF6
IF5
IF4
IF3
PLL Vector (Low)
IRQ2 Vector (High)
IF2
IRQ2 Vector (Low)
IRQ1 Vector (High)
IF1
IRQ1 Vector (Low)
SWI Vector (High)
—
SWI Vector (Low)
Reset Vector (High)
—
Highest
Reset Vector (Low)
Technical Data
60
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 3. Ra nd om -Ac c e ss Me m ory (RAM)
3.1 Conte nts
3.2
3.3
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
3.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the 512 bytes of RAM (random-access memory).
3.3 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Addresses $0060 through $025F are RAM locations. The location of the
stack RAM is programmable. The 16-bit stack pointer allows the stack to
be anywhere in the 64K-byte memory space.
NOTE: For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM
locations.
Within page zero are 160 bytes of RAM. Because the location of the
stack RAM is programmable, all page zero RAM locations can be used
for I/O control and user data or code. When the stack pointer is moved
from its reset location at $00FF out of page zero, direct addressing mode
instructions can efficiently access all page zero RAM locations. Page
zero RAM, therefore, provides ideal locations for frequently accessed
global variables.
Before processing an interrupt, the CPU uses five bytes of the stack to
save the contents of the CPU registers.
NOTE: For M6805 compatibility, the H register is not stacked.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Random-Access Memory (RAM)
Technical Data
61
Ra nd om -Ac c e ss Me m ory (RAM)
During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store
the return address. The stack pointer decrements during pushes and
increments during pulls.
NOTE: Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU may overwrite data
in the RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking
operation.
Technical Data
62
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Random-Access Memory (RAM)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 4. FLASH Me m ory
4.1 Conte nts
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
FLASH Program Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
4.8
4.8.1
FLASH Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
4.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the operation of the embedded FLASH memory.
This memory can be read, programmed, and erased from a single
external supply. The program and erase operations are enabled through
the use of an internal charge pump.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
63
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Me m ory
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
HVEN
0
2
MASS
0
1
ERASE
0
Bit 0
PGM
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
FLASH Control Register
(FLCR)
$FE08
0
BPR7
0
0
BPR6
0
0
BPR5
0
0
BPR4
0
BPR3
0
BPR2
0
BPR1
0
BPR0
0
FLASH Block Protect
Register (FLBPR)
$FE09
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-1. FLASH I/O Register Summary
4.3 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
The FLASH memory consists of an array of 12,288 bytes for user
memory plus a block of 38 bytes for user interrupt vectors and one byte
for the mask option register. An erased bit reads as logic 1 and a
programmed bit reads as a logic 0. The FLASH memory page size is
defined as 128 bytes, and is the minimum size that can be erased in a
page erase operation. Program and erase operations are facilitated
through control bits in FLASH control register (FLCR). The address
ranges for the FLASH memory are:
•
•
•
$C000–$EFFF; user memory, 12,288 bytes
$FFDA–$FFFF; user interrupt vectors, 38 bytes
$FF80; mask option register
Programming tools are available from Motorola. Contact your local
Motorola representative for more information.
NOTE: A security feature prevents viewing of the FLASH contents.1
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Technical Data
64
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Control Register
4.4 FLASH Control Re g iste r
The FLASH control register (FLCR) controls FLASH program and erase
operations.
Address: $FE08
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
HVEN
0
2
MASS
0
1
ERASE
0
Bit 0
PGM
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Figure 4-2. FLASH Control Register (FLCR)
HVEN — High Voltage Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the charge pump to drive high voltages for
program and erase operations in the array. HVEN can only be set if
either PGM = 1 or ERASE = 1 and the proper sequence for program
or erase is followed.
1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on
0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off
MASS — Mass Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for mass erase operation or
block erase operation when the ERASE bit is set.
1 = Mass Erase operation selected
0 = Block Erase operation selected
ERASE — Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation.
ERASE is interlocked with the PGM bit such that both bits cannot be
equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time.
1 = Erase operation selected
0 = Erase operation not selected
PGM — Program Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation.
PGM is interlocked with the ERASE bit such that both bits cannot be
equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time.
1 = Program operation selected
0 = Program operation not selected
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
65
FLASH Memory
FLASH Me m ory
4.5 FLASH Pa g e Era se Op e ra tion
Use the following procedure to erase a page of FLASH memory. A page
consists of 128 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $xx00 or
$xx80. The 38-byte user interrupt vectors area also forms a page. The
38-byte user interrupt vectors cannot be erased by the page erase
operation because of security reasons. Mass erase is required to erase
this page.
1. Set the ERASE bit and clear the MASS bit in the FLASH control
register.
2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the page address
range desired.
3. Wait for a time, tnvs (10µs).
4. Set the HVEN bit.
5. Wait for a time, tErase (1ms).
6. Clear the ERASE bit.
7. Wait for a time, tnvh (5µs).
8. Clear the HVEN bit.
9. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read
mode.
NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by
executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed
from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as
shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
Technical Data
66
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Mass Erase Operation
4.6 FLASH Ma ss Era se Op e ra tion
Use the following procedure to erase the entire FLASH memory to read
as logic 1:
1. Set both the ERASE bit and the MASS bit in the FLASH control
register.
2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the FLASH memory
address range.
3. Wait for a time, tnvs (10µs).
4. Set the HVEN bit.
5. Wait for a time tMErase (4ms).
6. Clear the ERASE bit.
7. Wait for a time, tnvhl (100µs).
8. Clear the HVEN bit.
9. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read
mode.
NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by
executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed
from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as
shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
67
FLASH Memory
FLASH Me m ory
4.7 FLASH Prog ra m Op e ra tion
Programming of the FLASH memory is done on a row basis. A row
consists of 64 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $xx00, $xx40,
$xx80, or $xxC0. The procedure for programming a row of the FLASH
memory is outlined below:
1. Set the PGM bit. This configures the memory for program
operation and enables the latching of address and data for
programming.
2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the row address
range desired.
3. Wait for a time, tnvs (10µs).
4. Set the HVEN bit.
5. Wait for a time, tpgs (5µs).
6. Write data to the FLASH address to be programmed.
7. Wait for time, tProg (30µs).
8. Repeat step 6 and 7 until all the bytes within the row are
programmed.
9. Clear the PGM bit.
10. Wait for time, tnvh (5µs).
11. Clear the HVEN bit.
12. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read
mode.
This program sequence is repeated throughout the memory until all data
is programmed.
NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by
executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed
from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as
shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. Do
not exceed tProg maximum. See 24.18 FLASH Memory
Characteristics.
Technical Data
68
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Program Operation
Figure 4-3 shows a flowchart representation for programming the
FLASH memory.
1
Set PGM bit
Algorithm for programming
a row (64 bytes) of FLASH memory
2
Write any data to any FLASH address
within the row address range desired
3
4
5
Wait for a time, tnvs
Set HVEN bit
Wait for a time, tpgs
6
7
Write data to the FLASH address
to be programmed
Wait for a time, tProg
Completed
Y
programming
this row?
N
9
Clear PGM bit
Wait for a time, tnvh
Clear HVEN bit
NOTE:
The time between each FLASH address change (step 6 to step 6), or
the time between the last FLASH address programmed
to clearing PGM bit (step 6 to step 9)
must not exceed the maximum programming
time, tProg max.
10
11
12
This row program algorithm assumes the row/s
to be programmed are initially erased.
Wait for a time, trcv
End of Programming
Figure 4-3. FLASH Programming Flowchart
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
69
FLASH Memory
FLASH Me m ory
4.8 FLASH Prote c tion
Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the
FLASH memory in the target application, provision is made to protect
pages of memory from unintentional erase or program operations due to
system malfunction. This protection is done by use of a FLASH block
protect register (FLBPR). The FLBPR determines the range of the
FLASH memory which is to be protected. The range of the protected
area starts from a location defined by FLBPR and ends to the bottom of
the FLASH memory ($FFFF). When the memory is protected, the HVEN
bit cannot be set in either ERASE or PROGRAM operations.
NOTE: When the FLBPR is cleared (all 0’s), the entire FLASH memory is
protected from being programmed and erased. When all the bits are set,
the entire FLASH memory is accessible for program and erase.
4.8.1 FLASH Bloc k Prote c t Re g iste r
The FLASH block protect register is implemented as an 8-bit I/O register.
The content of this register determine the starting location of the
protected range within the FLASH memory.
Address: $FE09
Bit 7
BPR7
0
6
BPR6
0
5
BPR5
0
4
BPR4
0
3
BPR3
0
2
BPR2
0
1
BPR1
0
Bit 0
BPR0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 4-4. FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR)
BPR[7:0] — FLASH Block Protect Register Bit7 to Bit 0
BPR[7:1] represent bits [13:7] of a 16-bit memory address. Bits
[15:14] are logic 1s and bits [6:0] are logic 0s.
16-bit memory address
Start address of FLASH block protect 1 1
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
BPR[7:1]
Figure 4-5. FLASH Block Protect Start Address
Technical Data
70
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Memory
FLASH Protection
BPR0 is used only for BPR[7:0] = $FF, for no block protection.
The resultant 16-bit address is used for specifying the start address
of the FLASH memory for block protection. The FLASH is protected
from this start address to the end of FLASH memory, at $FFFF. With
this mechanism, the protect start address can be XX00 or XX80 (at
page boundaries) within the FLASH memory.
Examples of protect start address:
BPR[7:0]
Start of Address of Protect Range
$C000 (1100 0000 0000 0000)
The entire FLASH memory is protected.
$00 or $01
$02 or $03
$04 or $05
$06 or $07
$08 or $09
$C080 (1100 0000 1000 0000)
$C100 (1100 0001 0000 0000)
$C180 (1100 0001 1000 0000)
$C200 (1100 0010 0000 0000)
and so on...
$F8 or $F9
$FA or $FB
$FC or $FD
$FE
$FE00 (1111 1110 0000 0000)
$FE80 (1111 1110 1000 0000)
$FF00 (1111 1111 0000 0000)
$FF80 (1111 1111 1000 0000)
$FF
The entire FLASH memory is not protected.
Note:
The end address of the protected range is always $FFFF.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
71
FLASH Memory
FLASH Me m ory
Technical Data
72
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 5. Config ura tion a nd Ma sk Op tion Re g iste rs
(CONFIG & MOR)
5.1 Conte nts
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Mask Option Register (MOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
5.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the configuration registers, CONFIG1 and
CONFIG2; and the mask option register, MOR.
The configuration registers enable or disable these options:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Computer operating properly module (COP)
COP timeout period (218 – 24 or 213 – 24 ICLK cycles)
Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module power
LVI module reset
LVI module in stop mode
LVI module voltage trip point selection
STOP instruction
Stop mode recovery time (32 ICLK cycles or 4096 ICLK cycles)
Oscillator (internal, RC, and crystal) during stop mode
Serial communications interface clock source (CGMXCLK or fBUS
Current detect output pin
)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Technical Data
73
Config ura tion a nd Ma sk Op tion
The mask option register selects one of the following oscillator options
as the MCU reference clock:
•
•
•
Internal oscillator
RC oscillator
Crystal oscillator
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
0
STOP_
RCLKEN XCLKEN
STOP_
STOP_
ICLKEN
SCIBDSRC
OSCCLK1 OSCCLK0
CDOEN
Configuration Register 2
(CONFIG2)†
$001D
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
STOP
0
0
COPD
0
COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3 SSREC
Configuration Register 1
(CONFIG1)†
$001F
0
0
0
0
0††
R
0
Mask Option Register
(MOR)*
OSCSEL1 OSCSEL0
R
R
R
R
R
$FF80
Erased:
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
*FLASHregister.
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
† One-time writable register after each reset.
†† Reset by POR only.
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 5-1. CONFIG and MOR Register Summary
5.3 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
The configuration registers and the mask option register are used in the
initialization of various options. These two types of registers are
configured differently:
•
•
Configuration registers — Write-once registers after reset
Mask option register — FLASH register (write by programming)
The configuration registers can be written once after each reset. All of
the configuration register bits are cleared during reset. Since the various
options affect the operation of the MCU, it is recommended that these
registers be written immediately after reset. The configuration registers
are located at $001D and $001F. The configurations register may be
read at anytime.
Technical Data
74
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
MOTOROLA
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1)
NOTE: The options except LVI5OR3 are one-time writable by the user after
each reset. The LVI5OR3 bit is one-time writable by the user only after
each POR (power-on reset). The CONFIG registers are not in the
FLASH memory but are special registers containing one-time writable
latches after each reset. Upon a reset, the CONFIG registers default to
predetermined settings as shown in Figure 5-2 and Figure 5-3.
The mask option register (MOR) is used for selecting one of the three
clock options for the MCU. The MOR is a byte located in FLASH
memory, and is written to by a FLASH programming routine.
5.4 Config ura tion Re g iste r 1 (CONFIG1)
Address: $001F
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
STOP
0
Bit 0
COPD
0
Read:
COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3 SSREC
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0*
0
* Reset by POR only.
Figure 5-2. Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1)
COPRS — COP Rate Select
COPRS selects the COP time-out period. Reset clears COPRS. (See
Section 21. Computer Operating Properly (COP).)
1 = COP time out period = 213 – 24 ICLK cycles
0 = COP time out period = 218 – 24 ICLK cycles
LVISTOP — LVI Enable in Stop Mode
When the LVIPWRD bit is clear, setting the LVISTOP bit enables the
LVI to operate during stop mode. Reset clears LVISTOP. (See
Section 22. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).)
1 = LVI enabled during stop mode
0 = LVI disabled during stop mode
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Technical Data
75
Config ura tion a nd Ma sk Op tion
LVIRSTD — LVI Reset Disable
LVIRSTD disables the reset signal from the LVI module. (See
Section 22. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).)
1 = LVI module resets disabled
0 = LVI module resets enabled
LVIPWRD — LVI Power Disable Bit
LVIPWRD disables the LVI module. (See Section 22. Low-Voltage
Inhibit (LVI).)
1 = LVI module power disabled
0 = LVI module power enabled
LVI5OR3 — LVI 5V or 3V Operating Mode
LVI5OR3 selects the voltage operating mode of the LVI module. (See
Section 22. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).) The voltage mode selected
for the LVI should match the operating VDD. See Section 24.
Electrical Specifications for the LVI voltage trip points for each of
the modes.
1 = LVI operates in 5V mode
0 = LVI operates in 3V mode
SSREC — Short Stop Recovery
SSREC enables the CPU to exit stop mode with a delay of 32 ICLK
cycles instead of a 4096 ICLK cycle delay.
1 = Stop mode recovery after 32 ICLK cycles
0 = Stop mode recovery after 4096 ICLK cycles
NOTE: Exiting stop mode by pulling reset will result in the long stop recovery.
If using an external crystal oscillator, and it is disabled during stop mode
(STOP_XCLKEN=0), do not set the SSREC bit.
NOTE: When the LVI is disabled in stop mode (LVISTOP=0), the system
stabilization time for long stop recovery (4096 ICLK cycles) gives a delay
longer than the LVI’s turn-on time. There is no period where the MCU is
not protected from a low power condition. However, when using the
short stop recovery configuration option, the 32 ICLK delay is less than
the LVI’s turn-on time and there exists a period in start-up where the LVI
is not protecting the MCU.
Technical Data
76
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
MOTOROLA
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2)
STOP — STOP Instruction Enable
STOP enables the STOP instruction.
1 = STOP instruction enabled
0 = STOP instruction treated as illegal opcode
COPD — COP Disable Bit
COPD disables the COP module. (See Section 21. Computer
Operating Properly (COP).)
1 = COP module disabled
0 = COP module enabled
5.5 Config ura tion Re g iste r 2 (CONFIG2)
Address: $001D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
STOP_
RCLKEN XCLKEN
STOP_
STOP_
OSCCLK1 OSCCLK0
CDOEN SCIBDSRC
ICLKEN
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 5-3. Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2)
STOP_ICLKEN — Internal Oscillator Stop Mode Disable
STOP_ICLKEN disables the internal oscillator during stop mode.
Setting the STOP_ICLKEN bit disables the oscillator during stop
mode. (See 7.4 Internal Oscillator).
Reset clears this bit.
1 = Internal oscillator disabled during stop mode
0 = Internal oscillator enabled to operate during stop mode
STOP_RCLKEN — RC Oscillator Stop Mode Enable
STOP_RCLKEN enables the RC oscillator to continue operating
during stop mode. Setting the STOP_RCLKEN bit allows the
oscillator to operate continuously even during stop mode. This is
useful for driving the timebase module to allow it to generate periodic
wake up while in stop mode. (See Section 8. Clock Generator
Module (CGM) and subsection 8.8.2 Stop Mode.)
Reset clears this bit.
1 = RC oscillator enabled to operate during stop mode
0 = RC oscillator disabled during stop mode
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Technical Data
77
Config ura tion a nd Ma sk Op tion
STOP_XCLKEN — Crystal Oscillator Stop Mode Enable
STOP_XCLKEN enables the crystal (x-tal) oscillator to continue
operating during stop mode. Setting the STOP_XCLKEN bit allows
the x-tal oscillator to operate continuously even during stop mode.
This is useful for driving the timebase module to allow it to generate
periodic wake up while in stop mode. (See Section 8. Clock
Generator Module (CGM) and subsection 8.8.2 Stop Mode.)
Reset clears this bit.
1 = X-tal oscillator enabled to operate during stop mode
0 = X-tal oscillator disabled during stop mode
OSCCLK1, OSCCLK0 — Oscillator Output Control Bits
OSCCLK1 and OSCCLK0 select which oscillator output to be driven
out as OSCCLK to the timebase module (TBM). Reset clears these
two bits.
OSCCLK1
OSCCLK0
Timebase Clock Source
Internal oscillator (ICLK)
RC oscillator (RCCLK)
X-tal oscillator (XTAL)
Not used
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CDOEN — Current-Flow Detect Output Enable
CDOEN enables the port pin PC0/PWM0/CD as the CD output pin for
the current detect flag (CDIF) from the analog module. Reset clears
the CDOEN bit.
1 = PCO/PWMO/CD pin enabled as CD output pin,
PTC0 and PWM0 functions are disabled.
0 = PTC0/PWM/CD pin disabled as CD output pin,
PTC0 or PWM0 functions are available; see 18.5.1 Port C
Data Register (PTC).
Technical Data
78
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
MOTOROLA
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Mask Option Register (MOR)
SCIBDSRC — SCI Baud Rate Clock Source
SCIBDSRC selects the clock source used for the SCI. The setting of
this bit affects the frequency at which the SCI operates.
1 = Internal data bus clock, fBUS, is used as clock source for SCI
0 = Oscillator clock, CGMXCLK, is used as clock source for SCI
5.6 Ma sk Op tion Re g iste r (MOR)
The mask option register (MOR) is used for selecting one of the three
clock options for the MCU. The MOR is a byte located in FLASH
memory, and is written to by a FLASH programming routine.
Address: $FF80
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
OSCSEL1 OSCSEL0
R
R
R
R
R
Erased:
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
U
R
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
=Reserved
Figure 5-4. Mask Option Register (MOR)
OSCSEL1, OSCSEL0 — Oscillator Selection Bits
OSCSEL1 and OSCSEL0 select which oscillator is used for the MCU
CGMXCLK clock. The erase state of these two bits is logic 1. These
bits are unaffected by reset. (See Table 5-1).
Bits 5–0 — Should be left as 1’s.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
Technical Data
79
Config ura tion a nd Ma sk Op tion
Table 5-1. CGMXCLK Clock Selection
OSCSEL1
OSCSEL0
CGMXCLK
—
OSC2 pin
—
Comments
0
0
0
1
Not used
ICLK
fBUS
Internal oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
RC oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
Internal oscillator is available after each POR
or reset.
1
1
0
1
RCCLK
X-TAL
fBUS
Inverting
output of
XTAL
X-tal oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
Internal oscillator is available after each POR
or reset.
NOTE: The internal oscillator is a free running oscillator and is available after
each POR or reset. It is turned-off in stop mode by clearing the
STOP_ICLKEN bit in CONFIG2.
Technical Data
80
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Configuration and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 6. Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
6.1 Conte nts
6.2
6.3
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
6.4
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
6.4.4
6.4.5
6.5
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
6.6
6.6.1
6.6.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
6.7
6.8
6.9
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
6.2 Introd uc tion
The M68HC08 CPU (central processor unit) is an enhanced and fully
object-code-compatible version of the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08
Reference Manual (Motorola document order number CPU08RM/AD)
contains a description of the CPU instruction set, addressing modes,
and architecture.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
81
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
6.3 Fe a ture s
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 Family
16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions
16-bit index register with x-register manipulation instructions
8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency
64K-byte program/data memory space
16 addressing modes
Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator
Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions
Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling
Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for
extension of addressing range beyond 64K-bytes
•
Low-power stop and wait modes
6.4 CPU Re g iste rs
Figure 6-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of
the memory map.
Technical Data
82
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
7
0
0
0
0
ACCUMULATOR (A)
15
15
15
H
X
INDEX REGISTER (H:X)
STACK POINTER (SP)
PROGRAM COUNTER (PC)
CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR)
7
0
V 1
1
H
I
N Z
C
CARRY/BORROW FLAG
ZERO FLAG
NEGATIVE FLAG
INTERRUPT MASK
HALF-CARRY FLAG
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG
Figure 6-1. CPU Registers
6.4.1 Ac c um ula tor
The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the
accumulator to hold operands and the results of arithmetic/logic
operations.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 6-2. Accumulator (A)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
83
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
6.4.2 Ind e x Re g iste r
The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64K-byte
memory space. H is the upper byte of the index register, and X is the
lower byte. H:X is the concatenated 16-bit index register.
In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the
index register to determine the conditional address of the operand.
The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location.
Bit
15
Bit
0
14 13 12 11 10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 6-3. Index Register (H:X)
6.4.3 Sta c k Pointe r
The stack pointer is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next
location on the stack. During a reset, the stack pointer is preset to
$00FF. The reset stack pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least
significant byte to $FF and does not affect the most significant byte. The
stack pointer decrements as data is pushed onto the stack and
increments as data is pulled from the stack.
In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the
stack pointer can function as an index register to access data on the
stack. The CPU uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine the
conditional address of the operand.
Technical Data
84
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
Bit
15
Bit
0
14 13 12 11 10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Figure 6-4. Stack Pointer (SP)
NOTE: The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in
RAM. Moving the SP out of page 0 ($0000 to $00FF) frees direct
address (page 0) space. For correct operation, the stack pointer must
point only to RAM locations.
6.4.4 Prog ra m Counte r
The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the
next instruction or operand to be fetched.
Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next
sequential memory location every time an instruction or operand is
fetched. Jump, branch, and interrupt operations load the program
counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location.
During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector
address located at $FFFE and $FFFF. The vector address is the
address of the first instruction to be executed after exiting the reset state.
Bit
15
Bit
0
14 13 12 11 10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Loaded with Vector from $FFFE and $FFFF
Figure 6-5. Program Counter (PC)
6.4.5 Cond ition Cod e Re g iste r
The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask and five
flags that indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
85
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
5 are set permanently to logic 1. The following paragraphs describe the
functions of the condition code register.
Bit 7
6
1
1
5
1
1
4
H
X
3
I
2
N
X
1
Z
X
Bit 0
C
Read:
Write:
Reset:
V
X
1
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 6-6. Condition Code Register (CCR)
V — Overflow Flag
The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow
occurs. The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use
the overflow flag.
1 = Overflow
0 = No overflow
H — Half-Carry Flag
The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between
accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an add-without-carry (ADD) or add-
with-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for binary-
coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses
the states of the H and C flags to determine the appropriate correction
factor.
1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4
0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4
Technical Data
86
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
I — Interrupt Mask
When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are
disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is
cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set
automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but
before the interrupt vector is fetched.
1 = Interrupts disabled
0 = Interrupts enabled
NOTE: To maintain M6805 Family compatibility, the upper byte of the index
register (H) is not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine
modifies H, then the user must stack and unstack H using the PSHH and
PULH instructions.
After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is
serviced first.
A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from
the stack and restores the interrupt mask from the stack. After any
reset, the interrupt mask is set and can be cleared only by the clear
interrupt mask software instruction (CLI).
N — Negative flag
The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic
operation, or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit
7 of the result.
1 = Negative result
0 = Non-negative result
Z — Zero flag
The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic
operation, or data manipulation produces a result of $00.
1 = Zero result
0 = Non-zero result
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
87
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
C — Carry/Borrow Flag
The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation
produces a carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction
operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and
branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag.
1 = Carry out of bit 7
0 = No carry out of bit 7
6.5 Arithm e tic / Log ic Unit (ALU)
The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the
instruction set.
Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual (Motorola document order
number CPU08RM/AD) for a description of the instructions and
addressing modes and more detail about the architecture of the CPU.
6.6 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption
standby modes.
6.6.1 Wa it Mod e
The WAIT instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register,
enabling interrupts. After exit from wait mode by interrupt, the I bit
remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
Technical Data
88
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU During Break Interrupts
6.6.2 Stop Mod e
The STOP instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register,
enabling external interrupts. After exit from stop mode by external
interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator
stabilization delay.
6.7 CPU During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
If a break module is present on the MCU, the CPU starts a break
interrupt by:
•
•
Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
Loading the program counter with $FFFC:$FFFD or with
$FEFC:$FEFD in monitor mode
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in
progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of
a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the
break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation if the break
interrupt has been deasserted.
6.8 Instruc tion Se t Sum m a ry
6.9 Op c od e Ma p
See Table 6-2.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
89
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary
Effect on
CCR
Source
Operation
Form
Description
V H
I N Z C
ADC #opr
ADC opr
ADC opr
ADC opr,X
ADC opr,X
ADC ,X
ADC opr,SP
ADC opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A9
B9
C9
D9
E9
F9
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Add with Carry
A ← (A) + (M) + (C)
↕ ↕ – ↕ ↕ ↕
SP1
SP2
9EE9 ff
9ED9 ee ff
ADD #opr
ADD opr
ADD opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
AB
BB
CB
DB
EB
FB
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ADD opr,X
Add without Carry
ADD opr,X
A ← (A) + (M)
↕ ↕ – ↕ ↕ ↕
ADD ,X
ADD opr,SP
ADD opr,SP
SP1
SP2
9EEB ff
9EDB ee ff
AIS #opr
AIX #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X
SP ← (SP) + (16 « M)
H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– IMM
– IMM
A7
AF
ii
ii
2
2
AND #opr
AND opr
AND opr
AND opr,X
AND opr,X
AND ,X
AND opr,SP
AND opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A4
B4
C4
D4
E4
F4
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Logical AND
A ← (A) & (M)
0
–
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
SP2
9EE4 ff
9ED4 ee ff
ASL opr
ASLA
ASLX
ASL opr,X
ASL ,X
ASL opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
38
48
58
68
78
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
Arithmetic Shift Left
(Same as LSL)
↕ –
↕ ↕ ↕
C
0
b7
b7
b0
b0
SP1
9E68 ff
ASR opr
ASRA
ASRX
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
37
47
57
67
77
dd
4
1
1
4
3
5
C
Arithmetic Shift Right
↕ –
–
–
↕ ↕ ↕
ff
SP1
9E67 ff
BCC rel
Branch if Carry Bit Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
24
rr
3
DIR (b0)
11
13
15
17
19
1B
1D
1F
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
BCLR n, opr
Clear Bit n in M
Mn ← 0
–
–
Technical Data
90
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z
C
BCS rel
Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO)
Branch if Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
25
27
rr
rr
3
3
BEQ rel
BGE opr
Branch if Greater Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N V) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
90
92
rr
rr
3
Branch if Greater Than (Signed
Operands)
BGT opr
PC ← (PC) + 2 +rel ? (Z) | (N V) = 0 –
3
3
BHCC rel
BHCS rel
BHI rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear
Branch if Half Carry Bit Set
Branch if Higher
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
– REL
28
29
22
rr
rr
rr
3
3
3
Branch if Higher or Same
(Same as BCC)
BHS rel
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
24
rr
BIH rel
BIL rel
Branch if IRQ Pin High
Branch if IRQ Pin Low
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
2F
2E
rr
rr
3
3
BIT #opr
BIT opr
BIT opr
BIT opr,X
BIT opr,X
BIT ,X
BIT opr,SP
BIT opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A5
B5
C5
D5
E5
F5
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Bit Test
(A) & (M)
0
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
SP2
9EE5 ff
9ED5 ee ff
Branch if Less Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
BLE opr
PC ← (PC) + 2 +rel ? (Z) | (N V) = 1 –
–
–
–
–
– REL
93
rr
3
BLO rel
BLS rel
BLT opr
BMC rel
BMI rel
BMS rel
BNE rel
BPL rel
BRA rel
Branch if Lower (Same as BCS)
Branch if Lower or Same
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
25
23
91
2C
2B
2D
26
2A
20
rr
rr
rr
rr
rr
rr
rr
rr
rr
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1
Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N V) =1
Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear
Branch if Minus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Set
Branch if Not Equal
Branch if Plus
Branch Always
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
91
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z
C
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
01
03
05
07
09
0B
0D
0F
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
↕
BRN rel
Branch Never
PC ← (PC) + 2
– REL
DIR (b0)
21
rr
3
00
02
04
06
08
0A
0C
0E
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1
↕
DIR (b0)
DIR (b1)
DIR (b2)
DIR (b3)
DIR (b4)
DIR (b5)
DIR (b6)
DIR (b7)
10
12
14
16
18
1A
1C
1E
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
BSET n,opr
Set Bit n in M
Mn ← 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1
BSR rel
Branch to Subroutine
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
AD
rr
4
PC ← (PC) + rel
CBEQ opr,rel
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (X) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
DIR
IMM
31
41
51
61
71
dd rr
ii rr
ii rr
ff rr
rr
5
4
4
5
4
6
CBEQA #opr,rel
CBEQX #opr,rel
CBEQ opr,X+,rel
CBEQ X+,rel
IMM
IX1+
Compare and Branch if Equal
–
IX+
SP1
CBEQ opr,SP,rel
9E61 ff rr
CLC
CLI
Clear Carry Bit
C ← 0
I ← 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0 INH
98
9A
1
2
Clear Interrupt Mask
0
– INH
CLR opr
CLRA
CLRX
CLRH
CLR opr,X
CLR ,X
M ← $00
A ← $00
X ← $00
H ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
DIR
INH
INH
– INH
IX1
IX
3F
4F
5F
8C
6F
7F
dd
ff
3
1
1
1
3
2
4
Clear
0
–
–
0
1
CLR opr,SP
SP1
9E6F ff
Technical Data
92
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z C
CMP #opr
CMP opr
CMP opr
CMP opr,X
CMP opr,X
CMP ,X
CMP opr,SP
CMP opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A1
B1
C1
D1
E1
F1
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Compare A with M
(A) – (M)
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ ↕
SP1
SP2
9EE1 ff
9ED1 ee ff
COM opr
COMA
COMX
COM opr,X
COM ,X
COM opr,SP
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
A ← (A) = $FF – (M)
X ← (X) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
33
43
53
63
73
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
Complement (One’s Complement)
0
–
–
–
↕ ↕ 1
SP1
9E63 ff
CPHX #opr
CPHX opr
IMM
DIR
65
75
ii ii+1
dd
3
4
Compare H:X with M
(H:X) – (M:M + 1)
↕ –
↕ –
↕ ↕ ↕
CPX #opr
CPX opr
CPX opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A3
B3
C3
D3
E3
F3
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
CPX ,X
Compare X with M
(X) – (M)
–
↕ ↕ ↕
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,SP
CPX opr,SP
SP1
SP2
9EE3 ff
9ED3 ee ff
DAA
Decimal Adjust A
(A)
U
–
–
–
–
↕ ↕ ↕ INH
72
2
10
A ← (A) –1 or M ← (M) –1 or X← (X) –1
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
5
3
3
5
4
6
DBNZ opr,rel
DBNZA rel
DBNZX rel
DBNZ opr,X,rel
DBNZ X,rel
DBNZ opr,SP,rel
DIR
INH
3B
4B
5B
6B
7B
dd rr
rr
rr
ff rr
rr
Decrement and Branch if Not Zero
–
–
–
– INH
IX1
IX
SP1
9E6B ff rr
DEC opr
DECA
DECX
DEC opr,X
DEC ,X
DEC opr,SP
M ← (M) – 1
A ← (A) – 1
X ← (X) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
3A
4A
5A
6A
7A
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
Decrement
Divide
↕ –
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
9E6A ff
A ← (H:A)/(X)
H ← Remainder
DIV
–
–
–
↕ ↕ INH
52
7
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
93
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z C
EOR #opr
EOR opr
EOR opr
EOR opr,X
EOR opr,X
EOR ,X
EOR opr,SP
EOR opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A8
B8
C8
D8
E8
F8
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Exclusive OR M with A
A ← (A M)
0
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
SP2
9EE8 ff
9ED8 ee ff
INC opr
INCA
INCX
INC opr,X
INC ,X
INC opr,SP
M ← (M) + 1
A ← (A) + 1
X ← (X) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
3C
4C
5C
6C
7C
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
Increment
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
9E6C ff
JMP opr
JMP opr
JMP opr,X
JMP opr,X
JMP ,X
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
IX
BC
CC
DC
EC
FC
dd
2
3
4
3
2
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Jump
PC ← Jump Address
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
JSR opr
JSR opr
JSR opr,X
JSR opr,X
JSR ,X
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
BD
CD
DD
ED
FD
dd
4
5
6
5
4
PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3)
Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← Unconditional Address
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Jump to Subroutine
IX
LDA #opr
LDA opr
LDA opr
LDA opr,X
LDA opr,X
LDA ,X
LDA opr,SP
LDA opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A6
B6
C6
D6
E6
F6
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Load A from M
Load H:X from M
Load X from M
A ← (M)
H:X ← (M:M + 1)
X ← (M)
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
↕ ↕ –
↕ ↕ –
↕ ↕ –
SP1
SP2
9EE6 ff
9ED6 ee ff
LDHX #opr
LDHX opr
IMM
DIR
45
55
ii jj
dd
3
4
LDX #opr
LDX opr
LDX opr
LDX opr,X
LDX opr,X
LDX ,X
LDX opr,SP
LDX opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
AE
BE
CE
DE
EE
FE
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
SP1
SP2
9EEE ff
9EDE ee ff
LSL opr
LSLA
LSLX
LSL opr,X
LSL ,X
LSL opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
38
48
58
68
78
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
Logical Shift Left
(Same as ASL)
C
0
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ ↕
b7
b0
SP1
9E68 ff
Technical Data
94
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z C
LSR opr
LSRA
LSRX
LSR opr,X
LSR ,X
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
34
44
54
64
74
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
0
C
Logical Shift Right
↕ –
–
0 ↕ ↕
b7
b0
LSR opr,SP
SP1
9E64 ff
MOV opr,opr
MOV opr,X+
MOV #opr,opr
MOV X+,opr
DD
4E
5E
6E
7E
dd dd
dd
ii dd
dd
5
4
4
4
(M)
← (M)
Source
Destination
DIX+
IMD
IX+D
Move
0
–
–
–
↕ ↕ –
H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+)
X:A ← (X) × (A)
MUL
Unsigned multiply
–
0
–
–
0 INH
42
5
NEG opr
NEGA
NEGX
NEG opr,X
NEG ,X
NEG opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
30
40
50
60
70
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
A ← –(A) = $00 – (A)
X ← –(X) = $00 – (X)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
Negate (Two’s Complement)
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ ↕
SP1
9E60 ff
NOP
NSA
No Operation
None
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
9D
1
3
Nibble Swap A
A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4])
62
ORA #opr
ORA opr
ORA opr
ORA opr,X
ORA opr,X
ORA ,X
ORA opr,SP
ORA opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
AA
BA
CA
DA
EA
FA
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Inclusive OR A and M
A ← (A) | (M)
0
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
SP2
9EEA ff
9EDA ee ff
PSHA
PSHH
PSHX
PULA
PULH
PULX
Push A onto Stack
Push H onto Stack
Push X onto Stack
Pull A from Stack
Pull H from Stack
Pull X from Stack
Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A)
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H)
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
87
8B
89
86
8A
88
2
2
2
2
2
2
ROL opr
ROLA
ROLX
ROL opr,X
ROL ,X
ROL opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
39
49
59
69
79
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
C
Rotate Left through Carry
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ ↕
b7
b0
SP1
9E69 ff
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
95
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z C
ROR opr
RORA
RORX
ROR opr,X
ROR ,X
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
36
46
56
66
76
dd
ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
C
Rotate Right through Carry
↕ –
–
–
↕ ↕ ↕
b7
b0
ROR opr,SP
SP1
9E66 ff
RSP
Reset Stack Pointer
Return from Interrupt
SP ← $FF
–
–
–
–
– INH
9C
1
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL)
RTI
↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ INH
80
81
7
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL)
RTS
Return from Subroutine
Subtract with Carry
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
4
SBC #opr
SBC opr
SBC opr
SBC opr,X
SBC opr,X
SBC ,X
SBC opr,SP
SBC opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A2
B2
C2
D2
E2
F2
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
A ← (A) – (M) – (C)
↕ –
↕ ↕ ↕
SP1
SP2
9EE2 ff
9ED2 ee ff
SEC
SEI
Set Carry Bit
C ← 1
I ← 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
1 INH
99
9B
1
2
Set Interrupt Mask
1
– INH
STA opr
STA opr
DIR
EXT
IX2
B7
C7
D7
E7
F7
dd
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
hh ll
ee ff
ff
STA opr,X
STA opr,X
STA ,X
STA opr,SP
STA opr,SP
Store A in M
M ← (A)
0
–
–
↕ ↕ – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
9EE7 ff
9ED7 ee ff
STHX opr
Store H:X in M
(M:M + 1) ← (H:X)
0
–
–
–
↕ ↕ – DIR
35
8E
dd
4
1
STOP
Enable IRQ Pin; Stop Oscillator
I ← 0; Stop Oscillator
–
0
–
–
– INH
STX opr
STX opr
DIR
EXT
IX2
BF
CF
DF
EF
FF
dd
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
hh ll
ee ff
ff
STX opr,X
STX opr,X
STX ,X
STX opr,SP
STX opr,SP
Store X in M
M ← (X)
0
–
–
↕ ↕ – IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
9EEF ff
9EDF ee ff
Technical Data
96
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
I
N Z C
SUB #opr
SUB opr
SUB opr
SUB opr,X
SUB opr,X
SUB ,X
SUB opr,SP
SUB opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
A0
B0
C0
D0
E0
F0
ii
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Subtract
A ← (A) – (M)
↕ –
–
↕ ↕ ↕
SP1
SP2
9EE0 ff
9ED0 ee ff
PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR)
SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1
SWI
Software Interrupt
–
–
1
–
–
– INH
83
9
PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte
PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte
TAP
TAX
TPA
Transfer A to CCR
Transfer A to X
CCR ← (A)
X ← (A)
↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ INH
84
97
85
2
1
1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
Transfer CCR to A
A ← (CCR)
TST opr
TSTA
TSTX
TST opr,X
TST ,X
TST opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
3D
4D
5D
6D
7D
dd
ff
3
1
1
3
2
4
Test for Negative or Zero
(A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00
0
–
–
↕ ↕ –
SP1
9E6D ff
TSX
TXA
TXS
Transfer SP to H:X
Transfer X to A
H:X ← (SP) + 1
A ← (X)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
– INH
95
9F
94
2
1
2
Transfer H:X to SP
(SP) ← (H:X) – 1
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
97
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Continued)
Effect on
CCR
Source
Form
Operation
Description
V H
Any bit
opr Operand (one or two bytes)
PC Program counter
PCH Program counter high byte
PCL Program counter low byte
REL Relative addressing mode
Relative program counter offset byte
Relative program counter offset byte
SP1 Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode
SP2 Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode
SP Stack pointer
I N Z C
A
C
Accumulator
Carry/borrow bit
n
CCR Condition code register
dd Direct address of operand
dd rr Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction
DD
DIR
DIX+ Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode
ee ff High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing
EXT Extended addressing mode
ff
H
H
hh ll High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing
I
ii
IMD Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode
IMM Immediate addressing mode
INH
IX
Direct to direct addressing mode
Direct addressing mode
rel
rr
Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing
Half-carry bit
Index register high byte
U
V
X
Z
&
|
Undefined
Overflow bit
Index register low byte
Zero bit
Logical AND
Logical OR
Logical EXCLUSIVE OR
Contents of
Interrupt mask
Immediate operand byte
Inherent addressing mode
Indexed, no offset addressing mode
Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode
( )
–( ) Negation (two’s complement)
IX+
#
Immediate value
Sign extend
Loaded with
If
IX+D Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode
IX1 Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode
IX1+ Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode
«
←
?
IX2
M
N
Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode
Memory location
Negative bit
:
↕
—
Concatenated with
Set or cleared
Not affected
Technical Data
98
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Table 6-2. Opcode Map
Bit Manipulation Branch
Read-Modify-Write
Control
Register/Memory
DIR
DIR
REL
DIR
3
INH
4
INH
IX1
SP1
9E6
IX
7
INH
INH
IMM
A
DIR
B
EXT
C
IX2
SP2
IX1
E
SP1
9EE
IX
F
MSB
0
1
2
5
6
8
9
D
9ED
LSB
5
4
3
4
1
NEGA
INH
1
NEGX
INH
4
5
3
NEG
IX
4
CBEQ
IX+
2
DAA
INH
3
COM
IX
3
LSR
IX
4
CPHX
DIR
3
ROR
IX
3
ASR
IX
3
LSL
IX
3
ROL
IX
3
DEC
IX
4
DBNZ
IX
3
INC
IX
2
TST
IX
7
3
2
3
4
4
5
3
4
2
SUB
IX
2
CMP
IX
2
SBC
IX
2
CPX
IX
2
AND
IX
2
BIT
IX
2
LDA
IX
2
STA
IX
2
EOR
IX
2
ADC
IX
2
ORA
IX
2
ADD
IX
2
JMP
IX
4
JSR
IX
2
LDX
IX
0
BRSET0 BSET0
BRA
NEG
NEG
NEG
RTI
BGE
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
REL 2 DIR
3
BRN
REL 3 DIR
3
BHI
REL
3
BLS
REL 2 DIR
3
BCC
REL 2 DIR
3
BCS
REL 2 DIR
3
BNE
REL 2 DIR
3
BEQ
REL 2 DIR
3
1
1
2
IX1 3 SP1
5
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
INH
4
RTS
INH
2
2
2
2
1
1
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
EXT 3 IX2
4
CMP
EXT 3 IX2
4
SBC
EXT 3 IX2
4
CPX
EXT 3 IX2
4
AND
EXT 3 IX2
4
BIT
EXT 3 IX2
4
LDA
EXT 3 IX2
4
STA
EXT 3 IX2
4
EOR
EXT 3 IX2
4
ADC
EXT 3 IX2
4
ORA
EXT 3 IX2
4
ADD
EXT 3 IX2
3
JMP
EXT 3 IX2
5
JSR
EXT 3 IX2
4
LDX
EXT 3 IX2
4
STX
EXT 3 IX2
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
SP2
5
CMP
SP2
5
SBC
SP2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IX1
3
CMP
IX1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
SP1
4
CMP
SP1
4
SBC
SP1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
4
4
6
CBEQ
SP1
2
CMP
3
4
1
2
BRCLR0 BCLR0
CBEQ CBEQA CBEQX CBEQ
BLT
CMP
CMP
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
3
IMM 3 IMM 3 IX1+
4
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
5
7
3
3
BGT
2
SBC
3
SBC
4
SBC
3
BRSET1 BSET1
MUL
INH
DIV
INH
NSA
SBC
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
1
1
2
2
3
2
2
2
2
2
INH
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
3
BLE
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
2
TXS
INH
IX1
4
1
1
4
COM
IX1
4
LSR
IX1
3
CPHX
IMM
4
ROR
IX1
4
ASR
IX1
4
LSL
IX1
4
ROL
IX1
4
DEC
IX1
5
COM
SP1
5
LSR
SP1
9
2
CPX
3
CPX
4
CPX
5
3
4
3
BRCLR1 BCLR1
COM
COMA
COMX
SWI
CPX
CPX
CPX
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
INH
1
INH
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
INH
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
LSR
1
LSRA
INH
1
LSRX
INH
2
2
AND
IMM 2 DIR
2
BIT
IMM 2 DIR
2
LDA
IMM 2 DIR
2
AIS
IMM 2 DIR
2
EOR
IMM 2 DIR
2
ADC
IMM 2 DIR
2
ORA
IMM 2 DIR
2
ADD
IMM 2 DIR
3
AND
4
AND
5
3
4
4
BRSET2 BSET2
TAP
AND
AND
AND
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
3
1
INH
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
3
4
1
TPA
INH
2
3
BIT
4
BIT
5
BIT
SP2
3
BIT
IX1
4
BIT
SP1
5
BRCLR2 BCLR2
STHX
LDHX
LDHX
TSX
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
IMM 2 DIR
INH
4
1
1
5
ROR
SP1
5
ASR
SP1
5
LSL
SP1
5
ROL
SP1
5
DEC
SP1
6
DBNZ
SP1
5
INC
SP1
4
TST
SP1
2
PULA
INH
2
PSHA
INH
2
PULX
INH
2
PSHX
INH
2
PULH
INH
2
PSHH
INH
1
CLRH
INH
3
LDA
4
LDA
5
3
4
6
BRSET3 BSET3
ROR
RORA
RORX
LDA
LDA
LDA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
INH
1
INH
3
3
3
3
3
4
3
3
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
ASR
1
ASRA
INH
1
LSLA
INH
1
ROLA
INH
1
DECA
INH
1
ASRX
INH
1
LSLX
INH
1
ROLX
INH
1
DECX
INH
1
3
STA
4
STA
5
3
4
7
BRCLR3 BCLR3
TAX
STA
STA
STA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
INH
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
LSL
1
3
EOR
4
EOR
5
3
4
8
BRSET4 BSET4 BHCC
CLC
EOR
EOR
EOR
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
REL 2 DIR
3
INH
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
ROL
1
3
ADC
4
ADC
5
3
4
9
BRCLR4 BCLR4 BHCS
SEC
ADC
ADC
ADC
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
REL 2 DIR
3
BPL
REL 2 DIR
3
BMI
REL 3 DIR
INH
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
DEC
2
CLI
INH
2
SEI
INH
3
ORA
4
ORA
5
3
4
A
B
C
D
E
F
BRSET5 BSET5
ORA
ORA
ORA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
SP2
IX1
SP1
5
3
3
5
3
ADD
4
ADD
5
3
4
ADD
SP1
BRCLR5 BCLR5
DBNZ DBNZA DBNZX DBNZ
ADD
ADD
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
1
1
3
1
INH
1
2
1
1
2
1
INH
1
3
2
2
3
2
IX1
4
INC
IX1
3
SP2
IX1
3
4
INC
1
2
JMP
4
JMP
3
BRSET6 BSET6
BMC
INCA
INCX
RSP
JMP
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
REL 2 DIR
INH
1
TSTA
INH
5
MOV
DD
1
CLRA
INH
INH
1
TSTX
INH
4
MOV
DIX+
1
CLRX
INH
INH
2
DIR
4
IX1
3
BMS
REL 2 DIR
3
BIL
3
TST
1
4
BSR
REL 2 DIR
2
LDX
IMM 2 DIR
2
AIX
IMM 2 DIR
6
JSR
5
BRCLR6 BCLR6
TST
IX1
NOP
JSR
JSR
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
INH
2
2
2
IX1
4
MOV
IMD
3
CLR
IX1
4
1
STOP
INH
1
WAIT
INH
3
LDX
4
LDX
5
LDX
SP2
3
4
LDX
SP1
BRSET7 BSET7
MOV
IX+D
LDX
*
1
TXA
INH
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
REL
3
BIH
1
1
4
4
IX1
3
3
3
CLR
4
CLR
SP1
2
CLR
IX
3
STX
4
STX
5
3
4
2
STX
IX
BRCLR7 BCLR7
DIR DIR
STX
STX
STX
3
2
REL 2 DIR
3
1
SP2
IX1
SP1
INH Inherent
IMM Immediate
DIR Direct
EXT Extended
DD Direct-Direct
IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed
*Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions
REL Relative
SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset
SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset
IX+ Indexed, No Offset with
Post Increment
IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with
Post Increment
MSB
LSB
0
High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
Cycles
IX
Indexed, No Offset
IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset
IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset
IMD Immediate-Direct
5
Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
0
BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic
DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode
3
Ce ntra l Proc e ssor Unit (CPU)
Technical Data
100
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 7. Osc illa tor (OSC)
7.1 Conte nts
7.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
7.3
7.3.1
7.3.2
Clock Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
CGM Reference Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
TBM Reference Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
7.4
7.5
7.6
Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
RC Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
X-tal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
7.7
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
CGM Oscillator Clock (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Oscillator Clock to Time Base Module (OSCCLK) . . . . . . .109
7.7.1
7.7.2
7.7.3
7.7.4
7.7.5
7.7.6
7.8
7.8.1
7.8.2
Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
7.9
Oscillator During Break Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
101
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Osc illa tor (OSC)
7.2 Introd uc tion
The oscillator module provides the reference clock for the clock
generator module (CGM), the timebase module (TBM), and other MCU
sub-systems.
The oscillator module consist of three types of oscillator circuits:
•
•
•
Internal oscillator
RC oscillator
Crystal (x-tal) oscillator
The reference clock for the CGM and other MCU sub-systems is
selected by:
•
•
MC68HC908SR12 — FLASH device — oscillator selected by
programming the mask option register located at $FF80.
MC68HC08SR12 — ROM device — oscillator selected by ROM-
mask layer at factory.
The reference clock for the timebase module (TBM) is selected by the
two bits, OSCCLK1 and OSCCLK0, in the CONFIG2 register.
The internal oscillator runs continuously after a POR or reset, and is
always available. The RC and crystal oscillator cannot run concurrently;
one is disabled while the other is selected; because the RC and x-tal
circuits share the same OSC1 pin.
Figure 7-1. shows the block diagram of the oscillator module.
Technical Data
102
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Oscillator (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Clock Selection
To CGM and others To CGM PLL
CGMXCLK CGMRCLK
To TBM
OSCCLK
MOR
CONFIG2
OSCCLK1
OSCCLK0
OSCSEL1
OSCSEL0
MUX
MUX
X
RC
I
X
RC
I
To SIM
(and COP)
XCLK
ICLK
RCCLK
X-TAL OSCILLATOR
RC OSCILLATOR
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
BUS CLOCK
From SIM
OSC1
OSC2
Figure 7-1. Oscillator Module Block Diagram
7.3 Cloc k Se le c tion
Reference clocks are selectable for the following sub-systems:
•
CGMXCLK and CGMRCLK — Reference clock for clock
generator module (CGM) and other MCU sub-systems other than
TBM and COP. This is the main reference clock for the MCU.
•
OSCCLK — Reference clock for timebase module (TBM).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
103
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Osc illa tor (OSC)
7.3.1 CGM Re fe re nc e Cloc k Se le c tion
The clock generator module (CGM) reference clock (CGMXCLK) is the
reference clock input to the MCU. It is selected by programming two bits
in a FLASH memory location; the mask option register (MOR), at $FF80.
See 5.6 Mask Option Register (MOR).
NOTE: On the ROM device, the oscillator is selected by a ROM-mask layer at
factory.
Address: $FF80
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
OSCSEL1 OSCSEL0
R
R
R
R
R
Erased:
Reset:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
U
R
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
=Reserved
Figure 7-2. Mask Option Register (MOR)
Table 7-1. CGMXCLK Clock Selection
OSCSEL1
OSCSEL0
CGMXCLK
—
OSC2 Pin
—
Comments
0
0
0
1
Not used
ICLK
fBUS
Internal oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
RC oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
Internal oscillator is available after each POR
or reset.
1
1
0
1
RCCLK
XCLK
fBUS
Inverting
output of
X-TAL
X-tal oscillator generates the CGMXCLK.
Internal oscillator is available after each POR
or reset.
NOTE: The internal oscillator is a free running oscillator and is available after
each POR or reset. It is turned-off in stop mode by clearing the
STOP_ICLKEN bit in CONFIG2.
Technical Data
104
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Oscillator (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Internal Oscillator
7.3.2 TBM Re fe re nc e Cloc k Se le c tion
The timebase module reference clock (OSCCLK) is selected by
configuring two bits in the CONFIG2 register, at $001D. See 5.5
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2).
Address: $001D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
STOP_
RCLKEN XCLKEN
STOP_
STOP_
ICLKEN
OSCCLK1 OSCCLK0
CDOEN SCIBDSRC
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 7-3. Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2)
Table 7-2. Timebase Module Reference Clock Selection
OSCCLK1
OSCCLK0
Timebase Clock Source
Internal oscillator (ICLK)
RC oscillator (RCCLK)
X-tal oscillator (XCLK)
Not used
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
NOTE: The RCCLK or XCLK is only available if that clock is selected as the
CGM reference clock, whereas the ICLK is always available.
7.4 Inte rna l Osc illa tor
The internal oscillator clock (ICLK) is a free running 24kHz clock that
requires no external components. It can be selected as the CGMXCLK
for the CGM and MCU sub-systems; and the OSCCLK clock for the
TBM. The ICLK is also the reference clock input to the computer
operating properly (COP) module.
Due to the simplicity of the internal oscillator, it does not have the
accuracy and stability of the RC oscillator or the x-tal oscillator.
Therefore, the ICLK is not suitable where an accurate bus clock is
required and it should not be used as the CGMRCLK to the CGM PLL.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
105
Oscillator (OSC)
Osc illa tor (OSC)
The internal oscillator by default is always available and is free running
after POR or reset. It can be stopped in Stop mode by setting the
STOP_ICLKEN bit before executing the STOP instruction.
Figure 7-4 shows the logical representation of components of the
internal oscillator circuitry.
From SIM
SIMOSCEN
From SIM
BUS CLOCK
To Clock Selection MUX
and COP
ICLK
CONFIG2
EN
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
STOP_ICLKEN
MCU
OSC2
Figure 7-4. Internal Oscillator
7.5 RC Osc illa tor
The RC oscillator circuit is designed for use with external R and C to
provide a clock source with tolerance less than 10%.
In its typical configuration, the RC oscillator requires two external
components, one R and one C. Component values should have a
tolerance of 1% or less, to obtain a clock source with less than 10%
tolerance. The oscillator configuration uses two components:
•
•
CEXT
REXT
Technical Data
106
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Oscillator (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
X-tal Oscillator
From SIM
SIMOSCEN
To Clock Selection MUX
RCCLK
From SIM
BUS CLOCK
CONFIG2
EN
STOP_RCLKEN
RC OSCILLATOR
MCU
OSC1
OSC2
See Section 24. for component value requirements.
V
DD
R
C
EXT
EXT
Figure 7-5. RC Oscillator
7.6 X-ta l Osc illa tor
The X-tal oscillator circuit is designed for use with an external crystal or
ceramic resonator to provide an accurate clock source.
In its typical configuration, the X-tal oscillator is connected in a Pierce
oscillator configuration, as shown in Figure 7-6. This figure shows only
the logical representation of the internal components and may not
represent actual circuitry. The oscillator configuration uses five
components:
•
•
•
•
•
Crystal, X1
Fixed capacitor, C1
Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor)
Feedback resistor, RB
Series resistor, RS (optional)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
107
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Osc illa tor (OSC)
From SIM
SIMOSCEN
To Clock Selection MUX
XCLK
CONFIG2
STOP_XCLKEN
MCU
OSC1
OSC2
R
X
B
RS*
*RS can be zero (shorted) when used with higher-frequency crystals.
Refer to manufacturer’s data.
1
See Section 24. for component value requirements.
C
C
2
1
Figure 7-6. Crystal Oscillator
The series resistor (RS) is included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce
oscillator guidelines and may not be required for all ranges of operation,
especially with high frequency crystals. Refer to the crystal
manufacturer’s data for more information.
7.7 I/ O Sig na ls
The following paragraphs describe the oscillator I/O signals.
7.7.1 Crysta l Am p lifie r Inp ut Pin (OSC1)
OSC1 pin is an input to the crystal oscillator amplifier or the input to the
RC oscillator circuit.
Technical Data
108
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Oscillator (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Oscillator (OSC)
Low Power Modes
7.7.2 Crysta l Am p lifie r Outp ut Pin (OSC2)
When the x-tal oscillator is selected, OSC2 pin is the output of the crystal
oscillator inverting amplifier.
When the RC oscillator or internal oscillator is selected, OSC2 pin is the
output of the internal bus clock.
7.7.3 Osc illa tor Ena b le Sig na l (SIMOSCEN)
The SIMOSCEN signal from the system integration module (SIM)
enables/disables the x-tal oscillator, the RC-oscillator, or the internal
oscillator circuit.
7.7.4 CGM Osc illa tor Cloc k (CGMXCLK)
The CGMXCLK clock is output from the x-tal oscillator, RC oscillator or
the internal oscillator. This clock drives to CGM and other MCU sub-
systems.
7.7.5 CGM Re fe re nc e Cloc k (CGMRCLK)
This is buffered signal of CGMXCLK, it is used by the CGM as the
phase-locked-loop (PLL) reference clock.
7.7.6 Osc illa tor Cloc k to Tim e Ba se Mod ule (OSCCLK)
The OSCCLK is the reference clock that drives the timebase module.
See Section 12. Timebase Module (TBM).
7.8 Low Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low-power
consumption standby modes.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
109
Oscillator (OSC)
Osc illa tor (OSC)
7.8.1 Wa it Mod e
The WAIT instruction has no effect on the oscillator module. CGMXCLK
continues to drive to the clock generator module, and OSCCLK
continues to drive the timebase module.
7.8.2 Stop Mod e
The STOP instruction disables the x-tal or the RC oscillator circuit, and
hence the CGMXCLK clock stops running. For continuous x-tal or RC
oscillator operation in stop mode, set the STOP_XCLKEN (for x-tal) or
STOP_RCLKEN (for RC) bit to logic 1 before entering stop mode.
The internal oscillator clock continues operation in stop mode. It can be
disabled by setting the STOP_ICLKEN bit to logic 1 before entering stop
mode.
7.9 Osc illa tor During Bre a k Mod e
The oscillator continues to drive CGMXCLK when the device enters the
break state.
Technical Data
110
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Oscillator (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 8. Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.1 Conte nts
8.2
8.3
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
8.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Oscillator Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. . . . . . . . . .118
Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
8.4.1
8.4.2
8.4.3
8.4.4
8.4.5
8.4.6
8.4.7
8.4.8
8.4.9
8.5
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
PLL Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Oscillator Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . .126
CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
CGM VCO Clock Output (CGMVCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.5.3
8.5.4
8.5.5
8.5.6
8.5.7
8.5.8
8.6
CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
PLL Multiplier Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
PLL VCO Range Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
PLL Reference Divider Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
8.6.1
8.6.2
8.6.3
8.6.4
8.6.5
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
111
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.7
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
8.8
Special Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
CGM During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
8.8.1
8.8.2
8.8.3
8.9
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Choosing a Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
8.9.1
8.9.2
8.9.3
8.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the clock generator module (CGM). The CGM
generates the base clock signal, CGMOUT, which is based on either the
oscillator clock divided by two or the divided phase-locked loop (PLL)
clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two. CGMOUT is the clock from which the
SIM derives the system clocks, including the bus clock, which is at a
frequency of CGMOUT÷2. The PLL clock, CGMVCLK (an integer
multiple of CGMPCLK) provides clock reference for the PWM and
analog modules.
The PLL is a frequency generator designed for use with a low frequency
crystal (typically 32.768kHz) to generate a base frequency and dividing
to a maximum bus frequency of 8MHz.
Technical Data
112
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Features
8.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the CGM include:
•
•
Phase-locked loop with output frequency in integer multiples of an
integer dividend of the crystal reference
Low-frequency crystal operation with low-power operation and
high-output frequency resolution
•
•
Programmable prescaler for power-of-two increases in frequency
Programmable hardware voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) for
low-jitter operation
•
•
•
•
Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation
Automatic frequency lock detector
CPU interrupt on entry or exit from locked condition
Configuration register bit to allow oscillator operation during stop
mode
8.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
The CGM consists of three major sub-modules:
•
•
Oscillator module — The oscillator module generates the constant
reference frequency clock, CGMRCLK (buffered CGMXCLK).
Phase-locked loop (PLL) — The PLL generates the
programmable VCO frequency clock, CGMVCLK, and the divided,
CGMPCLK. The CGMVCLK provides the input reference clock to
the PWM and analog modules.
•
Base clock selector circuit — This software-controlled circuit
selects either CGMXCLK divided by two or the divided VCO clock,
CGMPCLK, divided by two as the base clock, CGMOUT. The SIM
derives the system clocks from either CGMOUT or CGMXCLK.
Figure 8-1 shows the structure of the CGM.
Figure 8-2 is a summary of the CGM registers.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
113
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
OSCILLATOR (OSC) MODULE
OSC2
See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC).
ICLK
To SIM (and COP)
OSCCLK
CGMXCLK
CGMRCLK
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
RC OSCILLATOR
OSC1
To Timebase Module (TBM)
T0 ADC, Analog Module
MUX
OSCSEL[1:0]
OSCCLK[1:0]
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
SIMOSCEN
From SIM
PHASE-LOCKED LOOP (PLL)
CGMRDV
CGMRCLK
CGMXFC
REFERENCE
DIVIDER
CGMOUT
To SIM
A
B
CLOCK
SELECT
CIRCUIT
1
÷ 2
BCS
S*
R
SIMDIV2
From SIM
*WHEN S = 1,
CGMOUT = B
RDS[3:0]
V
V
SSA
DDA
VPR[1:0]
VRS[7:0]
L
E
2
CGMPCLK
VOLTAGE
CONTROLLED
OSCILLATOR
CGMVCLK
PHASE
DETECTOR
LOOP
FILTER
To PWM,
Analog Module
PLL ANALOG
AUTOMATIC
MODE
CONTROL
CGMINT
To SIM
LOCK
DETECTOR
INTERRUPT
CONTROL
LOCK
AUTO
ACQ
PLLIE
PLLF
MUL[11:0]
PRE[1:0]
P
N
2
CGMVDV
FREQUENCY
DIVIDER
FREQUENCY
DIVIDER
Figure 8-1. CGM Block Diagram
Technical Data
114
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
PLLIE
0
6
5
PLLON
1
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
VPR0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
PLLF
BCS
PRE1
PRE0
VPR1
PLL Control Register
(PTCL)
$0036
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LOCK
PLL Bandwidth Control
AUTO
ACQ
R
$0037
$0038
Register Write:
(PBWC)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUL11
0
0
MUL10
0
0
MUL9
0
Read:
PLL Multiplier Select
MUL8
0
Register High Write:
(PMSH)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Read:
PLL Multiplier Select
MUL7
0
MUL6
1
MUL5
0
MUL4
0
MUL3
0
MUL2
0
MUL1
0
MUL0
0
$0039
Register Low Write:
(PMSL)
Reset:
Read:
PLL VCO Range Select
VRS7
VRS6
VRS5
VRS4
VRS3
0
VRS2
0
VRS1
0
VRS0
0
$003A
$003B
NOTES:
Register Write:
(PMRS)
Reset:
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
PLL Reference Divider
RDS3
RDS2
RDS1
0
RDS0
1
Select Register Write:
(PMDS)
0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
1. When AUTO = 0, PLLIE is forced clear and is read-only.
2. When AUTO = 0, PLLF and LOCK read as clear.
3. When AUTO = 1, ACQ is read-only.
4. When PLLON = 0 or VRS7:VRS0 = $0, BCS is forced clear and is read-only.
5. When PLLON = 1, the PLL programming register is read-only.
6. When BCS = 1, PLLON is forced set and is read-only.
Figure 8-2. CGM I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
115
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.4.1 Osc illa tor Mod ule
The oscillator module provides two clock outputs CGMXCLK and
CGMRCLK to the CGM module. CGMXCLK when selected, is driven to
SIM module to generate the system bus clock. CGMRCLK is used by the
phase-lock-loop to provide a higher frequency system bus clock and the
reference clock for the PWM and analog modules. The oscillator module
also provides the reference clock for the timebase module (TBM). See
Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) for detailed oscillator circuit description.
See Section 12. Timebase Module (TBM) for detailed description on
TBM. See Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) for detailed
description on PWM module.
8.4.2 Pha se -Loc ke d Loop Circ uit (PLL)
The PLL is a frequency generator that can operate in either acquisition
mode or tracking mode, depending on the accuracy of the output
frequency. The PLL can change between acquisition and tracking
modes either automatically or manually.
8.4.3 PLL Circ uits
The PLL consists of these circuits:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO)
Reference divider
Frequency pre-scaler
Modulo VCO frequency divider
Phase detector
Loop filter
Lock detector
Technical Data
116
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
The operating range of the VCO is programmable for a wide range of
frequencies and for maximum immunity to external noise, including
supply and CGMXFC noise. The VCO frequency is bound to a range
from roughly one-half to twice the center-of-range frequency, fVRS
.
Modulating the voltage on the CGMXFC pin changes the frequency
within this range. By design, fVRS is equal to the nominal center-of-range
frequency, fNOM, (38.4 kHz) times a linear factor, L, and a power-of-two
factor, E, or (L × 2E)fNOM
.
CGMRCLK is the PLL reference clock, a buffered version of CGMXCLK.
CGMRCLK runs at a frequency, fRCLK, and is fed to the PLL through a
programmable modulo reference divider, which divides fRCLK by a
factor, R. The divider’s output is the final reference clock, CGMRDV,
running at a frequency, fRDV = fRCLK/R. With an external crystal
(30kHz–100kHz), always set R = 1 for specified performance. With an
external high-frequency clock source, use R to divide the external
frequency to between 30kHz and 100kHz.
The VCO’s output clock, CGMVCLK, running at a frequency, fVCLK, is
fed back through a programmable pre-scaler divider and a
programmable modulo divider. The pre-scaler divides the VCO clock by
a power-of-two factor P (the CGMPCLK) and the modulo divider reduces
the VCO clock by a factor, N. The dividers’ output is the VCO feedback
clock, CGMVDV, running at a frequency, fVDV = fVCLK/(N × 2P). (See
8.4.6 Programming the PLL for more information.)
The phase detector then compares the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV,
with the final reference clock, CGMRDV. A correction pulse is generated
based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter
then slightly alters the DC voltage on the external capacitor connected
to CGMXFC based on the width and direction of the correction pulse.
The filter can make fast or slow corrections depending on its mode,
described in 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. The value of the
external capacitor and the reference frequency determines the speed of
the corrections and the stability of the PLL.
The lock detector compares the frequencies of the VCO feedback clock,
CGMVDV, and the final reference clock, CGMRDV. Therefore, the
speed of the lock detector is directly proportional to the final reference
frequency, fRDV. The circuit determines the mode of the PLL and the lock
condition based on this comparison.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
117
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.4.4 Ac q uisition a nd Tra c king Mod e s
The PLL filter is manually or automatically configurable into one of two
operating modes:
•
Acquisition mode — In acquisition mode, the filter can make large
frequency corrections to the VCO. This mode is used at PLL start
up or when the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the VCO
frequency is far off the desired frequency. When in acquisition
mode, the ACQ bit is clear in the PLL bandwidth control register.
(See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.)
•
Tracking mode — In tracking mode, the filter makes only small
corrections to the frequency of the VCO. PLL jitter is much lower
in tracking mode, but the response to noise is also slower. The
PLL enters tracking mode when the VCO frequency is nearly
correct, such as when the PLL is selected as the base clock
source. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) The PLL is
automatically in tracking mode when not in acquisition mode or
when the ACQ bit is set.
8.4.5 Ma nua l a nd Autom a tic PLL Ba nd wid th Mod e s
The PLL can change the bandwidth or operational mode of the loop filter
manually or automatically. Automatic mode is recommended for most
users.
In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the lock detector
automatically switches between acquisition and tracking modes.
Automatic bandwidth control mode also is used to determine when the
VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is safe to use as the source for the base clock,
CGMOUT. (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) If PLL
interrupts are enabled, the software can wait for a PLL interrupt request
and then check the LOCK bit. If interrupts are disabled, software can poll
the LOCK bit continuously (during PLL start-up, usually) or at periodic
intervals. In either case, when the LOCK bit is set, the VCO clock is safe
to use as the source for the base clock. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector
Circuit.) If the VCO is selected as the source for the base clock and the
LOCK bit is clear, the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the
software must take appropriate action, depending on the application.
(See 8.7 Interrupts for information and precautions on using interrupts.)
Technical Data
118
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
The following conditions apply when the PLL is in automatic bandwidth
control mode:
•
The ACQ bit (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) is a
read-only indicator of the mode of the filter. (See 8.4.4
Acquisition and Tracking Modes.)
•
The ACQ bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain
tolerance and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a
certain tolerance. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time
Specifications for more information.)
•
•
The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the
PLL.
The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain
tolerance and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a
certain tolerance. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time
Specifications for more information.)
•
CPU interrupts can occur if enabled (PLLIE = 1) when the PLL’s
lock condition changes, toggling the LOCK bit. (See 8.6.1 PLL
Control Register.)
The PLL also may operate in manual mode (AUTO = 0). Manual mode
is used by systems that do not require an indicator of the lock condition
for proper operation. Such systems typically operate well below
fBUSMAX
.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
119
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
The following conditions apply when in manual mode:
•
ACQ is a writable control bit that controls the mode of the filter.
Before turning on the PLL in manual mode, the ACQ bit must be
clear.
•
Before entering tracking mode (ACQ = 1), software must wait a
given time, tACQ (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time
Specifications.), after turning on the PLL by setting PLLON in the
PLL control register (PCTL).
•
Software must wait a given time, tAL, after entering tracking mode
before selecting the PLL as the clock source to CGMOUT
(BCS = 1).
•
•
The LOCK bit is disabled.
CPU interrupts from the CGM are disabled.
8.4.6 Prog ra m m ing the PLL
The following procedure shows how to program the PLL.
NOTE: The round function in the following equations means that the real
number should be rounded to the nearest integer number.
1. Choose the desired bus frequency, fBUSDES, or the desired VCO
frequency, fVCLKDES; and then solve for the other.
The relationship between fBUS and fVCLK is governed by the
equation:
fVCLK = 2P × fCGMPCLK = 2P × 4 × fBUS
where P is the power of two multiplier, and can be 0, 1, 2, or 3
2. Choose a practical PLL reference frequency, fRCLK, and the
reference clock divider, R. Typically, the reference is 32.768kHz
and R = 1.
Frequency errors to the PLL are corrected at a rate of fRCLK/R. For
stability and lock time reduction, this rate must be as fast as
possible. The VCO frequency must be an integer multiple of this
rate.
Technical Data
120
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
The relationship between the VCO frequency, fVCLK, and the
reference frequency, fRCLK, is
P
2 N
R
fVCLK = ----------- (f RCLK
)
where N is the integer range multiplier, between 1 and 4095.
In cases where desired bus frequency has some tolerance,
choose fRCLK to a value determined either by other module
requirements (such as modules which are clocked by CGMXCLK),
cost requirements, or ideally, as high as the specified range
allows. See Section 24. Electrical Specifications. Choose the
reference divider, R = 1.
When the tolerance on the bus frequency is tight, choose fRCLK to
an integer divisor of fBUSDES, and R = 1. If fRCLK cannot meet this
requirement, use the following equation to solve for R with
practical choices of fRCLK, and choose the fRCLK that gives the
lowest R.
fVCLKDES
fVCLKDES
R = round RMAX
×
------------------------- – integer -------------------------
fRCLK
fRCLK
3. Calculate N:
R × fVCLKDES
N = round ------------------------------------
f
RCLK × 2P
4. Calculate and verify the adequacy of the VCO and bus
frequencies fVCLK and fBUS
.
P
2 N
R
fVCLK = ----------- (f RCLK
)
fVCLK
2P × 4
fBUS
=
-----------
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
121
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
5. Select the VCO’s power-of-two range multiplier E, according to
this table:
Frequency Range
E
0
1
2
0 < fVCLK < 9,830,400
9,830,400 ≤ fVCLK < 19,660,800
19,660,800 ≤ fVCLK < 39,321,600
NOTE: Do not program E to a value of 3.
6. Select a VCO linear range multiplier, L, where fNOM = 38.4kHz
fVCLK
L = round --------------------------
2E × fNOM
7. Calculate and verify the adequacy of the VCO programmed
center-of-range frequency, fVRS. The center-of-range frequency is
the midpoint between the minimum and maximum frequencies
attainable by the PLL.
fVRS = (L × 2E)fNOM
For proper operation,
f
NOM × 2E
--------------------------
VRS – fVCLK ≤
f
2
8. Verify the choice of P, R, N, E, and L by comparing fVCLK to fVRS
and fVCLKDES. For proper operation, fVCLK must be within the
application’s tolerance of fVCLKDES, and fVRS must be as close as
possible to fVCLK.
NOTE: Exceeding the recommended maximum bus frequency or VCO
frequency can crash the MCU.
Technical Data
122
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
9. Program the PLL registers accordingly:
a. In the PRE bits of the PLL control register (PCTL), program
the binary equivalent of P.
b. In the VPR bits of the PLL control register (PCTL), program
the binary equivalent of E.
c. In the PLL multiplier select register low (PMSL) and the PLL
multiplier select register high (PMSH), program the binary
equivalent of N.
d. In the PLL VCO range select register (PMRS), program the
binary coded equivalent of L.
e. In the PLL reference divider select register (PMDS), program
the binary coded equivalent of R.
NOTE: The values for P, E, N, L, and R can only be programmed when the PLL
is off (PLLON = 0).
Table 8-1 provides numeric examples (numbers are in hexadecimal
notation):
Table 8-1. Numeric Examples
fBUS
fRCLK
CGMVCLK
8.0 MHz
CGMPCLK
8.0 MHz
R
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
N
P
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
2
3
E
0
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
L
2.0 MHz
32.768 kHz
F5
D1
80
83
D1
80
82
C0
D0
D0
D0
D0
9.8304 MHz
10.0 MHz
16 MHz
9.8304 MHz
10.0 MHz
16 MHz
2.4576 MHz 32.768 kHz
12C
132
1E9
258
263
384
3D1
1E9
F5
2.5 MHz
4.0 MHz
32.768 kHz
32.768 kHz
19.6608 MHz 19.6608 MHz 4.9152 MHz 32.768 kHz
20 MHz 20 MHz 5.0 MHz 32.768 kHz
29.4912 MHz 29.4912 MHz 7.3728 MHz 32.768 kHz
32 MHz
32 MHz
32 MHz
32 MHz
32 MHz
16 MHz
8 MHz
4 MHz
8.0 MHz
4.0 MHz
2.0 MHz
1.0 MHz
32.768 kHz
32.768 kHz
32.768 kHz
32.768 kHz
7B
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
123
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.4.7 Sp e c ia l Prog ra m m ing Exc e p tions
The programming method described in 8.4.6 Programming the PLL
does not account for three possible exceptions. A value of 0 for R, N, or
L is meaningless when used in the equations given. To account for these
exceptions:
•
•
A 0 value for R or N is interpreted exactly the same as a value of 1.
A 0 value for L disables the PLL and prevents its selection as the
source for the base clock.
(See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.)
8.4.8 Ba se Cloc k Se le c tor Circ uit
This circuit is used to select either the oscillator clock, CGMXCLK, or the
divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, as the source of the base clock,
CGMOUT. The two input clocks go through a transition control circuit
that waits up to three CGMXCLK cycles and three CGMPCLK cycles to
change from one clock source to the other. During this time, CGMOUT
is held in stasis. The output of the transition control circuit is then divided
by two to correct the duty cycle. Therefore, the bus clock frequency,
which is one-half of the base clock frequency, is one-fourth the
frequency of the selected clock (CGMXCLK or CGMPCLK).
The BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) selects which clock drives
CGMOUT. The divided VCO clock cannot be selected as the base clock
source if the PLL is not turned on. The PLL cannot be turned off if the
divided VCO clock is selected. The PLL cannot be turned on or off
simultaneously with the selection or deselection of the divided VCO
clock. The divided VCO clock also cannot be selected as the base clock
source if the factor L is programmed to a 0. This value would set up a
condition inconsistent with the operation of the PLL, so that the PLL
would be disabled and the oscillator clock would be forced as the source
of the base clock.
Technical Data
124
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
I/O Signals
8.4.9 CGM Exte rna l Conne c tions
In its typical configuration, the CGM requires up to four external
components.
Figure 8-3 shows the external components for the PLL:
•
•
Bypass capacitor, CBYP
Filter network
Care should be taken with PCB routing in order to minimize signal cross
talk and noise. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for
routing information, filter network and its effects on PLL performance.)
MCU
CGMXFC
V
V
DDA
SSA
V
DD
10 kΩ
C
0.1 µF
BYP
0.01 µF
0.033 µF
Note: Filter network in box can be replaced with a 0.47µF capacitor, but will degrade stability.
Figure 8-3. CGM External Connections
8.5 I/ O Sig na ls
The following paragraphs describe the CGM I/O signals.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
125
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.5.1 Exte rna l Filte r Ca p a c itor Pin (CGMXFC)
The CGMXFC pin is required by the loop filter to filter out phase
corrections. An external filter network is connected to this pin. (See
Figure 8-3.)
NOTE: To prevent noise problems, the filter network should be placed as close
to the CGMXFC pin as possible, with minimum routing distances and no
routing of other signals across the network.
8.5.2 PLL Ana log Powe r Pin (VDDA
)
VDDA is a power pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect the
VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as the VDD pin.
NOTE: Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
8.5.3 PLL Ana log Ground Pin (VSSA
)
V
SSA is a ground pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect
the VSSA pin to the same voltage potential as the VSS pin.
NOTE: Route VSSA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
8.5.4 Osc illa tor Outp ut Fre q ue nc y Sig na l (CGMXCLK)
CGMXCLK is the oscillator output signal. It runs at the full speed of the
oscillator, and is generated directly from the crystal oscillator circuit, the
RC oscillator circuit, or the internal oscillator circuit.
8.5.5 CGM Re fe re nc e Cloc k (CGMRCLK)
CGMRCLK is a buffered version of CGMXCLK, this clock is the
reference clock for the phase-locked-loop circuit.
Technical Data
126
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
8.5.6 CGM VCO Cloc k Outp ut (CGMVCLK)
CGMVCLK is the clock output from the VCO. This clock can be used by
the pulse width modulator (PWM) module to generate high frequency
PWM signals. This clock is also used by the analog module as a
reference for signal sampling.
8.5.7 CGM Ba se Cloc k Outp ut (CGMOUT)
CGMOUT is the clock output of the CGM. This signal goes to the SIM,
which generates the MCU clocks. CGMOUT is a 50 percent duty cycle
clock running at twice the bus frequency. CGMOUT is software
programmable to be either the oscillator output, CGMXCLK, divided by
two or the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two.
8.5.8 CGM CPU Inte rrup t (CGMINT)
CGMINT is the interrupt signal generated by the PLL lock detector.
8.6 CGM Re g iste rs
The following registers control and monitor operation of the CGM:
•
•
•
•
•
PLL control register (PCTL)
(See 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.)
PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC)
(See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.)
PLL multiplier select registers (PMSH and PMSL)
(See 8.6.3 PLL Multiplier Select Registers.)
PLL VCO range select register (PMRS)
(See 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register.)
PLL reference divider select register (PMDS)
(See 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register.)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
127
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.6.1 PLL Control Re g iste r
The PLL control register (PCTL) contains the interrupt enable and flag
bits, the on/off switch, the base clock selector bit, the prescaler bits, and
the VCO power-of-two range selector bits.
Address: $0036
Bit 7
PLLIE
0
6
5
PLLON
1
4
BCS
0
3
PRE1
0
2
PRE0
0
1
VPR1
0
Bit 0
VPR0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PLLF
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-4. PLL Control Register (PCTL)
PLLIE — PLL Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the PLL to generate an interrupt request
when the LOCK bit toggles, setting the PLL flag, PLLF. When the
AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear,
PLLIE cannot be written and reads as logic 0. Reset clears the PLLIE
bit.
1 = PLL interrupts enabled
0 = PLL interrupts disabled
PLLF — PLL Interrupt Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set whenever the LOCK bit toggles. PLLF
generates an interrupt request if the PLLIE bit also is set. PLLF
always reads as logic 0 when the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth
control register (PBWC) is clear. Clear the PLLF bit by reading the
PLL control register. Reset clears the PLLF bit.
1 = Change in lock condition
0 = No change in lock condition
NOTE: Do not inadvertently clear the PLLF bit. Any read or read-modify-write
operation on the PLL control register clears the PLLF bit.
Technical Data
128
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
PLLON — PLL On Bit
This read/write bit activates the PLL and enables the VCO clock,
CGMVCLK. PLLON cannot be cleared if the VCO clock is driving the
base clock, CGMOUT (BCS = 1). (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector
Circuit.) Reset sets this bit so that the loop can stabilize as the MCU
is powering up.
1 = PLL on
0 = PLL off
BCS — Base Clock Select Bit
This read/write bit selects either the oscillator output, CGMXCLK, or
the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, as the source of the CGM output,
CGMOUT. CGMOUT frequency is one-half the frequency of the
selected clock. BCS cannot be set while the PLLON bit is clear. After
toggling BCS, it may take up to three CGMXCLK and three
CGMPCLK cycles to complete the transition from one source clock to
the other. During the transition, CGMOUT is held in stasis. (See 8.4.8
Base Clock Selector Circuit.) Reset clears the BCS bit.
1 = CGMPCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT
0 = CGMXCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT
NOTE: PLLON and BCS have built-in protection that prevents the base clock
selector circuit from selecting the VCO clock as the source of the base
clock if the PLL is off. Therefore, PLLON cannot be cleared when BCS
is set, and BCS cannot be set when PLLON is clear. If the PLL is off
(PLLON = 0), selecting CGMPCLK requires two writes to the PLL control
register. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.)
PRE1 and PRE0 — Prescaler Program Bits
These read/write bits control a prescaler that selects the prescaler
power-of-two multiplier, P. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6
Programming the PLL.) PRE1 and PRE0 cannot be written when
the PLLON bit is set. Reset clears these bits.
These prescaler bits affects the relationship between the VCO clock
and the final system bus clock.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
129
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
Table 8-2. PRE1 and PRE0 Programming
PRE1 and PRE0
00
P
0
1
2
3
Prescaler Multiplier
1
2
4
8
01
10
11
VPR1 and VPR0 — VCO Power-of-Two Range Select Bits
These read/write bits control the VCO’s hardware power-of-two range
multiplier E that, in conjunction with L (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits, 8.4.6
Programming the PLL, and 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select
Register.) controls the hardware center-of-range frequency, fVRS
.
VPR1:VPR0 cannot be written when the PLLON bit is set. Reset
clears these bits.
Table 8-3. VPR1 and VPR0 Programming
VCO Power-of-Two
Range Multiplier
VPR1 and VPR0
E
00
01
10
0
1
2
1
2
4
NOTE: Do not program E to a value of 3.
8.6.2 PLL Ba nd wid th Control Re g iste r
The PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC):
•
Selects automatic or manual (software-controlled) bandwidth
control mode
•
•
Indicates when the PLL is locked
In automatic bandwidth control mode, indicates when the PLL is in
acquisition or tracking mode
•
In manual operation, forces the PLL into acquisition or tracking
mode
Technical Data
130
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
Address: $0037
Bit 7
6
5
ACQ
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
R
Read:
AUTO
Write:
LOCK
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 8-5. PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWCR)
AUTO — Automatic Bandwidth Control Bit
This read/write bit selects automatic or manual bandwidth control.
When initializing the PLL for manual operation (AUTO = 0), clear the
ACQ bit before turning on the PLL. Reset clears the AUTO bit.
1 = Automatic bandwidth control
0 = Manual bandwidth control
LOCK — Lock Indicator Bit
When the AUTO bit is set, LOCK is a read-only bit that becomes set
when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is locked (running at the
programmed frequency). When the AUTO bit is clear, LOCK reads as
logic 0 and has no meaning. The write one function of this bit is
reserved for test, so this bit must always be written a 0. Reset clears
the LOCK bit.
1 = VCO frequency correct or locked
0 = VCO frequency incorrect or unlocked
ACQ — Acquisition Mode Bit
When the AUTO bit is set, ACQ is a read-only bit that indicates
whether the PLL is in acquisition mode or tracking mode. When the
AUTO bit is clear, ACQ is a read/write bit that controls whether the
PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode.
In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the last-written
value from manual operation is stored in a temporary location and is
recovered when manual operation resumes. Reset clears this bit,
enabling acquisition mode.
1 = Tracking mode
0 = Acquisition mode
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
131
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.6.3 PLL Multip lie r Se le c t Re g iste rs
The PLL multiplier select registers (PMSH and PMSL) contain the
programming information for the modulo feedback divider.
Address: $0038
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
MUL11
0
2
MUL10
0
1
MUL9
0
Bit 0
MUL8
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-6. PLL Multiplier Select Register High (PMSH)
Address: $0039
Bit 7
6
MUL6
1
5
MUL5
0
4
MUL4
0
3
MUL3
0
2
MUL2
0
1
MUL1
0
Bit 0
MUL0
0
Read:
MUL7
Write:
Reset:
0
Figure 8-7. PLL Multiplier Select Register Low (PMSL)
MUL[11:0] — Multiplier Select Bits
These read/write bits control the modulo feedback divider that selects
the VCO frequency multiplier N. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6
Programming the PLL.) A value of $0000 in the multiplier select
registers configure the modulo feedback divider the same as a value
of $0001. Reset initializes the registers to $0040 for a default multiply
value of 64.
NOTE: The multiplier select bits have built-in protection such that they cannot
be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1).
Technical Data
132
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
8.6.4 PLL VCO Ra ng e Se le c t Re g iste r
The PLL VCO range select register (PMRS) contains the programming
information required for the hardware configuration of the VCO.
Address: $003A
Bit 7
VRS7
0
6
VRS6
1
5
VRS5
0
4
VRS4
0
3
VRS3
0
2
VRS2
0
1
VRS1
0
Bit 0
VRS0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 8-8. PLL VCO Range Select Register (PMRS)
VRS[7:0] — VCO Range Select Bits
These read/write bits control the hardware center-of-range linear
multiplier L which, in conjunction with E (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits,
8.4.6 Programming the PLL, and 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.),
controls the hardware center-of-range frequency, fVRS. VRS[7:0]
cannot be written when the PLLON bit in the PCTL is set. (See 8.4.7
Special Programming Exceptions.)ꢀA value of $00 in the VCO
range select register disables the PLL and clears the BCS bit in the
PLL control register (PCTL). (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit
and 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions.). Reset initializes the
register to $40 for a default range multiply value of 64.
NOTE: The VCO range select bits have built-in protection such that they cannot
be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1) and such that the VCO clock
cannot be selected as the source of the base clock (BCS = 1) if the VCO
range select bits are all clear.
The PLL VCO range select register must be programmed correctly.
Incorrect programming can result in failure of the PLL to achieve lock.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
133
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.6.5 PLL Re fe re nc e Divid e r Se le c t Re g iste r
The PLL reference divider select register (PMDS) contains the
programming information for the modulo reference divider.
Address: $003B
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
RDS3
0
2
RDS2
0
1
RDS1
0
Bit 0
RDS0
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-9. PLL Reference Divider Select Register (PMDS)
RDS[3:0] — Reference Divider Select Bits
These read/write bits control the modulo reference divider that selects
the reference division factor, R. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6
Programming the PLL.) RDS[3:0] cannot be written when the
PLLON bit in the PCTL is set. A value of $00 in the reference divider
select register configures the reference divider the same as a value of
$01. (See 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions.) Reset
initializes the register to $01 for a default divide value of 1.
NOTE: The reference divider select bits have built-in protection such that they
cannot be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1).
NOTE: The default divide value of 1 is recommended for all applications.
Technical Data
134
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Interrupts
8.7 Inte rrup ts
When the AUTO bit is set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC),
the PLL can generate a CPU interrupt request every time the LOCK bit
changes state. The PLLIE bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) enables
CPU interrupts from the PLL. PLLF, the interrupt flag in the PCTL,
becomes set whether interrupts are enabled or not. When the AUTO bit
is clear, CPU interrupts from the PLL are disabled and PLLF reads as
logic 0.
Software should read the LOCK bit after a PLL interrupt request to see
if the request was due to an entry into lock or an exit from lock. When the
PLL enters lock, the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two can
be selected as the CGMOUT source by setting BCS in the PCTL. When
the PLL exits lock, the VCO clock frequency is corrupt, and appropriate
precautions should be taken. If the application is not frequency sensitive,
interrupts should be disabled to prevent PLL interrupt service routines
from impeding software performance or from exceeding stack
limitations.
NOTE: Software can select the CGMPCLK divided by two as the CGMOUT
source even if the PLL is not locked (LOCK = 0). Therefore, software
should make sure the PLL is locked before setting the BCS bit.
8.8 Sp e c ia l Mod e s
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby
modes.
8.8.1 Wa it Mod e
The WAIT instruction does not affect the CGM. Before entering wait
mode, software can disengage and turn off the PLL by clearing the BCS
and PLLON bits in the PLL control register (PCTL) to save power. Less
power-sensitive applications can disengage the PLL without turning it
off, so that the PLL clock is immediately available at WAIT exit. This
would be the case also when the PLL is to wake the MCU from wait
mode, such as when the PLL is first enabled and waiting for LOCK or
LOCK is lost.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
135
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
8.8.2 Stop Mod e
If the oscillator stop mode enable bit (STOP_ICLKEN, STOP_RCLKEN,
or STOP_XCLKEN in CONFIG2 register) for the selected oscillator is
configured to disabled the oscillator in stop mode, then the STOP
instruction disables the CGM (oscillator and phase locked loop) and
holds low all CGM outputs (CGMOUT, CGMVCLK, CGMPCLK, and
CGMINT).
If the STOP instruction is executed with the divided VCO clock,
CGMPCLK, divided by two driving CGMOUT, the PLL automatically
clears the BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL), thereby selecting
the oscillator clock, CGMXCLK, divided by two as the source of
CGMOUT. When the MCU recovers from STOP, the crystal clock
divided by two drives CGMOUT and BCS remains clear.
If the oscillator stop mode enable bit is configured for continuous
oscillator operation in stop mode, then the phase locked loop is shut off
but the CGMXCLK will continue to drive the SIM and other MCU sub-
systems.
8.8.3 CGM During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in
other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in
the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear
status bits during the break state. (See 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control
Register.)
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a
logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it
remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect the PLLF bit during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE
bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write
the PLL control register during the break state without affecting the PLLF
bit.
Technical Data
136
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
8.9 Ac q uisition/ Loc k Tim e Sp e c ific a tions
The acquisition and lock times of the PLL are, in many applications, the
most critical PLL design parameters. Proper design and use of the PLL
ensures the highest stability and lowest acquisition/lock times.
8.9.1 Ac q uisition/ Loc k Tim e De finitions
Typical control systems refer to the acquisition time or lock time as the
reaction time, within specified tolerances, of the system to a step input.
In a PLL, the step input occurs when the PLL is turned on or when it
suffers a noise hit. The tolerance is usually specified as a percent of the
step input or when the output settles to the desired value plus or minus
a percent of the frequency change. Therefore, the reaction time is
constant in this definition, regardless of the size of the step input. For
example, consider a system with a 5 percent acquisition time tolerance.
If a command instructs the system to change from 0Hz to 1MHz, the
acquisition time is the time taken for the frequency to reach
1MHz ±50kHz. 50kHz = 5% of the 1MHz step input. If the system is
operating at 1MHz and suffers a –100kHz noise hit, the acquisition time
is the time taken to return from 900kHz to 1MHz ±5kHz. 5kHz = 5% of
the 100kHz step input.
Other systems refer to acquisition and lock times as the time the system
takes to reduce the error between the actual output and the desired
output to within specified tolerances. Therefore, the acquisition or lock
time varies according to the original error in the output. Minor errors may
not even be registered. Typical PLL applications prefer to use this
definition because the system requires the output frequency to be within
a certain tolerance of the desired frequency regardless of the size of the
initial error.
8.9.2 Pa ra m e tric Influe nc e s on Re a c tion Tim e
Acquisition and lock times are designed to be as short as possible while
still providing the highest possible stability. These reaction times are not
constant, however. Many factors directly and indirectly affect the
acquisition time.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
137
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
The most critical parameter which affects the reaction times of the PLL
is the reference frequency, fRDV. This frequency is the input to the phase
detector and controls how often the PLL makes corrections. For stability,
the corrections must be small compared to the desired frequency, so
several corrections are required to reduce the frequency error.
Therefore, the slower the reference the longer it takes to make these
corrections. This parameter is under user control via the choice of crystal
frequency fXCLK and the R value programmed in the reference divider.
(See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits, 8.4.6 Programming the PLL, and 8.6.5 PLL
Reference Divider Select Register.)
Another critical parameter is the external filter network. The PLL
modifies the voltage on the VCO by adding or subtracting charge from
capacitors in this network. Therefore, the rate at which the voltage
changes for a given frequency error (thus change in charge) is
proportional to the capacitance. The size of the capacitor also is related
to the stability of the PLL. If the capacitor is too small, the PLL cannot
make small enough adjustments to the voltage and the system cannot
lock. If the capacitor is too large, the PLL may not be able to adjust the
voltage in a reasonable time. (See 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter.)
Also important is the operating voltage potential applied to VDDA. The
power supply potential alters the characteristics of the PLL. A fixed value
is best. Variable supplies, such as batteries, are acceptable if they vary
within a known range at very slow speeds. Noise on the power supply is
not acceptable, because it causes small frequency errors which
continually change the acquisition time of the PLL.
Temperature and processing also can affect acquisition time because
the electrical characteristics of the PLL change. The part operates as
specified as long as these influences stay within the specified limits.
External factors, however, can cause drastic changes in the operation of
the PLL. These factors include noise injected into the PLL through the
filter capacitor, filter capacitor leakage, stray impedances on the circuit
board, and even humidity or circuit board contamination.
Technical Data
138
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
8.9.3 Choosing a Filte r
As described in 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time, the
external filter network is critical to the stability and reaction time of the
PLL. The PLL is also dependent on reference frequency and supply
voltage.
Either of the filter networks in Figure 8-10 is recommended when using
a 32.768kHz reference clock (CGMRCLK). Figure 8-10 (a) is used for
applications requiring better stability. Figure 8-10 (b) is used in low-cost
applications where stability is not critical.
CGMXFC
CGMXFC
10 kΩ
0.01 µF
0.47 µF
0.033 µF
V
SSA
V
SSA
(a)
(b)
Figure 8-10. PLL Filter
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Technical Data
139
Cloc k Ge ne ra tor Mod ule (CGM)
Technical Data
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
140
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 9. Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.1 Conte nts
9.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
9.3
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Clock Start-up from POR or LVI Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
9.3.1
9.3.2
9.3.3
9.4
9.4.1
9.4.2
9.4.2.1
9.4.2.2
9.4.2.3
9.4.2.4
9.4.2.5
9.4.2.6
Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . .149
Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
9.5
SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . .151
SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
9.5.1
9.5.2
9.5.3
9.6
9.6.1
Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
SWI Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Interrupt Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Interrupt Status Register 3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
9.6.1.1
9.6.1.2
9.6.1.3
9.6.1.4
9.6.1.5
9.6.1.6
9.6.2
9.6.3
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
141
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.6.4
Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
9.7
9.7.1
9.7.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
9.8
SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.8.1
9.8.2
9.8.3
9.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the system integration module (SIM). Together
with the CPU, the SIM controls all MCU activities. A block diagram of the
SIM is shown in Figure 9-1. Table 9-1 is a summary of the SIM
input/output (I/O) registers. The SIM is a system state controller that
coordinates CPU and exception timing. The SIM is responsible for:
•
Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals:
– Stop/wait/reset/break entry and recovery
– Internal clock control
•
•
Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and COP
timeout
Interrupt control:
– Acknowledge timing
– Arbitration control timing
– Vector address generation
CPU enable/disable timing
•
•
Modular architecture expandable to 128 interrupt sources
Table 9-1 shows the internal signal names used in this section.
Technical Data
142
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Introduction
MODULE STOP
MODULE WAIT
CPU STOP (FROM CPU)
CPU WAIT (FROM CPU)
STOP/WAIT
CONTROL
SIMOSCEN (TO CGM, OSC)
SIM
COUNTER
COP CLOCK
ICLK (FROM OSC)
CGMOUT (FROM CGM)
÷ 2
CLOCK
CONTROL
VDD
CLOCK GENERATORS
INTERNAL CLOCKS
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
LVI (FROM LVI MODULE)
RESET
PIN LOGIC
POR CONTROL
MASTER
RESET
CONTROL
ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU)
ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS
MAP DECODERS)
RESET PIN CONTROL
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER
COP (FROM COP MODULE)
RESET
INTERRUPT SOURCES
CPU INTERFACE
INTERRUPT CONTROL
AND PRIORITY DECODE
Figure 9-1. SIM Block Diagram
Table 9-1. Signal Name Conventions
Signal Name
Description
Internal oscillator clock
ICLK
CGMXCLK
Selected oscillator clock from oscillator module
PLL output and the divided PLL output
CGMVCLK, CGMPCLK
CGMPCLK-based or oscillator-based clock output from CGM module
(Bus clock = CGMOUT ÷ 2)
CGMOUT
IAB
IDB
Internal address bus
Internal data bus
PORRST
IRST
Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM
Internal reset signal
R/W
Read/write signal
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
143
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SBSW
Note
0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SIM Break Status Register
(SBSR)
$FE00
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
Read: POR
Write:
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
0
LVI
0
SIM Reset Status Register
$FE01
(SRSR)
POR:
Read:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SIM Break Flag Control
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
Register Write:
(SBFCR)
Reset:
0
IF6
R
Read:
IF5
R
IF4
R
IF3
R
IF2
R
IF1
0
R
0
R
Interrupt Status Register 1
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R
(INT1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF14
R
IF13
R
IF12
R
IF11
R
IF10
R
IF9
IF8
R
IF7
R
Interrupt Status Register 2
(INT2)
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF17
IF16
R
IF15
R
Interrupt Status Register 3
(INT3)
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 9-2. SIM I/O Register Summary
9.3 SIM Bus Cloc k Control a nd Ge ne ra tion
The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and
peripherals on the MCU. The system clocks are generated from an
incoming clock, CGMOUT, as shown in Figure 9-3. This clock can come
from either the oscillator module or from the on-chip PLL. (See Section
8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).)
Technical Data
144
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
OSC2
OSC1
OSCCLK
TO TBM
OSCILLATOR (OSC) MODULE
CGMXCLK
TO TIM, ADC
ICLK
SIM COUNTER
SIMOSCEN
STOP MODE CLOCK
ENABLE SIGNALS
FROM CONFIG2
SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE
IT12
CGMRCLK
TO REST
OF MCU
CGMOUT
BUS CLOCK
GENERATORS
IT23
TO REST
OF MCU
÷ 2
PHASE-LOCKED LOOP (PLL)
PTC1
SIMDIV2
MONITOR MODE
USER MODE
CGMVCLK
TO PWM
Figure 9-3. CGM Clock Signals
9.3.1 Bus Tim ing
In user mode, the internal bus frequency is either the oscillator output
(CGMXCLK) divided by four or the divided PLL output (CGMPCLK)
divided by four.
9.3.2 Cloc k Sta rt-up from POR or LVI Re se t
When the power-on reset module or the low-voltage inhibit module
generates a reset, the clocks to the CPU and peripherals are inactive
and held in an inactive phase until after the 4096 ICLK cycle POR
timeout has completed. The RST pin is driven low by the SIM during this
entire period. The IBUS clocks start upon completion of the timeout.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
145
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.3.3 Cloc ks in Stop Mod e a nd Wa it Mod e
Upon exit from stop mode by an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM allows
ICLK to clock the SIM counter. The CPU and peripheral clocks do not
become active until after the stop delay timeout. This timeout is
selectable as 4096 or 32 ICLK cycles. (See 9.7.2 Stop Mode.)
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. The SIM also produces two
sets of clocks for other modules. Refer to the wait mode subsection of
each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode.
Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode.
9.4 Re se t a nd Syste m Initia liza tion
The MCU has these reset sources:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Power-on reset module (POR)
External reset pin (RST)
Computer operating properly module (COP)
Low-voltage inhibit module (LVI)
Illegal opcode
Illegal address
All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE:$FFFF ($FEFE:$FEFF in
monitor mode) and assert the internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes
all registers to be returned to their default values and all modules to be
returned to their reset states.
An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 9.5 SIM Counter), but an
external reset does not. Each of the resets sets a corresponding bit in
the SIM reset status register (SRSR). (See 9.8 SIM Registers.)
Technical Data
146
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
9.4.1 Exte rna l Pin Re se t
The RST pin circuit includes an internal pull-up device. Pulling the
asynchronous RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit of the SIM
reset status register (SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low for a
minimum of 67 ICLK cycles, assuming that neither the POR nor the LVI
was the source of the reset. See Table 9-2 for details.
Figure 9-4 shows the relative timing.
Table 9-2. PIN Bit Set Timing
Reset Type
POR/LVI
Number of Cycles Required to Set PIN
4163 (4096 + 64 + 3)
All others
67 (64 + 3)
ICLK
RST
IAB
VECT H VECT L
PC
Figure 9-4. External Reset Timing
9.4.2 Ac tive Re se ts from Inte rna l Sourc e s
All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 ICLK cycles
to allow resetting of external peripherals. The internal reset signal IRST
continues to be asserted for an additional 32 cycles (see Figure 9-5). An
internal reset can be caused by an illegal address, illegal opcode, COP
timeout, LVI, or POR (see Figure 9-6).
NOTE: For LVI or POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 + 32 ICLK cycles
during which the SIM forces the RST pin low. The internal reset signal
then follows the sequence from the falling edge of RST shown in
Figure 9-5.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
147
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
IRST
RST
ICLK
IAB
RST PULLED LOW BY MCU
32 CYCLES
32 CYCLES
VECTOR HIGH
Figure 9-5. Internal Reset Timing
The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock.
ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST
ILLEGAL OPCODE RST
COPRST
LVI
INTERNAL RESET
POR
Figure 9-6. Sources of Internal Reset
The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals
and other chips within a system built around the MCU.
9.4.2.1 Po we r-On Re se t
When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset module
(POR) generates a pulse to indicate that power-on has occurred. The
external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out
4096 + 32 ICLK cycles. Thirty-two ICLK cycles later, the CPU and
memories are released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to
occur.
At power-on, these events occur:
•
•
•
•
A POR pulse is generated.
The internal reset signal is asserted.
The SIM enables CGMOUT.
Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for 4096
ICLK cycles to allow stabilization of the oscillator.
•
•
The RST pin is driven low during the oscillator stabilization time.
The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all
other bits in the register are cleared.
Technical Data
148
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
OSC1
PORRST
4096
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
ICLK
CGMOUT
RST
IRST
IAB
$FFFE
$FFFF
Figure 9-7. POR Recovery
9.4.2.2 Co m p ute r Op e ra ting Pro p e rly (COP) Re se t
An input to the SIM is reserved for the COP reset signal. The overflow of
the COP counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the
SIM reset status register (SRSR). The SIM actively pulls down the RST
pin for all internal reset sources.
To prevent a COP module timeout, write any value to location $FFFF.
Writing to location $FFFF clears the COP counter and bits 12 through 5
of the SIM counter. The SIM counter output, which occurs at least every
213 – 24 ICLK cycles, drives the COP counter. The COP should be
serviced as soon as possible out of reset to guarantee the maximum
amount of time before the first timeout.
The COP module is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ1 pin is held at
VTST while the MCU is in monitor mode. The COP module can be
disabled only through combinational logic conditioned with the high
voltage signal on the RST or the IRQ1 pin. This prevents the COP from
becoming disabled as a result of external noise. During a break state,
VTST on the RST pin disables the COP module.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
149
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.4.2.3 Ille g a l Op c o d e Re se t
The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An
illegal instruction sets the ILOP bit in the SIM reset status register
(SRSR) and causes a reset.
If the stop enable bit, STOP, in the mask option register is logic 0, the
SIM treats the STOP instruction as an illegal opcode and causes an
illegal opcode reset. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all
internal reset sources.
9.4.2.4 Ille g a l Ad d re ss Re se t
An opcode fetch from an unmapped address generates an illegal
address reset. The SIM verifies that the CPU is fetching an opcode prior
to asserting the ILAD bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and
resetting the MCU. A data fetch from an unmapped address does not
generate a reset. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal
reset sources.
9.4.2.5 Lo w-Vo lta g e Inhib it (LVI) Re se t
The low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) asserts its output to the SIM when
the VDD voltage falls to the LVITRIPF voltage. The LVI bit in the SIM reset
status register (SRSR) is set, and the external reset pin (RST) is held low
while the SIM counter counts out 4096 + 32 ICLK cycles. Thirty-two ICLK
cycles later, the CPU is released from reset to allow the reset vector
sequence to occur. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all
internal reset sources.
9.4.2.6 Mo nito r Mo d e Entry Mo d ule Re se t
The monitor mode entry module reset asserts its output to the SIM when
monitor mode is entered in the condition where the reset vectors are
blank ($FF). (See Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON).) When MODRST
gets asserted, an internal reset occurs. The SIM actively pulls down the
RST pin for all internal reset sources.
Technical Data
150
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Counter
9.5 SIM Counte r
The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset module (POR) and in
stop mode recovery to allow the oscillator time to stabilize before
enabling the internal bus (IBUS) clocks. The SIM counter also serves as
a prescaler for the computer operating properly module (COP). The SIM
counter overflow supplies the clock for the COP module. The SIM
counter is 12 bits long and is clocked by the falling edge of ICLK.
9.5.1 SIM Counte r During Powe r-On Re se t
The power-on reset module (POR) detects power applied to the MCU.
At power-on, the POR circuit asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM
is initialized, it enables the clock generation module (CGM) to drive the
bus clock state machine.
9.5.2 SIM Counte r During Stop Mod e Re c ove ry
The SIM counter also is used for stop mode recovery. The STOP
instruction clears the SIM counter. After an interrupt, break, or reset, the
SIM senses the state of the short stop recovery bit, SSREC, in the
configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). If the SSREC bit is a logic 1, then
the stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096 ICLK cycles
down to 32 ICLK cycles. This is ideal for applications using canned
oscillators that do not require long start-up times from stop mode.
External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time, that
is, with SSREC cleared.
9.5.3 SIM Counte r a nd Re se t Sta te s
External reset has no effect on the SIM counter. (See 9.7.2 Stop Mode
for details.) The SIM counter is free-running after all reset states. (See
9.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources for counter control and
internal reset recovery sequences.)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
151
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.6 Exc e p tion Control
Normal, sequential program execution can be changed in three different
ways:
•
Interrupts:
– Maskable hardware CPU interrupts
– Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI)
•
•
Reset
Break interrupts
9.6.1 Inte rrup ts
At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register
contents on the stack and sets the interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent
additional interrupts. At the end of an interrupt, the RTI instruction
recovers the CPU register contents from the stack so that normal
processing can resume. Figure 9-8 shows interrupt entry timing, and
Figure 9-9 shows interrupt recovery timing.
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I-BIT
IAB
DUMMY
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
SP – 3
SP – 4
VECT H
VECT L START ADDR
IDB
DUMMY PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8]
X
A
CCR V DATA H V DATA L OPCODE
R/W
Figure 9-8. Interrupt Entry Timing
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I-BIT
IAB
SP – 4
SP – 3
SP – 2
SP – 1
SP
PC
PC + 1
IDB
CCR
A
X PC – 1[15:8] PC – 1[7:0] OPCODE OPERAND
R/W
Figure 9-9. Interrupt Recovery Timing
Technical Data
152
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start
of interrupt processing. The arbitration result is a constant that the CPU
uses to determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is latched by
the SIM, no other interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority,
until the latched interrupt is serviced (or the I bit is cleared).
(See Figure 9-10.)
FROM RESET
BREAK
YES
INTERRUPT?
NO
YES
I-BIT SET?
NO
IRQ1
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I-BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
AS MANY INTERRUPTS
AS EXIST ON CHIP
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
NO
RTI
YES
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
INSTRUCTION?
NO
Figure 9-10. Interrupt Processing
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
153
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.6.1.1 Ha rd wa re Inte rrup ts
A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of
a hardware interrupt begins after completion of the current instruction.
When the current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending
hardware interrupts. If interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the
condition code register) and if the corresponding interrupt enable bit is
set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt processing; otherwise, the next
instruction is fetched and executed.
If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction
execution, the highest priority interrupt is serviced first. Figure 9-11
demonstrates what happens when two interrupts are pending. If an
interrupt is pending upon exit from the original interrupt service routine,
the pending interrupt is serviced before the LDA instruction is executed.
CLI
BACKGROUND
LDA #$FF
ROUTINE
INT1
PSHH
INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
INT2
PSHH
INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
Figure 9-11ꢀꢁInterrupt Recognition Example
The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 RTI
instructions. However, in the case of the INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a
redundant operation.
NOTE: To maintain compatibility with the M6805 Family, the H register is not
pushed on the stack during interrupt entry. If the interrupt service routine
modifies the H register or uses the indexed addressing mode, software
should save the H register and then restore it prior to exiting the routine.
Technical Data
154
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
9.6.1.2 SWI Instruc tio n
The SWI instruction is a non-maskable instruction that causes an
interrupt regardless of the state of the interrupt mask (I bit) in the
condition code register.
NOTE: A software interrupt pushes PC onto the stack. A software interrupt does
not push PC – 1, as a hardware interrupt does.
9.6.1.3 Inte rrup t Sta tus Re g iste rs
The flags in the interrupt status registers identify maskable interrupt
sources. Table 9-3 summarizes the interrupt sources and the interrupt
status register flags that they set. The interrupt status registers can be
useful for debugging.
9.6.1.4 Inte rrup t Sta tus Re g iste r 1
Address: $FE04
Bit 7
6
5
IF4
R
4
IF3
R
3
IF2
R
2
IF1
R
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
IF6
R
IF5
R
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 9-12. Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1)
IF6–IF1 — Interrupt Flags 6–1
These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the
sources shown in Table 9-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
Bit 0 and Bit 1 — Always read 0
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
155
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
Table 9-3. Interrupt Sources
INT
Vector
Address
Priority
Interrupt Source
Timebase Module
Flag
Lowest
$FFDA
$FFDB
$FFDC
$FFDD
$FFDE
$FFDF
$FFE0
$FFE1
$FFE2
$FFE3
$FFE4
$FFE5
$FFE6
$FFE7
$FFE8
$FFE9
$FFEA
$FFEB
$FFEC
$FFED
$FFEE
$FFEF
$FFF0
$FFF1
$FFF2
$FFF3
$FFF4
$FFF5
$FFF6
$FFF7
$FFF8
$FFF9
$FFFA
$FFFB
$FFFC
$FFFD
$FFFE
$FFFF
IF17
IF16
IF15
IF14
IF13
IF12
IF11
IF10
IF9
Analog Module
ADC Conversion Complete
Keyboard
SCI Transmit
SCI Receive
SCI Error
MMIIC
TIM2 Overflow
TIM2 Channel 1
TIM2 Channel 0
TIM1 Overflow
TIM1 Channel 1
TIM1 Channel 0
PLL
IF8
IF7
IF6
IF5
IF4
IF3
IF2
IRQ2
IF1
IRQ1
SWI
Reset
Highest
Technical Data
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA
156
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
9.6.1.5 Inte rrup t Sta tus Re g iste r 2
Address: $FE05
Bit 7
6
5
IF12
R
4
IF11
R
3
IF10
R
2
IF9
R
1
IF8
R
Bit 0
IF7
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
IF14
R
IF13
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 9-13. Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2)
IF14–IF7 — Interrupt Flags 14–7
These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the
sources shown in Table 9-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
9.6.1.6 Inte rrup t Sta tus Re g iste r 3
Address: $FE06
Bit 7
6
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
IF17
R
1
IF16
R
Bit 0
IF15
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
R
0
0
R
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 9-14. Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3)
IF17–IF15 — Interrupt Flags 17–15
These flags indicate the presence of an interrupt request from the
source shown in Table 9-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
157
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.6.2 Re se t
All reset sources always have equal and highest priority and cannot be
arbitrated.
9.6.3 Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The break module can stop normal program flow at a software-
programmable break point by asserting its break interrupt output. (See
Section 23. Break Module (BRK).) The SIM puts the CPU into the
break state by forcing it to the SWI vector location. Refer to the break
interrupt subsection of each module to see how each module is affected
by the break state.
9.6.4 Sta tus Fla g Prote c tion in Bre a k Mod e
The SIM controls whether status flags contained in other modules can
be cleared during break mode. The user can select whether flags are
protected from being cleared by properly initializing the break clear flag
enable bit (BCFE) in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR).
Protecting flags in break mode ensures that set flags will not be cleared
while in break mode. This protection allows registers to be freely read
and written during break mode without losing status flag information.
Setting the BCFE bit enables the clearing mechanisms. Once cleared in
break mode, a flag remains cleared even when break mode is exited.
Status flags with a 2-step clearing mechanism — for example, a read of
one register followed by the read or write of another — are protected,
even when the first step is accomplished prior to entering break mode.
Upon leaving break mode, execution of the second step will clear the flag
as normal.
Technical Data
158
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Low-Power Modes
9.7 Low-Powe r Mod e s
Executing the WAIT or STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low power-
consumption mode for standby situations. The SIM holds the CPU in a
non-clocked state. The operation of each of these modes is described in
the following subsections. Both STOP and WAIT clear the interrupt mask
(I) in the condition code register, allowing interrupts to occur.
9.7.1 Wa it Mod e
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while the peripheral clocks
continue to run. Figure 9-15 shows the timing for wait mode entry.
A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an
interrupt if the interrupt is enabled. Stacking for the interrupt begins one
cycle after the WAIT instruction during which the interrupt occurred. In
wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. Refer to the wait mode
subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in
wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait
mode.
Wait mode also can be exited by a reset or break. A break interrupt
during wait mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit, SBSW, in the SIM
break status register (SBSR). If the COP disable bit, COPD, in the mask
option register is logic 0, then the computer operating properly module
(COP) is enabled and remains active in wait mode.
IAB
IDB
WAIT ADDR
WAIT ADDR + 1
SAME
SAME
PREVIOUS DATA
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
R/W
NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the
last instruction.
Figure 9-15. Wait Mode Entry Timing
Figure 9-16 and Figure 9-17 show the timing for WAIT recovery.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
159
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
IAB
$6E0B
$A6
$6E0C
$00FF
$00FE
$00FD
$00FC
IDB
$A6
$A6
$01
$0B
$6E
EXITSTOPWAIT
NOTE: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin OR CPU interrupt OR break interrupt
Figure 9-16. Wait Recovery from Interrupt or Break
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
IAB
$6E0B
$A6
RST VCT H RST VCT L
IDB $A6
RST
$A6
ICLK
Figure 9-17. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset
9.7.2 Stop Mod e
In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are
disabled. An interrupt request from a module can cause an exit from stop
mode. Stacking for interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery
time has elapsed. Reset or break also causes an exit from stop mode.
The SIM disables the clock generator module output (CGMOUT) in stop
mode, stopping the CPU and peripherals. Stop recovery time is
selectable using the SSREC bit in the configuration register 1
(CONFIG1). If SSREC is set, stop recovery is reduced from the normal
delay of 4096 ICLK cycles down to 32. This is ideal for applications using
canned oscillators that do not require long start-up times from stop
mode.
NOTE: External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time by
clearing the SSREC bit.
Technical Data
160
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Registers
A break interrupt during stop mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit
(SBSW) in the SIM break status register (SBSR).
The SIM counter is held in reset from the execution of the STOP
instruction until the beginning of stop recovery. It is then used to time the
recovery period. Figure 9-18 shows stop mode entry timing.
NOTE: To minimize stop current, all pins configured as inputs should be driven
to a logic 1 or logic 0.
CPUSTOP
IAB
IDB
STOP ADDR
STOP ADDR + 1
SAME
SAME
PREVIOUS DATA
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
R/W
NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the STOP opcode, depending on the last
instruction.
Figure 9-18. Stop Mode Entry Timing
STOP RECOVERY PERIOD
ICLK
INT/BREAK
IAB
STOP + 2 STOP + 2
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
SP – 3
STOP +1
Figure 9-19. Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt or Break
9.8 SIM Re g iste rs
The SIM has three memory-mapped registers:
•
•
•
SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) — $FE00
SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) — $FE01
SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) — $FE03
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
161
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.8.1 SIM Bre a k Sta tus Re g iste r
The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a
break caused an exit from stop mode or wait mode.
Address: $FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SBSW
Note
0
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
R
=Reserved
Figure 9-20. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
SBSW — Break Wait Bit
This status bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from wait
mode or stop mode. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears
SBSW.
1 = Stop mode or wait mode was exited by break interrupt
0 = Stop mode or wait mode was not exited by break interrupt
SBSW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can
modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. The
following code is an example.
This code works if the H register has been pushed onto the stack in the break
service routine software. This code should be executed at the end of the break
service routine software.
HIBYTE
LOBYTE
EQU
EQU
If not SBSW, do RTI
BRCLR
SBSW,SBSR, RETURN
;See if wait mode or stop mode was exited by
;break.
TST
BNE
DEC
DEC
LOBYTE,SP
DOLO
;If RETURNLO is not zero,
;then just decrement low byte.
;Else deal with high byte, too.
;Point to WAIT/STOP opcode.
;Restore H register.
HIBYTE,SP
LOBYTE,SP
DOLO
RETURN
PULH
RTI
Technical Data
162
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Registers
9.8.2 SIM Re se t Sta tus Re g iste r
This register contains six flags that show the source of the last reset
provided all previous reset status bits have been cleared. Clear the SIM
reset status register by reading it. A power-on reset sets the POR bit and
clears all other bits in the register.
Address: $FE01
Bit 7
POR
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
LVI
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-21. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
POR — Power-On Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit
0 = Read of SRSR
PIN — External Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST)
0 = POR or read of SRSR
COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by COP counter
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only)
1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address
0 = POR or read of SRSR
LVI — Low-Voltage Inhibit Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by the LVI circuit
0 = POR or read of SRSR
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM)
Technical Data
163
Syste m Inte g ra tion Mod ule (SIM)
9.8.3 SIM Bre a k Fla g Control Re g iste r
The SIM break control register contains a bit that enables software to
clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
Address: $FE03
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 9-22. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing
status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits
during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
Technical Data
164
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 10. Monitor ROM (MON)
10.1 Conte nts
10.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
10.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.4.3 Break Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.4.4 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.4.5 Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.5 Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
10.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the monitor ROM (MON) and the monitor mode
entry methods. The monitor ROM allows complete testing of the MCU
through a single-wire interface with a host computer. Monitor mode entry
can be achieved without use of the higher test voltage, VTST, as long as
vector addresses $FFFE and $FFFF are blank, thus reducing the
hardware requirements for in-circuit programming.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
165
Monitor ROM (MON)
10.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the monitor ROM include:
•
•
Normal user-mode pin functionality
One pin dedicated to serial communication between monitor ROM
and host computer
•
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication
with host computer
•
•
•
•
Execution of code in RAM or FLASH
FLASH memory security feature1
FLASH memory programming interface
Enhanced PLL (phase-locked loop) option to allow use of external
32.768-kHz crystal to generate internal frequency of 2.4576 MHz
•
•
368 bytes monitor ROM code size ($FE10 to $FF7F)
Monitor mode entry without high voltage, VTST, if reset vector is
blank ($FFFE and $FFFF contain $FF)
•
Standard monitor mode entry if high voltage, VTST, is applied to
IRQ1
10.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
The monitor ROM receives and executes commands from a host
computer. Figure 10-1 shows an example circuit used to enter monitor
mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232
interface.
Simple monitor commands can access any memory address. In monitor
mode, the MCU can execute code downloaded into RAM by a host
computer while most MCU pins retain normal operating mode functions.
All communication between the host computer and the MCU is through
the PTA0 pin. A level-shifting and multiplexing interface is required
between PTA0 and the host computer. PTA0 is used in a wired-OR
configuration and requires a pullup resistor.
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Technical Data
166
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
68HC908SR12
RST
0.1 µF
V
TST
RESET VECTORS
$FFFE
(SEE NOTE 3)
10 kΩ
(SEE NOTES 2
AND 3)
$FFFF
C
D
SW2
IRQ1
CGMXFC
4.9152MHz/9.8304MHz
10 k
0.033 µF
SW3
Ω
C
C
OSC1
OSC2
(SEE NOTE 2)
6–30 pF
1
20
MC145407
D
+
+
+
+
10
10
µ
F
F
10 µF
SW4
(SEE NOTE 2)
3
4
18
17
V
V
V
V
SS
32.768 kHz XTAL
V
SSA
SSAM
REFL
330 k
Ω
D
6–30 pF
DD
10 µF
µ
2
19
V
DB-25
2
DD
5
6
16
15
V
V
V
DD
3
7
DDA
REFH
0.1 µF
V
DD
V
DD
1
2
6
4
14
3
MC74HC125
10 kΩ
PTA0
PTC1
5
V
DD
V
DD
7
A
PTA1
PTA2
SW1
(SEE NOTE 1)
B
Notes:
1. For monitor mode entry when SW2 at position C (IRQ1 = V
SW1: Position A — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 4
):
TST
SW1: Position B — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 2
2. SW2, SW3, and SW4: Position C — Enter monitor mode using off-chip oscillator only.
SW2, SW3, and SW4: Position D — Enter monitor mode using 32.768kHz XTAL and internal PLL.
3. See Table 24-5 for IRQ1 voltage level requirements.
4. See Table 10-1 for other monitor mode entry configurations.
Figure 10-1. Monitor Mode Circuit
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
167
Monitor ROM (MON)
The monitor code allows enabling the PLL to generate the internal clock,
provided the reset vector is blank ($FF), when the device is being
clocked by a low-frequency crystal. This entry method, which is enabled
when IRQ1 is held low out of reset, is intended to support serial
communication/programming at 9600 baud in monitor mode by stepping
up the external frequency (assumed to be 32.768 kHz) by a fixed amount
to generate the desired internal frequency (2.4576 MHz).
If the reset vector is not blank (not $FF), the frequency stepping feature
is not supported, because IRQ1 cannot be held low for monitor mode
entry. With a non-blank reset vector, entry into monitor mode requires
VTST on IRQ1.
10.4.1 Ente ring Monitor Mod e
Table 10-1 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode. As
specified in the table, monitor mode may be entered after a POR and will
allow communication at 9600 baud provided one of the following sets of
conditions is met:
1. If $FFFE and $FFFF do not contain $FF (programmed state):
– The external clock is 4.9152 MHz with PTC1 low or
9.8304 MHz with PTC1 high
– IRQ1 = VTST (PLL off)
2. If $FFFE and $FFFF both contain $FF (erased state):
– The external clock is 9.8304 MHz
– IRQ1 = VDD (this can be implemented through the internal
IRQ1 pullup; PLL off)
3. If $FFFE and $FFFF both contain $FF (erased state):
– The external clock is 32.768 kHz (crystal)
– IRQ1 = VSS (this setting initiates the PLL to boost the external
32.768 kHz to an internal bus frequency of 2.4576 MHz)
Technical Data
168
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Table 10-1. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options
Address
$FFFE/
$FFFF
External
Clock
Bus
Frequency
Baud
Rate
(1)
IRQ1
RST
PTA2
PTA1 PTA0
PTC1
PLL
COP
Comment
X
GND
X
X
X
1
X
1
X
X
0
X
Disabled
0
No operation until
reset goes high
V
V
X
0
0
0
1
4.9152
2.4576
MHz
OFF
OFF
Disabled
Disabled
9600
PTA1 and PTA2
voltages only
required if
TST
DD
(2)
or
MHz
V
TST
IRQ1 = V
;
TST
PTC1 determines
frequency divider
V
V
X
1
1
9.8304
2.4576
MHz
9600
PTA1 and PTA2
voltages only
required if
TST
DD
(2)
or
MHz
V
TST
IRQ1 = V
;
TST
PTC1 determines
frequency divider
V
V
Blank
"$FFFF"
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
9.8304
2.4576
MHz
OFF
ON
Disabled
Disabled
9600
9600
External frequency
always divided by 4
DD
DD
(3)
MHz
GND
V
Blank
"$FFFF"
32.768
2.4576
MHz
PLL enabled
(BCS set)
in monitor code
DD
(3)
kHz
V
V
Blank
"$FFFF"
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
—
OFF
OFF
Enabled
Enabled
—
—
Enters user
mode — will
encounter an illegal
address reset
DD
TST
or
GND
V
V
Not Blank
—
Enters user mode
DD
DD
or
or
GND
V
TST
Notes:
1. PTA0 = 1 if serial communication; PTA0 = 0 if parallel communication (factory use only)
2. When IRQ1 = VTST, external clock must be derived by a 4.9152MHz or 9.8304MHz off-chip oscillator.
3. External clock is derived by a crystal or an off-chip oscillator.
Monitor ROM (MON)
If VTST is applied to IRQ1 and PTC1 is low upon monitor mode entry
(above condition set 1), the bus frequency is a divide-by-two of the input
clock. If PTC1 is high with VTST applied to IRQ1 upon monitor mode
entry, the bus frequency will be a divide-by-four of the input clock.
Holding the PTC1 pin low when entering monitor mode causes a bypass
of a divide-by-two stage at the oscillator only if VTST is applied to IRQ1.
In this event, the CGMOUT frequency is equal to the CGMXCLK
frequency, and the OSC1 input directly generates internal bus clocks. In
this case, the OSC1 signal must have a 50% duty cycle at maximum bus
frequency.
If entering monitor mode without high voltage on IRQ1 (above condition
set 2 or 3, where applied voltage is either VDD or VSS), then all port A pin
requirements and conditions, including the PTC1 frequency divisor
selection, are not in effect. This is to reduce circuit requirements when
performing in-circuit programming.
NOTE: If the reset vector is blank and monitor mode is entered, the chip will see
an additional reset cycle after the initial POR reset. Once the part has
been programmed, the traditional method of applying a voltage, VTST, to
IRQ1 must be used to enter monitor mode.
The COP module is disabled in monitor mode based on these
conditions:
•
If monitor mode was entered as a result of the reset vector being
blank (above condition set 2 or 3), the COP is always disabled
regardless of the state of IRQ1 or RST.
•
If monitor mode was entered with VTST on IRQ1 (condition set 1),
then the COP is disabled as long as VTST is applied to either IRQ1
or RST.
The second condition states that as long as VTST is maintained on the
IRQ1 pin after entering monitor mode, or if VTST is applied to RST after
the initial reset to get into monitor mode (when VTST was applied to
IRQ1), then the COP will be disabled. In the latter situation, after VTST is
applied to the RST pin, VTST can be removed from the IRQ1 pin in the
interest of freeing the IRQ1 for normal functionality in monitor mode.
Technical Data
170
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
Figure 10-2 shows a simplified diagram of the monitor mode entry when
the reset vector is blank and just 1 x VDD voltage is applied to the IRQ1
pin. An external oscillator of 9.8304 MHz is required for a baud rate of
9600, as the internal bus frequency is automatically set to the external
frequency divided by four.
POR RESET
NO
NORMAL USER
MODE
IS VECTOR
BLANK?
YES
MONITOR MODE
EXECUTE
MONITOR
CODE
POR
TRIGGERED?
NO
YES
Figure 10-2. Low-Voltage Monitor Mode Entry Flowchart
Enter monitor mode with pin configuration shown in Figure 10-1 by
pulling RST low and then high. The rising edge of RST latches monitor
mode. Once monitor mode is latched, the values on the specified pins
can change.
Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security
bytes. (See 10.5 Security.) After the security bytes, the MCU sends a
break signal (10 consecutive logic 0s) to the host, indicating that it is
ready to receive a command.
In monitor mode, the MCU uses different vectors for reset, SWI
(software interrupt), and break interrupt than those for user mode. The
alternate vectors are in the $FE page instead of the $FF page and allow
code execution from the internal monitor firmware instead of user code.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
171
Monitor ROM (MON)
NOTE: Exiting monitor mode after it has been initiated by having a blank reset
vector requires a power-on reset (POR). Pulling RST low will not exit
monitor mode in this situation.
Table 10-2 summarizes the differences between user mode and monitor
mode.
Table 10-2. Mode Differences
Functions
Modes
Reset
Vector
High
Reset
Vector
Low
Break
Vector
High
Break
Vector
Low
SWI
Vector
High
SWI
Vector
Low
User
$FFFE
$FEFE
$FFFF
$FEFF
$FFFC
$FEFC
$FFFD
$FEFD
$FFFC
$FEFC
$FFFD
$FEFD
Monitor
10.4.2 Da ta Form a t
Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero
(NRZ) mark/space data format. Transmit and receive baud rates must
be identical.
NEXT
START
BIT
START
BIT
STOP
BIT
BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 BIT 6 BIT 7
Figure 10-3. Monitor Data Format
10.4.3 Bre a k Sig na l
A start bit (logic 0) followed by nine logic 0 bits is a break signal. When
the monitor receives a break signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for the
duration of two bits and then echoes back the break signal.
MISSING STOP BIT
2-STOP BIT DELAY BEFORE ZERO ECHO
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Figure 10-4. Break Transaction
Technical Data
172
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
10.4.4 Ba ud Ra te
The communication baud rate is controlled by the crystal frequency and
the state of the PTC1 pin (when IRQ1 is set to VTST) upon entry into
monitor mode. When PTC1 is high, the divide by ratio is 1024. If the
PTC1 pin is at logic 0 upon entry into monitor mode, the divide by ratio
is 512.
If monitor mode was entered with VDD on IRQ1, then the divide by ratio
is set at 1024, regardless of PTC1. If monitor mode was entered with VSS
on IRQ, then the internal PLL steps up the external frequency, presumed
to be 32.768 kHz, to 2.4576 MHz. These latter two conditions for monitor
mode entry require that the reset vector is blank.
Table 10-3 lists external frequencies required to achieve a standard
baud rate of 9600 BPS. Other standard baud rates can be accomplished
using proportionally higher or lower frequency generators. If using a
crystal as the clock source, be aware of the upper frequency limit that the
internal clock module can handle. See 24.6 5.0V DC Electrical
Characteristics and 24.8 5.0V Control Timing for this limit.
Table 10-3. Monitor Baud Rate Selection
External
Frequency
Internal
Frequency
Baud Rate
(BPS)
IRQ1
PTC1
VTST
VTST
VDD
VSS
4.9152 MHz
9.8304 MHz
9.8304 MHz
32.768 kHz
0
1
2.4576 MHz
2.4576 MHz
2.4576 MHz
2.4576 MHz
9600
9600
9600
9600
X
X
10.4.5 Com m a nd s
The monitor ROM firmware uses these commands:
•
•
•
READ (read memory)
WRITE (write memory)
IREAD (indexed read)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
173
Monitor ROM (MON)
•
•
•
IWRITE (indexed write)
READSP (read stack pointer)
RUN (run user program)
The monitor ROM firmware echoes each received byte back to the PTA0
pin for error checking. An 11-bit delay at the end of each command
allows the host to send a break character to cancel the command. A
delay of two bit times occurs before each echo and before READ,
IREAD, or READSP data is returned. The data returned by a read
command appears after the echo of the last byte of the command.
NOTE: Wait one bit time after each echo before sending the next byte.
FROM
HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
READ
READ
DATA
4
4
1
1
4
1
3, 2
4
ECHO
RETURN
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times
2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times
3 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 10-5. Read Transaction
FROM
HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
DATA
WRITE
WRITE
3
3
1
1
3
1
3
1
2, 3
ECHO
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times
2 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 10-6. Write Transaction
Technical Data
174
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
A brief description of each monitor mode command is given in
Table 10-4 through Table 10-9.
Table 10-4. READ (Read Memory) Command
Description Read byte from memory
Operand
2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order
Data
Returned
Returns contents of specified address
Opcode
$4A
Command Sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
READ
READ
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
Table 10-5. WRITE (Write Memory) Command
Description Write byte to memory
2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order; low byte followed by
data byte
Operand
Data
Returned
None
Opcode
$49
Command Sequence
FROM
HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS ADDRESS
HIGH LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
DATA
WRITE
ECHO
WRITE
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
175
Monitor ROM (MON)
Table 10-6. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command
Description Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed
Operand
2-byte address in high byte:low byte order
Returns contents of next two addresses
Data
Returned
Opcode
$1A
Command Sequence
FROM
HOST
IREAD
IREAD
DATA
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
Table 10-7. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command
Description Write to last address accessed + 1
Operand
Single data byte
Data
None
$19
Returned
Opcode
Command Sequence
FROM
HOST
DATA
DATA
IWRITE
IWRITE
ECHO
Technical Data
176
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can access a block of
memory sequentially over the full 64k-byte memory map.
Table 10-8. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command
Description Reads stack pointer
Operand
None
Returns incremented stack pointer value (SP + 1) in high-byte:low-
byte order
Data
Returned
Opcode
$0C
Command Sequence
FROM
HOST
SP
HIGH
SP
LOW
READSP
READSP
ECHO
RETURN
Table 10-9. RUN (Run User Program) Command
Description Executes PULH and RTI instructions
Operand
None
None
$28
Data
Returned
Opcode
Command Sequence
FROM
HOST
RUN
RUN
ECHO
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
177
Monitor ROM (MON)
The MCU executes the SWI and PSHH instructions when it enters
monitor mode. The RUN command tells the MCU to execute the PULH
and RTI instructions. Before sending the RUN command, the host can
modify the stacked CPU registers to prepare to run the host program.
The READSP command returns the incremented stack pointer value,
SP + 1. The high and low bytes of the program counter are at addresses
SP + 5 and SP + 6.
SP
HIGH BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
CONDITION CODE REGISTER
ACCUMULATOR
SP + 1
SP + 2
SP + 3
SP + 4
LOW BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
HIGH BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER SP + 5
LOW BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER SP + 6
SP + 7
Figure 10-7. Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry
10.5 Se c urity
A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations
while in monitor mode. The host can bypass the security feature at
monitor mode entry by sending eight security bytes that match the bytes
at locations $FFF6–$FFFD. Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain user-
defined data.
NOTE: Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons,
program locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors.
During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for
the host to send the eight security bytes on pin PTA0. If the received
bytes match those at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the
security feature and can read all FLASH locations and execute code
from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until a power-on reset occurs.
If the reset was not a power-on reset, security remains bypassed and
security code entry is not required. (See Figure 10-8.)
Technical Data
178
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Security
V
DD
4096 + 32 ICLK CYCLES
RST
256 BUS CYCLES (MINIMUM)
FROM HOST
FROM MCU
PTA0
1
1
4
1
4
2
1
NOTES:
1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times.
2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times.
4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 10-8. Monitor Mode Entry Timing
Upon power-on reset, if the received bytes of the security code do not
match the data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the
security feature. The MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading a
FLASH location returns an invalid value and trying to execute code from
FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After receiving the eight security
bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break character, signifying that
it is ready to receive a command.
NOTE: The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends
the eight security bits.
To determine whether the security code entered is correct, check to see
if bit 6 of RAM address $40 is set. If it is, then the correct security code
has been entered and FLASH can be accessed.
If the security sequence fails, the device should be reset by a power-on
reset and brought up in monitor mode to attempt another entry. After
failing the security sequence, the FLASH module can also be mass
erased by executing an erase routine that was downloaded into internal
RAM. The mass erase operation clears the security code locations so
that all eight security bytes become $FF (blank).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
179
Monitor ROM (MON)
Technical Data
180
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 11. Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.1 Conte nts
11.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
11.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
11.4 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
11.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
11.5.1 TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
11.5.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
11.5.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
11.5.3.1
11.5.3.2
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
11.5.4.1
11.5.4.2
11.5.4.3
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
11.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
11.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
11.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.8 TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
11.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
11.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
11.10.2 TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
11.10.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . .200
11.10.5 TIM Channel Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
181
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the timer interface (TIM) module. The TIM is a
two-channel timer that provides a timing reference with input capture,
output compare, and pulse-width-modulation functions. Figure 11-1 is a
block diagram of the TIM.
This particular MCU has two timer interface modules which are denoted
as TIM1 and TIM2.
11.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the TIM include:
•
Two input capture/output compare channels:
– Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger
– Set, clear, or toggle output compare action
•
•
Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width-modulation (PWM) signal
generation
Programmable TIM clock input with 7-frequency internal bus clock
prescaler selection
•
•
•
Free-running or modulo up-count operation
Toggle any channel pin on overflow
TIM counter stop and reset bits
Technical Data
182
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Pin Name Conventions
11.4 Pin Na m e Conve ntions
The text that follows describes both timers, TIM1 and TIM2. The TIM
input/output (I/O) pin names are T[1,2]CH0 (timer channel 0) and
T[1,2]CH1 (timer channel 1), where “1” is used to indicate TIM1 and “2”
is used to indicate TIM2. The two TIMs share four I/O pins with four I/O
port pins. The full names of the TIM I/O pins are listed in
Table 11-1. The generic pin names appear in the text that follows.
Table 11-1. Pin Name Conventions
TIM Generic Pin Names:
T[1,2]CH0
PTA6/T1CH0
PTB4/T2CH0
T[1,2]CH1
PTA7/T1CH1
PTB5/T2CH1
TIM1
Full TIM
Pin Names:
TIM2
NOTE: References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text
by omitting the timer number. For example, TCH0 may refer generically
to T1CH0 and T2CH0, and TCH1 may refer to T1CH1 and T2CH1.
11.5 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Figure 11-1 shows the structure of the TIM. The central component of
the TIM is the 16-bit TIM counter that can operate as a free-running
counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIM counter provides the timing
reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIM
counter modulo registers, TMODH:TMODL, control the modulo value of
the TIM counter. Software can read the TIM counter value at any time
without affecting the counting sequence.
The two TIM channels (per timer) are programmable independently as
input capture or output compare channels.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
183
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
PRESCALER SELECT
INTERNAL
PRESCALER
BUS CLOCK
TSTOP
TRST
PS2
PS1
PS0
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
TOIE
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TMODH:TMODL
TOV0
ELS0B
ELS0A
PORT
LOGIC
CHANNEL 0
CH0MAX
T[1,2]CH0
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH0H:TCH0L
CH0F
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT LATCH
MS0A
CH0IE
MS0B
CH1F
TOV1
ELS1B
ELS1A
PORT
LOGIC
CHANNEL 1
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH1H:TCH1L
CH1MAX
T[1,2]CH1
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT LATCH
MS1A
CH1IE
Figure 11-1. TIM Block Diagram
Figure 11-2 summarizes the timer registers.
NOTE: References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text
by omitting the timer number. For example, TSC may generically refer to
both T1SC and T2SC.
Technical Data
184
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
TOF
0
6
5
4
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
PS0
Timer 1 Status and Control
Register (T1SC)
$0020
TRST
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
9
0
Read: Bit 15
Write:
14
13
12
11
10
Bit 8
Timer 1 Counter Register
High (T1CNTH)
$0021
$0022
$0023
$0024
$0025
$0026
$0027
$0028
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 7
Bit 0
Timer 1 Counter Register
Low (T1CNTL)
0
Bit 15
1
0
0
13
1
0
12
1
0
0
0
0
Bit 8
1
14
11
10
9
Timer 1 Counter Modulo
Register High (T1MODH)
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
1
6
1
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
Timer 1 Counter Modulo
Register Low (T1MODL)
1
1
1
ELS0B
0
1
ELS0A
0
1
TOV0
0
Read: CH0F
Timer 1 Channel 0 Status
CH0IE
0
MS0B
0
MS0A
0
CH0MAX
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T1SC0)
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Timer 1 Channel 0
Write:
Register High (T1CH0H)
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Timer 1 Channel 0
Write:
Register Low (T1CH0L)
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH1F
0
0
Timer 1 Channel 1 Status
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
0
ELS1A
0
TOV1
0
CH1MAX
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T1SC1)
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
185
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Timer 1 Channel 1
Register High (T1CH1H)
$0029
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PS0
Timer 1 Channel 1
Register Low (T1CH1L)
$002A
$002B
$002C
$002D
$002E
$002F
$0030
$0031
Indeterminate after reset
TOF
0
0
TRST
0
0
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
Timer 2 Status and Control
Register (T2SC)
0
0
1
0
0
0
9
0
Read: Bit 15
Write:
14
13
12
11
10
Bit 8
Timer 2 Counter Register
High (T2CNTH)
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 7
Bit 0
Timer 2 Counter Register
Low (T2CNTL)
0
Bit 15
1
0
0
13
1
0
12
1
0
0
0
0
Bit 8
1
14
11
10
9
Timer 2 Counter Modulo
Register High (T2MODH)
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
1
6
1
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
Timer 2 Counter Modulo
Register Low (T2MODL)
1
1
1
ELS0B
0
1
ELS0A
0
1
TOV0
0
Read: CH0F
Timer 2 Channel 0 Status
CH0IE
0
MS0B
0
MS0A
0
CH0MAX
0
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T2SC0)
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Timer 2 Channel 0
Write:
Register High (T2CH0H)
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
Technical Data
186
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Timer 2 Channel 0
Register Low (T2CH0L)
$0032
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH1F
0
Timer 2 Channel 1 Status
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
$0033
$0034
$0035
and Control Register Write:
0
0
(T2SC1)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
9
0
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
Bit 8
Timer 2 Channel 1
Write:
Register High (T2CH1H)
Reset:
Read:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Timer 2 Channel 1
Write:
Register Low (T2CH1L)
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
11.5.1 TIM Counte r Pre sc a le r
The TIM clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs. The
prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The
prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in the TIM status and control register
select the TIM clock source.
11.5.2 Inp ut Ca p ture
With the input capture function, the TIM can capture the time at which an
external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input
capture channel, the TIM latches the contents of the TIM counter into the
TIM channel registers, TCHxH:TCHxL. The polarity of the active edge is
programmable. Input captures can generate TIM CPU interrupt
requests.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
187
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.5.3 Output Com p a re
With the output compare function, the TIM can generate a periodic pulse
with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the
counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel,
the TIM can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can
generate TIM CPU interrupt requests.
11.5.3.1 Unb uffe re d Outp ut C om p a re
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare
pulses as described in 11.5.3 Output Compare. The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing
the new value over the old value currently in the TIM channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change an
output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two
counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the
counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new
value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also,
using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output
compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass
the new value before it is written.
Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the
output compare value on channel x:
•
When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until
the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIM
overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIM overflow
interrupt routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of
the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an
output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse)
could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter
overflow period.
Technical Data
188
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
11.5.3.2 Buffe re d Outp ut Co m p a re
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare
channel whose output appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel
registers of the linked pair alternately control the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0)
links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the TIM
channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the TCH0 pin. Writing
to the TIM channel 1 registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to
synchronously control the output after the TIM overflows. At each
subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that control the
output are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the
buffered output compare function, and TIM channel 1 status and control
register (TSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin,
TCH1, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin.
NOTE: In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare
values to the currently active channel registers. User software should
track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the
active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered output compares.
11.5.4 Pulse Wid th Mod ula tion (PWM)
By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel,
the TIM can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIM counter
modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel
pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIM counter
modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM
signal.
As Figure 11-3 shows, the output compare value in the TIM channel
registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time
between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the
TIM to clear the channel pin on output compare if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 1. Program the TIM to set the pin if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 0.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
189
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
The value in the TIM counter modulo registers and the selected
prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The
frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing
$00FF (255) to the TIM counter modulo registers produces a PWM
period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select
value is $000. See 11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PULSE
WIDTH
TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
Figure 11-3. PWM Period and Pulse Width
The value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width of the
PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256
increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIM channel registers produces
a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50%.
11.5.4.1 Unb uffe re d PWM Sig na l G e ne ra tio n
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as
described in 11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new
pulse width value over the old value currently in the TIM channel
registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change a pulse
width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM periods.
For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old
value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare
during that PWM period. Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to
write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare to be
missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is written.
Technical Data
190
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the
PWM pulse width on channel x:
•
When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the
PWM period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIM overflow
interrupts and write the new value in the TIM overflow interrupt
routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current
PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt
routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output
compares to occur in the same PWM period.
NOTE: In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0%
duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-
correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
11.5.4.2 Buffe re d PWM Sig na l Ge ne ra tio n
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose
output appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked
pair alternately control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0)
links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIM channel 0 registers initially
control the pulse width on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1
registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control
the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM period. At each
subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that control the
pulse width are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the
buffered PWM function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register
(TSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, TCH1,
is available as a general-purpose I/O pin.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
191
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
NOTE: In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values
to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the
currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active
channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered PWM signals.
11.5.4.3 PWM Initia liza tio n
To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered
PWM signals, use the following initialization procedure:
1. In the TIM status and control register (TSC):
a. Stop the TIM counter by setting the TIM stop bit, TSTOP.
b. Reset the TIM counter and prescaler by setting the TIM reset
bit, TRST.
2. In the TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL), write the
value for the required PWM period.
3. In the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH:TCHxL), write the value for
the required pulse width.
4. In TIM channel x status and control register (TSCx):
a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or
1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the
mode select bits, MSxB:MSxA. (See Table 11-3.)
b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx.
c. Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on
compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA. The
output action on compare must force the output to the
complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 11-3.)
NOTE: In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0%
duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to self-
correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
5. In the TIM status control register (TSC), clear the TIM stop bit,
TSTOP.
Technical Data
192
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Interrupts
Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered
PWM operation. The TIM channel 0 registers (TCH0H:TCH0L) initially
control the buffered PWM output. TIM status control register 0 (TSCR0)
controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels.
Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIM
overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to a state
it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0% duty cycle output.
Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the
TOVx bit generates a 100% duty cycle output. (See 11.10.4 TIM
Channel Status and Control Registers.)
11.6 Inte rrup ts
The following TIM sources can generate interrupt requests:
•
TIM overflow flag (TOF) — The TOF bit is set when the TIM
counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIM counter
modulo registers. The TIM overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE,
enables TIM overflow CPU interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are
in the TIM status and control register.
•
TIM channel flags (CH1F:CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an
input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x
TIM CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x
interrupt enable bit, CHxIE. Channel x TIM CPU interrupt requests
are enabled when CHxIE = 1. CHxF and CHxIE are in the TIM
channel x status and control register.
11.7 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
193
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.7.1 Wa it Mod e
The TIM remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait
mode, the TIM registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled
CPU interrupt request from the TIM can bring the MCU out of wait mode.
If TIM functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by stopping the TIM before executing the WAIT instruction.
11.7.2 Stop Mod e
The TIM is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP
instruction does not affect register conditions or the state of the TIM
counter. TIM operation resumes when the MCU exits stop mode after an
external interrupt.
11.8 TIM During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
A break interrupt stops the TIM counter.
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in
other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in
the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear
status bits during the break state. (See 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control
Register.)
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a
logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it
remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE
bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write
I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some
status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does
the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during
the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the
second step clears the status bit.
Technical Data
194
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
I/O Signals
11.9 I/ O Sig na ls
Port A and port B each shares two of its pins with the TIM. The four TIM
channel I/O pins are T1CH0, T1CH1, T2CH0, and T2CH1 as described
in 11.4 Pin Name Conventions.
Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input
capture pin or an output compare pin. T1CH0 and T2CH0 can be
configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins.
11.10 I/ O Re g iste rs
NOTE: References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text
by omitting the timer number. For example, TSC may generically refer to
both T1SC AND T2SC.
These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the TIM:
•
•
•
•
•
TIM status and control register (TSC)
TIM counter registers (TCNTH:TCNTL)
TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL)
TIM channel status and control registers (TSC0, TSC1)
TIM channel registers (TCH0H:TCH0L, TCH1H:TCH1L)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
195
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.10.1 TIM Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
The TIM status and control register (TSC):
•
•
•
•
•
Enables TIM overflow interrupts
Flags TIM overflows
Stops the TIM counter
Resets the TIM counter
Prescales the TIM counter clock
Address: T1SC, $0020 and T2SC, $002B
Bit 7
TOF
0
6
TOIE
0
5
TSTOP
1
4
0
3
0
2
PS2
0
1
PS1
0
Bit 0
PS0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
TRST
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-4. TIM Status and Control Register (TSC)
TOF — TIM Overflow Flag Bit
This read/write flag is set when the TIM counter reaches the modulo
value programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by
reading the TIM status and control register when TOF is set and then
writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIM overflow occurs before the
clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no
effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to
inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a logic
1 to TOF has no effect.
1 = TIM counter has reached modulo value
0 = TIM counter has not reached modulo value
TOIE — TIM Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM overflow interrupts when the TOF bit
becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit.
1 = TIM overflow interrupts enabled
0 = TIM overflow interrupts disabled
Technical Data
196
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
I/O Registers
TSTOP — TIM Stop Bit
This read/write bit stops the TIM counter. Counting resumes when
TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIM
counter until software clears the TSTOP bit.
1 = TIM counter stopped
0 = TIM counter active
NOTE: Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIM is required
to exit wait mode.
TRST — TIM Reset Bit
Setting this write-only bit resets the TIM counter and the TIM
prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers.
Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after
the TIM counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears the
TRST bit.
1 = Prescaler and TIM counter cleared
0 = No effect
NOTE: Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIM counter
at a value of $0000.
PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits
These read/write bits select one of the seven prescaler outputs as the
input to the TIM counter as Table 11-2 shows. Reset clears the
PS[2:0] bits.
Table 11-2. Prescaler Selection
PS2
0
PS1
0
PS0
0
TIM Clock Source
Internal bus clock ÷ 1
Internal bus clock ÷ 2
Internal bus clock ÷ 4
Internal bus clock ÷ 8
Internal bus clock ÷ 16
Internal bus clock ÷ 32
Internal bus clock ÷ 64
Not available
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
197
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.10.2 TIM Counte r Re g iste rs
The two read-only TIM counter registers contain the high and low bytes
of the value in the TIM counter. Reading the high byte (TCNTH) latches
the contents of the low byte (TCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent reads of
TCNTH do not affect the latched TCNTL value until TCNTL is read.
Reset clears the TIM counter registers. Setting the TIM reset bit (TRST)
also clears the TIM counter registers.
NOTE: If you read TCNTH during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TCNTL
by reading TCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TCNTL
retains the value latched during the break.
Address: T1CNTH, $0021 and T2CNTH, $002C
Bit 7
Read: Bit 15
Write:
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
Bit 0
Bit 8
14
13
12
11
10
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-5. TIM Counter Registers High (TCNTH)
Address: T1CNTL, $0022 and T2CNTL, $002D
Bit 7
Bit 7
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 11-6. TIM Counter Registers Low (TCNTL)
Technical Data
198
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
I/O Registers
11.10.3 TIM Counte r Mod ulo Re g iste rs
The read/write TIM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the
TIM counter. When the TIM counter reaches the modulo value, the
overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIM counter resumes counting
from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte (TMODH)
inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte (TMODL) is
written. Reset sets the TIM counter modulo registers.
Address: T1MODH, $0023 and T2MODH, $002E
Bit 7
Bit 15
1
6
14
1
5
13
1
4
12
1
3
11
1
2
10
1
1
9
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 11-7. TIM Counter Modulo Register High (TMODH)
Address: T1MODL, $0024 and T2MODL, $002F
Bit 7
Bit 7
1
6
6
1
5
5
1
4
4
1
3
3
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 11-8. TIM Counter Modulo Register Low (TMODL)
NOTE: Reset the TIM counter before writing to the TIM counter modulo registers.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
199
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
11.10.4 TIM Cha nne l Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste rs
Each of the TIM channel status and control registers:
•
•
•
•
•
Flags input captures and output compares
Enables input capture and output compare interrupts
Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation
Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare
Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input
capture trigger
•
•
•
Selects output toggling on TIM overflow
Selects 0% and 100% PWM duty cycle
Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
Address: T1SC0, $0025 and T2SC0, $0030
Bit 7
6
CH0IE
0
5
MS0B
0
4
MS0A
0
3
ELS0B
0
2
ELS0A
0
1
TOV0
0
Bit 0
CH0MAX
0
Read: CH0F
Write:
0
0
Reset:
Figure 11-9. TIM Channel 0 Status and Control Register (TSC0)
Address: T1SC1, $0028 and T2SC1, $0033
Bit 7
6
CH1IE
0
5
0
4
MS1A
0
3
ELS1B
0
2
ELS1A
0
1
TOV1
0
Bit 0
CH1MAX
0
Read: CH1F
Write:
0
0
Reset:
0
Figure 11-10. TIM Channel 1 Status and Control Register (TSC1)
Technical Data
200
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
I/O Registers
CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit
When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set
when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is
an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIM
counter registers matches the value in the TIM channel x registers.
When TIM CPU interrupt requests are enabled (CHxIE = 1), clear
CHxF by reading TIM channel x status and control register with CHxF
set and then writing a logic 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request
occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0
to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an interrupt request cannot be lost
due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF.
Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a logic 1 to CHxF has no effect.
1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x
0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x
CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM CPU interrupt service requests on
channel x.
Reset clears the CHxIE bit.
1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled
MSxB — Mode Select Bit B
This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation.
MSxB exists only in the TIM1 channel 0 and TIM2 channel 0 status
and control registers.
Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and
reverts TCH1 to general-purpose I/O.
Reset clears the MSxB bit.
1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled
0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled
MSxA — Mode Select Bit A
When ELSxB:ELSxA ≠ 0:0, this read/write bit selects either input
capture operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation.
See Table 11-3.
1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
0 = Input capture operation
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
201
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
When ELSxB:ELSxA = 0:0, this read/write bit selects the initial output
level of the TCHx pin. See Table 11-3. Reset clears the MSxA bit.
1 = Initial output level low
0 = Initial output level high
NOTE: Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit,
set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIM status and control register
(TSC).
ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits
When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits
control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x.
When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA
control the channel x output behavior when an output compare
occurs.
When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected
to an I/O port, and pin TCHx is available as a general-purpose I/O pin.
Table 11-3 shows how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears the
ELSxB and ELSxA bits.
Table 11-3. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
MSxB:MSxA ELSxB:ELSxA
Mode
Configuration
Pin under port control;
initial output level high
X0
X1
00
00
Output preset
Pin under port control;
initial output level low
00
00
01
10
Capture on rising edge only
Capture on falling edge only
Input capture
Capture on rising or
falling edge
00
11
01
01
01
1X
1X
1X
01
10
11
01
10
11
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
Output
compare or
PWM
Buffered
output
compare or
buffered PWM
Technical Data
202
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
I/O Registers
NOTE: Before enabling a TIM channel register for input capture operation, make
sure that the TCHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks.
TOVx — Toggle On Overflow Bit
When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit
controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIM counter
overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no
effect.
Reset clears the TOVx bit.
1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIM counter overflow
0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIM counter overflow
NOTE: When TOVx is set, a TIM counter overflow takes precedence over a
channel x output compare if both occur at the same time.
CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit
When the TOVx bit is at logic 1, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the
duty cycle of buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100%. As
Figure 11-11 shows, the CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it
is set or cleared. The output stays at the 100% duty cycle level until
the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
CHxMAX
Figure 11-11. CHxMAX Latency
11.10.5 TIM Cha nne l Re g iste rs
These read/write registers contain the captured TIM counter value of the
input capture function or the output compare value of the output
compare function. The state of the TIM channel registers after reset is
unknown.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Technical Data
203
Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule (TIM)
In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the
TIM channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits input captures until the low
byte (TCHxL) is read.
In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of
the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits output compares until the
low byte (TCHxL) is written.
Address: T1CH0H, $0026 and T2CH0H, $0031
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
Bit 0
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-12. TIM Channel 0 Register High (TCH0H)
Address: T1CH0L, $0027 and T2CH0L $0032
Bit 7
6
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-13. TIM Channel 0 Register Low (TCH0L)
Address: T1CH1H, $0029 and T2CH1H, $0034
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
Bit 0
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-14. TIM Channel 1 Register High (TCH1H)
Address: T1CH1L, $002A and T2CH1L, $0035
Bit 7
6
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-15. TIM Channel 1 Register Low (TCH1L)
Technical Data
204
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 12. Tim e b a se Mod ule (TBM)
12.1 Conte nts
12.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
12.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
12.5 Timebase Register Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
12.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
12.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
12.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
12.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
12.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the timebase module (TBM). The TBM will
generate periodic interrupts at user selectable rates using a counter
clocked by the selected OSCCLK clock from the oscillator module. This
TBM version uses 18 divider stages, eight of which are user selectable.
12.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the TBM module include:
•
•
Software programmable 8s, 4s, 2s, 1s, 2ms, 1ms, 0.5ms, and
0.25ms periodic interrupt using 32.768-kHz OSCCLK clock
User selectable oscillator clock source enable during stop mode to
allow periodic wake-up from stop
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timebase Module (TBM)
Technical Data
205
Tim e b a se Mod ule (TBM)
12.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
This module can generate a periodic interrupt by dividing the oscillator
clock frequency, OSCCLK. The counter is initialized to all 0s when
TBON bit is cleared. The counter, shown in Figure 12-1, starts counting
when the TBON bit is set. When the counter overflows at the tap
selected by TBR2:TBR0, the TBIF bit gets set. If the TBIE bit is set, an
interrupt request is sent to the CPU. The TBIF flag is cleared by writing
a 1 to the TACK bit. The first time the TBIF flag is set after enabling the
timebase module, the interrupt is generated at approximately half of the
overflow period. Subsequent events occur at the exact period.
The reference clock OSCCLK is derived from the oscillator module, see
7.3.2 TBM Reference Clock Selection.
TBON
÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2
OSCCLK
From OSC module
(See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC).)
÷ 8
÷ 16
÷ 32
÷ 64
÷ 2048
TBMINT
÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2 ÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 2
÷ 32768 ÷ 65536 ÷ 131072
÷ 262144
TBIF
TBIE
0 0 0
0 0 1
0 1 0
0 1 1
1 0 0
1 0 1
1 1 0
1 1 1
R
SEL
Figure 12-1. Timebase Block Diagram
Technical Data
206
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timebase Module (TBM) MOTOROLA
Timebase Module (TBM)
Timebase Register Description
12.5 Tim e b a se Re g iste r De sc rip tion
The timebase has one register, the TBCR, which is used to enable the
timebase interrupts and set the rate.
Address: $0046
Bit 7
TBIF
6
TBR2
0
5
TBR1
0
4
TBR0
0
3
2
1
TBON
0
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
TACK
0
TBIE
0
0
0
R
= Unimplemented
= Reserved
Figure 12-2. Timebase Control Register (TBCR)
TBIF — Timebase Interrupt Flag
This read-only flag bit is set when the timebase counter has rolled
over.
1 = Timebase interrupt pending
0 = Timebase interrupt not pending
TBR2–TBR0 — Timebase Rate Selection
These read/write bits are used to select the rate of timebase interrupts
as shown in Table 12-1.
Table 12-1. Timebase Rate Selection for OSCCLK = 32.768 kHz
Timebase Interrupt Rate
TBR2
TBR1
TBR0
Divider
Hz
0.125
0.25
0.5
ms
8000
4000
2000
1000
~2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
262144
131072
65536
32768
64
1
512
32
1024
2048
4096
~1
16
~0.5
~0.24
8
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timebase Module (TBM)
Technical Data
207
Tim e b a se Mod ule (TBM)
NOTE: Do not change TBR2–TBR0 bits while the timebase is enabled
(TBON = 1).
TACK — Timebase ACKnowledge
The TACK bit is a write-only bit and always reads as 0. Writing a logic
1 to this bit clears TBIF, the timebase interrupt flag bit. Writing a logic
0 to this bit has no effect.
1 = Clear timebase interrupt flag
0 = No effect
TBIE — Timebase Interrupt Enabled
This read/write bit enables the timebase interrupt when the TBIF bit
becomes set. Reset clears the TBIE bit.
1 = Timebase interrupt enabled
0 = Timebase interrupt disabled
TBON — Timebase Enabled
This read/write bit enables the timebase. Timebase may be turned off
to reduce power consumption when its function is not necessary. The
counter can be initialized by clearing and then setting this bit. Reset
clears the TBON bit.
1 = Timebase enabled
0 = Timebase disabled and the counter initialized to 0s
12.6 Inte rrup ts
The timebase module can interrupt the CPU on a regular basis with a
rate defined by TBR2–TBR0. When the timebase counter chain rolls
over, the TBIF flag is set. If the TBIE bit is set, enabling the timebase
interrupt, the counter chain overflow will generate a CPU interrupt
request. The interrupt vector is defined in Table 2-1 . Vector
Addresses.
Interrupts must be acknowledged by writing a logic 1 to the TACK bit.
Technical Data
208
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timebase Module (TBM)
MOTOROLA
Timebase Module (TBM)
Low-Power Modes
12.7 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
12.7.1 Wa it Mod e
The timebase module remains active after execution of the WAIT
instruction. In wait mode, the timebase register is not accessible by the
CPU.
If the timebase functions are not required during wait mode, reduce the
power consumption by stopping the timebase before enabling the WAIT
instruction.
12.7.2 Stop Mod e
The timebase module may remain active after execution of the STOP
instruction if the oscillator has been enabled to operate during stop mode
through the stop mode oscillator enable bit (STOP_ICLKEN,
STOP_RCLKEN, or STOP_XCLKEN) for the selected oscillator in the
CONFIG2 register. The timebase module can be used in this mode to
generate a periodic walk-up from stop mode.
If the oscillator has not been enabled to operate in stop mode, the
timebase module will not be active during STOP mode. In stop mode the
timebase register is not accessible by the CPU.
If the timebase functions are not required during stop mode, reduce the
power consumption by stopping the timebase before enabling the STOP
instruction.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Timebase Module (TBM)
Technical Data
209
Tim e b a se Mod ule (TBM)
Technical Data
210
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Timebase Module (TBM) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 13. Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
13.1 Conte nts
13.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
13.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
13.4 PWM Period and Resolution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
13.5 PWM Automatic Phase Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
13.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.7 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.8 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
13.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10.1 PWM Control Register (PWMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
13.10.2 PWM Clock Control Register (PWMCCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
13.10.3 PWM Data Registers (PWMDR0–PWMDR2) . . . . . . . . . .219
13.10.4 PWM Phase Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
13.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the pulse width modulator (PWM) module. The
PWM module provides three 8-bit PWM output channels, with an
independent 8-bit counter for each channel. The PWM period is equal to
1
256 × --------------- seconds, where PCLK is the PWM counter clock.
ꢀPCLKꢀ
For a 32MHz PWM counter clock, the PWM period is 8µs (a PWM
frequency of 125kHz). The automatic phase control feature allows
phase delays between the channels.
Figure 13-2 shows the structure of the PWM module.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Technical Data
211
Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
NOTE: The CGM’s PLL must be running (enabled by setting PLLON bit in the
PLL control register) if the CGMVCLK is selected for the PWM module
input clock. (See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).)
13.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the PWM include the following:
•
•
•
•
Three independent PWM channels with independent counters
PWM input clock select
PWM input clock prescaler
Automatic phase control
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
PCH1
0
Bit 0
PCH0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
PWMEN2 PWMEN1 PWMEN0
PCH2
PWM Control Register
(PWMCR)
$0051
0
PCLKSEL
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PWM Clock Control
PCLK1
0
PCLK0
0
$0052
$0053
$0054
$0055
$0056
Register Write:
(PWMCCR)
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0PWMD7 0PWMD6 0PWMD5 0PWMD4 0PWMD3 0PWMD2 0PWMD1 0PWMD0
PWM Data Register 0
(PWMDR0)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1PWMD7 1PWMD6 1PWMD5 1PWMD4 1PWMD3 1PWMD2 1PWMD1 1PWMD0
PWM Data Register 1
(PWMDR1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2PWMD7 2PWMD6 2PWMD5 2PWMD4 2PWMD3 2PWMD2 2PWMD1 2PWMD0
PWM Data Register 2
(PWMDR2)
0
PHEN
0
0
PHD6
0
0
PHD5
0
0
PHD4
0
0
PHD3
0
0
PHD2
0
0
PHD1
0
0
PHD0
0
PWM Phase Control
Register Write:
(PWMPCR)
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-1. PWM I/O Register Summary
Technical Data
212
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) MOTOROLA
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Features
INTERNAL BUS
CGMOUT
PWMCLK
A
CHANNEL 0
FROM CGM
÷
2
÷
2
÷ 2
1
CGMVCLK
B
PWMCR
S
8-BIT PWM
DATA REGISTER
PCLK1
PCLK0
WHEN PCLKSEL=0,
PWMCLK=CGMOUT.
MUX
P
PCLKSEL
PWMCCR
IF CGMVCLK IS SELECTED,
CGM’S PLL MUST BE RUNNING.
PWMR0
CLK
8-BIT
DATA REGISTER
8-BIT COUNTER
8-BIT COUNTER
8-BIT COUNTER
BUFFER
TO
TO
CHANNEL 2
CHANNEL 1
ZERO
DETECTOR
COMPARATOR
CHANNEL 0 OUTPUT LOGIC
S
PWM0
1
LATCH
R
Q
B
A
PTC0/PWM0/CD
PIN
A
S
1
B
S
A IS SELECTED
WHEN S=0
TO/FROM
PTC0
PCH0
CDIF
CDOEN
LOGIC
PWMCR FROM
CONFIG2
ANALOG
MODULE
CHANNEL 1 OUTPUT LOGIC
CHANNEL 2 OUTPUT LOGIC
1
1
PWM1
PWM2
B
A
B
A
PTC1/PWM1
PIN
PTC2/PWM2
PIN
TO/FROM
PTC1
TO/FROM
PTC2
S
S
LOGIC
LOGIC
A IS SELECTED
WHEN S=0
A IS SELECTED
WHEN S=0
PCH1
PCH2
PWMCR
PWMCR
Figure 13-2. PWM Block Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Technical Data
213
Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
13.4 PWM Pe riod a nd Re solution
1
1
The PWM period is equal to 256 × --------------- , resolution is --------------- , where
ꢀPCLKꢀ
ꢀPCLKꢀ
PCLK is the PWM counter clock. The value in the PWM data register
(PWMDR) defines the period where the PWM output is high, the low
period is equal to 256 minus that value. Each PWM channel has its own
counter and I/O control bits so it can be turned on and off independently.
Figure 13-3 shows the PWM output waveforms for a channel with
different values in the PWM data register.
PWM PERIOD = 256 × T
PWMDR = 256
PWMDR = 1
T
255 × T
128 × T
128 × T
PWMDR = 128
255 × T
T
PWMDR = 255
NOTE: T =
1
P
CLK
Figure 13-3. PWM Output Waveforms
Technical Data
214
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM) MOTOROLA
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
PWM Automatic Phase Control
13.5 PWM Autom a tic Pha se Control
The automatic phase control function allows precise phase difference
between the PWM output signals.
Figure 13-4 shows the phase delays between the PWM output signals.
256 × T
256 × T
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
256 × T
PHASE VALUE 1
256 × T
PHASE VALUE 2
Figure 13-4. PWM Automatic Phase Control
Use the following steps to generate phase difference on PWM channels:
1. Clear PWM enable bits, PWMEN[0:2], to logic 0.
2. Write delay value in PHD[0:6].
3. Set PWM automatic phase control enable bit, PHEN, to logic 1.
4. Set the PWM channel enable bits, PCH[0:2], to logic 1.
5. Set the PWM enable bits, PWMEN[0:2], to logic 1, to enable the
PWM counters.
When phase control is enabled, the PWM2 counter will start counting
immediately, but the PWM1 and PWM0 counters will be held at zero.
After the PWM2 counter reaches the phase value, PH[0:6], the PWM1
counter is released and starts counting. Finally, when the PMW1 counter
reaches the phase value, PH[0:6], PWM0 is released and starts
counting. It is possible to change the value of PH[0:6] after the PWM1
counter has started and before the start of the PWM0 counter. This way,
difference phases can be set between PWM2 and PWM1; PWM1 and
PWM0.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Technical Data
215
Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
The PH[0:6] value is used once to determine the start-up time of the
different PWM counters. After that, all PWM counters become free
running counters and the phase between the counters will remain
unchanged. Changing the value of PH[0:6] after all PWM counters are
running has no effect. The counters must first be disabled by clearing the
PWM enable bits, PWMEN[0:2], to logic 0, before a new phase value is
effective.
Automatic phase control is only available with two (PWM2–PWM1) or
three (PWM2–PWM0) PWM channels.
13.6 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
13.7 Wa it Mod e
The PWM module remains active after the execution of a WAIT
instruction. In wait mode, the PWM registers are not accessible by the
CPU.
If PWM functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by disabling the PWM before executing the WAIT
instruction.
13.8 Stop Mod e
The PWM is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The
STOP instruction does not affect register conditions or the state of the
PWM counters and outputs. PWM operation resumes when the MCU
exits stop mode after an external interrupt.
Technical Data
216
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
MOTOROLA
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
I/O Signals
13.9 I/ O Sig na ls
The PWM module has three output pins shared with port C:
PTC0/PWM0/CD, PWM1/PTC1, and PTC2/PWM2. PTC0 is also shared
with current flow detect output, CD, of the analog module, see (see 18.5
Port C).
13.10 I/ O Re g iste rs
These I/O registers control PWM operation:
•
•
•
•
PWM control register (PWMCR)
PWM clock control register (PWMCCR)
PWM phase control register (PWMPCR)
Three PWM data registers (PWMDR0–PWMDR2)
13.10.1 PWM Control Re g iste r (PWMCR)
The PWM control register (PWMCR) enables/disables the independent
PWM counters and port pins used for the PWM channels.
Address: $0051
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
PWMEN2 PWMEN1 PWMEN0
PCH2
0
PCH1
0
PCH0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-5. PWM Control Register (PWMCR)
PWMEN2–PWMEN0 — PWM Enable Bits
Writing a 0 to the PWMENx bit clears the corresponding PWM counter
and force the PWM channel x output to 0. Reset clears these bits.
1 = PWM channel x enabled
0 = PWM channel x is disabled; PWM counter cleared to zero and
PWM channel x output forced to zero
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Technical Data
217
Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
PCH2–PCH0 — PWM Channel Enable Bits
Setting a bit will enable the corresponding port pin to be a PWM
output pin. When a bit is set, the DDR bit has no effect on the port
function.
1 = Port pin is enabled for PWM output
0 = Port pin is standard I/O pin
Exception for PTC0/PWM0/CD control:
Table 13-1. PTC0 Pin Configuration
CDOEN Bit
($001D)
PCH0 Bit
($0051)
Pin
Pin function
0
0
1
0
1
PTC0
PWM0
CD
PTC0/PWM0/CD
X
13.10.2 PWM Cloc k Control Re g iste r (PWMCCR)
The PWM clock control register (PWMCCR) selects and defines the
clock to the PWM counter, PCLK
.
Address: $0052
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PCLKSEL
0
PCLK1
0
PCLK0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-6. PWM Clock Control Register (PWMCCR)
PCLKSEL — PWM Input Clock Select Bit
This bit selects either the CGMOUT or CGMVCLK clock as the input
clock to the PWM counters. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Select CGMVCLK as PWM input clock
0 = Select CGMOUT (CPU bus clock) as PWM input clock
Technical Data
218
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
MOTOROLA
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
I/O Registers
PCLK1–PCLK0 — PWM Clock Prescaler Bits
These two bits select the divide ratio used to divide the PWM input
clock. Table 13-2 shows the available clock divisions.
Table 13-2. PWM Counter Clock Prescaler Selection
PWM Clock, PCLK
Source clock ÷ 1
Source clock ÷ 2
Source clock ÷ 4
Source clock ÷ 8
PCLK1
PCLK0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
13.10.3 PWM Da ta Re g iste rs (PWMDR0–PWMDR2)
The three PWM data registers (PWMDR0–PWMDR2) defines the high
period for corresponding PWM channels.
Address: $0053
Read:
0PWMD7 0PWMD6 0PWMD5 0PWMD4 0PWMD3 0PWMD2 0PWMD1 0PWMD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-7. PWM Data Register 0 (PWMDR0)
Address: $0054
Read:
1PWMD7 1PWMD6 1PWMD5 1PWMD4 1PWMD3 1PWMD2 1PWMD1 1PWMD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-8. PWM Data Register 1 (PWMDR1)
Address: $0055
Read:
2PWMD7 2PWMD6 2PWMD5 2PWMD4 2PWMD3 2PWMD2 2PWMD1 2PWMD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-9. PWM Data Register 2 (PWMDR2)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
Technical Data
219
Pulse Wid th Mod ula tor (PWM)
The value of each PWM data register is continuously compared with the
content of a PWM counter to determine the state of each PWM channel
output pin.
A value of $00 loaded into these register results in a continuously low
output on the corresponding PWM output pin. A value of $80 results in a
50% duty cycle output and so on. The maximum value, $FF correspond
to an output which is a "1" for 255/256 of the PWM cycle.
A new value written to the PWM data register will not be effective until
the end of the current PWM period. Upon the end of the current PWM
period, the contain of the PWM data register is loaded into the PWM data
buffer, the value of the PWM data buffer controls the PWM output.
13.10.4 PWM Pha se Control Re g iste r
The PWM phase control register (PWMPCR) enables the automatic
phase control and sets the phase values between the PWM channels.
Address: $0056
Read:
PHEN
PHD6
0
PHD5
0
PHD4
0
PHD3
0
PHD2
0
PHD1
0
PHD0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
Figure 13-10. PWM Phase Control Register (PWMPCR)
PHEN — PWM Automatic Phase Control Enable Bit
Setting this bit to 1 will enable the automatic phase control function.
Reset clears this bit.
1 = Automatic phase control enabled
0 = Automatic phase control disabled
PHD6–PHD0 — PWM Phase Value Bits
This 7-bit phase value is used to determined the start-up time of the
different PWM counters when PHEN bit is set. Reset clears these bits.
Technical Data
220
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 14. Ana log Mod ule
14.1 Conte nts
14.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
14.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
14.4.1 On-Chip Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
14.4.2 Two-Stage Amplifier. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
14.4.3 Amplifier Response Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
14.4.4 Current Flow Detection Amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.4.5 Current Flow Detect Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
14.7 Analog Module I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14.7.1 Analog Module Control Register (AMCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
14.7.2 Analog Module Gain Control Register (AMGCR). . . . . . . .227
14.7.3 Analog Module Status and Control Register (AMSCR) . . .228
14.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the analog module. The analog module is
designed to be use in conjunction with the analog-to-digital converter
module for monitoring temperature, charge and discharge currents in
smart battery applications.
NOTE: The analog module uses clock signals from the CGM’s PLL, therefore
the PLL must be running — PLLON bit in the PLL control register must
be set. (See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
221
Analog Module
Ana log Mod ule
14.3 Fe a ture s
The features of the analog module include the following:
•
•
•
Temperature sensor
Current flow detection amplifier
Two-stage amplifier
ATD1
BATT +
ANALOG MODULE
TO ADC
ATD0
ADCICLK
FROM ADC
OPIN2/
ATD1
DO[2:0]
CLOCK
DIVIDER
AMCDIV[1:0]
AMCLK
GAINA[3:0]
GAINB[3:0]
EXTERNAL
THERMISTOR
INTERNAL
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
BATT –
INTERNAL
REFERENCE
–
DOF
OPCH[1:0]
BATT +
+
CGMVCLK
FROM CGM
IN3
IN2
IN1
IN0
OPOUT
TO ADC
2-STAGE
AMP
OPIN1/
ATD0
I
SENSE
R
SENSE
0.01Ω
OPIFR
OPIF
OPIF
CGMXCLK
ANALOG MODULE
INTERRUPT REQUEST
V
BATT –
V
SSAM
DD
TO IRQ
LOGIC
D
Q
–9mV
–
CDIF
+
V
SSA
V
DET
R
CDIFR
CDIF
AMIEN
PTC0/
PWM0/
CD
PTC0
LOGIC
FROM CONFIG2
CDOEN
Figure 14-1. Analog Module Block Diagram
Technical Data
222
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog Module
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Functional Description
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
PWR1
0
6
PWR0
0
5
4
3
AMIEN
0
2
DO2
0
1
DO1
0
Bit 0
DO0
0
Read:
Analog Module Control
OPCH1 OPCH0
$000E
Register Write:
(AMCR)
Reset:
0
0
Read:
Analog Module Gain
GAINB3 GAINB2 GAINB1 GAINB0 GAINA3 GAINA2 GAINA1 GAINA0
$000F
$0010
Control Register Write:
(AMGCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
OPIF
DOF
CDIF
Analog Module Status and
AMCDIV1 AMCDIV0
Control Register Write:
OPIFR
U
CDIFR
U
(AMSCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
U = Unaffected
Figure 14-2. Analog Module I/O Register Summary
14.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Figure 14-1 shows the block diagram of the analog module. The central
component of the analog module is the two-stage gain amplifier used for
amplifying the small signals on the analog input pins, OPIN1 and OPIN2.
These two signals feed into a multiplexer together with the signal from
the internal temperature sensor and a reference input. The selected
signal is then fed into the two-stage gain amplifier before going into the
analog-to-digital converter (ADC) as OPOUT. The OPIN1 and OPIN2
pins can also feed directly into the ADC as channels ATD0 and ATD1
respectively, without any amplification.
14.4.1 On-Chip Te m p e ra ture Se nsor
The on-chip temperature sensor is designed to measure temperatures
from –20°C to 70 °C. The output of the internal temperature sensor
TSOUT is amplified by the two-stage amplifier. The amplified
temperature sensor signal is routed to the analog-to-digital converter for
analog-to-digital conversion (see Figure 14-1).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
223
Analog Module
Ana log Mod ule
14.4.2 Two-Sta g e Am p lifie r
The two-stage amplifier is used to amplify small input signals from the
on-chip temperature sensor or external voltage sources such as external
thermistor and current sensing resistor, for temperature and current
monitoring. The amplified signal, OPOUT, is fed to the ADC module for
analog-to-digital conversion. The gain of the two-stage amplifier is
defined by the GAINAx and GAINBx bits in the analog module gain
control register (AMGCR) (see Figure 14-1).
14.4.3 Am p lifie r Re sp onse Tim e
The two-stage amplifier requires the input signal to be stable for
sampling. This signal hold-time varies with gain setting for stage-1 of the
two-stage amplifier, and is determined by the formula:
10 + [(Gain of stage-1 amplifier – 1) × 2] AMCLK cycles
The AMCLK clock is the analog amplifier clock, which is divided from the
ADC clock, ADCICLK.
The time for the two-stage amplifier to amplify the input signal to the
desired output is dependent on the gain setting in both stages of the two-
stage amplifier. The amplifier response time is determined by the
formula:
70 + (8 × Gain of stage-1) + (6 × Gain of stage-2) AMCLK cycles
This amplifier response time should be added to the ADC conversion
time to obtain the total time for the small-signal conversion.
Therefore, conversion time for OPINx signals, with amplification is:
Amplifier response time + ADC conversion time
Technical Data
224
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog Module
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Interrupts
14.4.4 Curre nt Flow De te c tion Am p lifie r
The current flow detection amplifier is used to detect charge and
discharge current flowing through an external sensing resistor, RSENSE
The current flow detection flag CDIF is set when the voltage at OPIN1
.
exceeds –9mV (typical) (0.9 ampere when RSENSE = 0.01Ω). When set,
CDIF can generate an interrupt request to the CPU when the analog
module interrupt enable bit AMIEN is set (see Figure 14-1).
14.4.5 Curre nt Flow De te c t Outp ut
The current detect flag, CDIF, can be configured for direct control to
other external circuitry. When the CDOEN bit in CONFIG2 is set, the
status of CDIF is reflected on the PTC0/PWM0/CD pin. (See 5.5
Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) and 18.5 Port C.)
14.5 Inte rrup ts
When the AMIEN bit is set, the analog module is capable of generating
CPU interrupt requests. The interrupt vector is defined in Table 2-1 .
Vector Addresses.
14.6 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
14.6.1 Wa it Mod e
14.6.2 Stop Mod e
In wait mode the analog module if enabled, continues to operate and
may generate an interrupt to trigger the MCU out of wait mode.
In stop mode, the temperature sensor and the two-stage amplifier are
disabled, but the current flow detection amplifier (when enabled)
continues to operate if the oscillator is enabled in stop mode. When
AMIEN is set, CDIF can be used to wake-up the MCU from the stop
mode.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
225
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Ana log Mod ule
14.7 Ana log Mod ule I/ O Re g iste rs
Three registers control and monitor the operation of the analog module:
•
•
•
Analog module control register (AMCR) — $000E
Analog module gain control register (AMGCR) — $000F
Analog module status and control register (AMSCR) — $0010
14.7.1 Ana log Mod ule Control Re g iste r (AMCR)
The analog module control register (AMCR):
•
•
•
•
Powers on and off analog sub-modules
Selects the input signal to the two-stage amplifier
Enables analog module interrupt requests
Offset adjustment for calibration
Address: $000E
Bit 7
6
PWR0
0
5
4
3
AMIEN
0
2
DO2
0
1
DO1
0
Bit 0
DO0
0
Read:
PWR1
Write:
OPCH1 OPCH0
Reset:
0
0
0
Figure 14-3. Analog Module Control Register (AMCR)
PWR1–PWR0 — Analog Module Power Control Bits
These read/write bits power on/off the different functions within the
analog module. Reset clears the PWR1 and PWR0 bits.
Table 14-1. Analog Module Power Control
Current Detect
Module
Temperature
Sensor
Two-Stage
Amplifier
PWR1
PWR0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Off
On
Off
On
Off
Off
Off
On
Off
Off
On
On
Technical Data
226
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog Module
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Analog Module I/O Registers
OPCH1–OPCH0 — Amplifier Channel Select Control Bits
These read/write bits select the input source to be amplified by the
two-stage amplifier. Reset clears the OPCH1 and OPCH0 bits.
Table 14-2. Amplifier Channel Select Control bits
OPCH1
OPCH0
Input Source
Comments
External negative reference
External pin
VSSAM
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
OPIN1/ATD0
OPIN2/ATD1
External pin
TSOUT (internal)
Internal temperature sensor
AMIEN — Analog Module Interrupt Enable
Setting this bit will enable the CDIF and OPIF flags to generate an
CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the AMIEN bit.
1 = Analog module CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Analog module CPU interrupt requests disabled
DO[2:0] — DC Offset Control Bits
Set these bits to zero for optimum analog module performance.
14.7.2 Ana log Mod ule Ga in Control Re g iste r (AMGCR)
The analog module gain control register (AMGCR) selects the two gains
for the two-stage amplifier.
Address: $000F
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
GAINB3 GAINB2 GAINB1 GAINB0 GAINA3 GAINA2 GAINA1 GAINA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 14-4. Analog Module Gain Control Register (AMGCR)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
227
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Ana log Mod ule
GAINB[3:0] — Analog Module 2nd-stage Gain Control Bits
These read/write bits define the 2nd-stage gain of the two-stage
amplifier. The overall gain of the amplifier equals the 1st-stage gain
multiplied by the 2nd-stage gain. Reset clears the GAINB[3:0] bits.
GAINA[3:0] — Analog Module 1st-stage Gain Control Bits
These read/write bits define the 1st-stage gain of the two-stage
amplifier. The overall gain of the amplifier equals the 1st-stage gain
multiplied by the 2nd-stage gain. Reset clears the GAINA[3:0] bits.
Table 14-3. Analog Module Gain Values
GAINx3
GAINx2
GAINx1
GAINx0
Amplifier Gain
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
14.7.3 Ana log Mod ule Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r (AMSCR)
The analog module status and control register (AMSCR):
•
Selects input clock divider value
Monitors and clears the amplifier ready interrupt flag
Monitors DC offset flag
Monitors and clears the current detect interrupt flag
•
•
•
Technical Data
228
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Analog Module
Analog Module
Analog Module I/O Registers
Address: $0010
Bit 7
6
5
0
4
3
0
2
1
0
Bit 0
Read:
OPIF
DOF
CDIF
AMCDIV1 AMCDIV0
Write:
OPIFR
U
CDIFR
U
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
U = Unaffected
Figure 14-5. Analog Module Status and Control Register (AMSCR)
AMCDIV[1:0] — Analog Module Clock Divider Control Bits
These read/write bits select the analog module input clock divider
value. The ADC clock, ADICLK, is divided by this value to obtain the
AMCLK. Reset clears the AMCDIV[1:0] bits.
Table 14-4. Analog Module Clock Divider Select
AMCDIV1
AMCDIV0
Divider Value
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
2
4
8
16
Set AMCDIV1 and AMCDIV0 bits to zero for optimum analog module
performance.
OPIFR — Amplifier Ready Interrupt Flag Reset
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the OPIF bit. OPIFR
always reads as a logic 0. Reset does not affect OPIFR.
1 = Clear OPIF bit
0 = No affect on OPIF bit
OPIF — Amplifier Ready Interrupt Flag
This read-only bit is set when the output of the two-stage amplifier is
ready. A CPU interrupt request will be generated if the AMIEN bit is
also set. Reset clears OPIF bit.
1 = Two-stage amplifier output is ready
0 = Two-stage amplifier output is not ready
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA
Technical Data
229
Analog Module
Ana log Mod ule
DOF — DC Offset Flag
This is a reserved bit.
CDIFR — Current Detect Interrupt Flag Reset
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the CDIF bit. CDIFR
always reads as a logic 0. Reset does not affect CDIFR.
1 = Clear CDIF bit
0 = No affect on CDIF bit
CDIF — Current Detect Interrupt Flag
This read-only bit is set when the voltage developed across the sense
resistor, RSENSE is equal to or greater than VDET (the current sense
amplifier comparator trip voltage, typically –9mV). CDIF generates an
CPU interrupt request if AMIEN bit is also set. The CDIF bit is cleared
by writing a logic 1 to the CDIFR bit. Reset clears CDIF bit.
1 = Current detect interrupt has occurred
0 = No current detect interrupt since CDIF last cleared
Technical Data
230
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog Module
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 15. Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.1 Conte nts
15.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
15.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
15.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
15.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
15.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
15.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
15.4.5 Auto-scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
15.4.6 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
15.4.7 Data Register Interlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.4.8 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
15.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.1 ADC Voltage In (VADIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.2 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.3 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
15.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.7.5 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
15.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
15.8.2 ADC Clock Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
15.8.3 ADC Data Register 0 (ADRH0 and ADRL0). . . . . . . . . . . .246
15.8.4 ADC Auto-Scan Mode Data Registers (ADRL1–ADRL3). .248
15.8.5 ADC Auto-Scan Control Register (ADASCR). . . . . . . . . . .248
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
231
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the analog-to-digital converter (ADC). The ADC
is a 14-channel 10-bit linear successive approximation ADC.
15.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the ADC module include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Fourteen channels with multiplexed input
High impedance buffered input
Linear successive approximation with monotonicity
10-bit resolution
Single or continuous conversion
Auto-scan conversion on four channels
Conversion complete flag or conversion complete interrupt
Selectable ADC clock
Conversion result justification
– 8-bit truncated mode
– Right justified mode
– Left justified mode
– Left justified sign mode
Technical Data
232
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Features
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
AIEN
0
5
4
ADCH4
1
3
ADCH3
1
2
ADCH2
1
1
Bit 0
Read: COCO
ADC Status and Control
ADCO
0
ADCH1
ADCH0
$0057
Register Write:
(ADSCR)
Reset:
Read:
0
1
0
1
0
ADC Clock Control
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADIV0
ADICLK MODE1 MODE0
$0058
$0059
$005A
$005B
$005C
$005D
$005E
Register Write:
R
(ADICLK)
Reset:
0
ADx
R
0
ADx
R
0
ADx
R
0
ADx
R
0
ADx
R
1
ADx
R
0
ADx
R
0
Read:
ADx
R
ADC Data Register High 0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
(ADRH0)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADx
R
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 1
(ADRL1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 2
(ADRL3)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 3
(ADRL3)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADC Auto-scan Control
AUTO1
AUTO0
0
ASCAN
0
Register Write:
(ADASCR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-1. ADC I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
233
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
The ADC provides thirteen pins for sampling external sources at pins
PTA0/ATD2–PTA5/ATD7, PTC3/ATD8–PTC7/ATD12, and
OPIN1–OPIN2; one internal source from the analog module. An analog
multiplexer allows the single ADC converter to select one of fourteen
ADC channels as ADC voltage in (VADIN). VADIN is converted by the
successive approximation register-based analog-to-digital converter.
When the conversion is completed, ADC places the result in the ADC
data register, high and low byte (ADRH0 and ADRL0), and sets a flag or
generates an interrupt.
An additional three ADC data registers (ADRL1–ADRL3) are available to
store the individual converted data for ADC channels ATD1–ATD3 when
the auto-scan mode is enabled. Data from channel ATD0 is stored in
ADRL0 in the auto-scan mode.
Figure 15-2 shows the structure of the ADC module.
15.4.1 ADC Port I/ O Pins
PTA0–PTA5 and PTC3–PTC7 are general-purpose I/O pins that are
shared with the ADC channels, OPIN1 and OPIN2 are two analog inputs
that are always connected to the ADC channel select multiplexer. The
channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], define which ADC channel/port pin will
be used as the input signal. The ADC overrides the port I/O logic by
forcing that pin as input to the ADC. The remaining ADC channels/port
pins are controlled by the port I/O logic and can be used as general-
purpose I/O pins. Writes to the port data register or data direction
register will not have any affect on the port pin that is selected by the
ADC. Read of a port pin which is in use by the ADC will return the pin
condition if the corresponding DDR bit is at logic 0. If the DDR bit is at
logic 1, the value in the port data latch is read.
Technical Data
234
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
15.4.2 Volta g e Conve rsion
When the input voltage to the ADC equals VREFH, the ADC converts the
signal to $3FF (full scale). If the input voltage equals VREFL, the ADC
converts it to $000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL is a
straight-line linear conversion. All other input voltages will result in $3FF
if greater than VREFH and $000 if less than VREFL
.
NOTE: Input voltage should not exceed the analog supply voltages.
INTERNAL
DATA BUS
READ DDRAx/DDRCx
DISABLE
WRITE DDRAx/DDRCx
DDRAx/DDRCx
RESET
WRITE PTAx/PTCx
PTAx/PTCx
PTAx/PTCx
READ PTAx/PTCx
ATD2–ATD12
(11 CHANNELS)
DISABLE
ADC DATA REGISTERS
OPIN1
OPIN2
ADRH0 ADRL0
ADRL1
ADRL2
V
REFH
ADRL3
V
REFL
OPOUT
FROM
ANALOG MODULE
ADC
VOLTAGE IN
CONVERSION
COMPLETE
(V
)
ADIN
CHANNEL
SELECT
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
ADC
ADCICLK
AIEN
COCO
MUX
ASCAN
CGMXCLK
CLOCK
GENERATOR
BUS CLOCK
ADCH[4:0]
ADIV[2:0] ADICLK
2-BIT UP-COUNTER
AUTO[1:0]
Figure 15-2. ADC Block Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
235
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.4.3 Conve rsion Tim e
Conversion starts after a write to the ADSCR. One conversion will take
between 16 and 17 ADC clock cycles, therefore:
16 to17 ADC cycles
Conversion time =
ADC frequency
Number of bus cycles = conversion time × bus frequency
The ADC conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and
the divide ratio selected. The clock source is either the bus clock or
CGMXCLK and is selectable by the ADICLK bit located in the ADC clock
register. The divide ratio is selected by the ADIV[2:0] bits.
For example, if a 4MHz CGMXCLK is selected as the ADC input clock
source, with a divide-by-four prescale, and the bus speed is set at 2MHz:
16 to17 ADC cycles
Conversion time =
= 16 to 17 µs
4MHz ÷ 4
Number of bus cycles = 16 µs × 2MHz = 32 to 34 cycles
NOTE: The ADC frequency must be between fADIC minimum and fADIC
maximum to meet ADC specifications. (See 24.12 5.0V ADC Electrical
Characteristics.)
Since an ADC cycle may comprised of several bus cycles (two in the
previous example) and the start of a conversion is initiated by a bus cycle
write to the ADSCR, from zero to two additional bus cycles may occur
before the start of the initial ADC cycle. This results in a fractional ADC
cycle and is represented as the 17th cycle.
NOTE: When OPOUT is selected as the ADC input, VADIN, the conversion time
is the accumulation of the op-amp settling time and the normal ADC
conversion time. After writing to the ADSCR to initiate a conversion
cycle, the ADC module sends a signal to the analog module for a
OPOUT output. A signal will be sent back to the ADC by the analog
module to indicate that OPOUT signal is ready for sampling. Upon
receiving this signal, the ADC module starts its normal conversion cycle.
(See 24.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics.)
Technical Data
236
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
15.4.4 Continuous Conve rsion
In the continuous conversion mode, the ADC continuously converts the
selected channel, filling the ADC data register with new data after each
conversion. Data from the previous conversion will be overwritten
whether that data has been read or not. Conversions will continue until
the ADCO bit is cleared. The COCO bit is set after each conversion and
can be cleared by writing to the ADC status and control register or
reading of the ADRL0 data register.
15.4.5 Auto-sc a n Mod e
In auto-scan mode, the ADC input channel is selected by the value of the
2-bit up-counter, instead of the channel select bits, ADCH[4:0]. The
value of the counter also defines the data register ADRLx to be used to
store the conversion result. When ASCAN bit is set, a write to ADC
status and control register (ADSCR) will reset the auto-scan up-counter
and ADC conversion will start on the channel 0 up to the channel number
defined by the integer value of AUTO[1:0]. After a channel conversion is
completed, data is stored in ADRLx and the COCO-bit will be set. The
counter value will be incremented by 1 and a new conversion will start.
This process will continue until the counter value reaches the value of
AUTO[1:0]. When this happens, it indicates that the current channel is
the last channel to be converted. Upon the completion on the last
channel, the counter value will not be incremented and no further
conversion will be performed. To start another auto-scan cycle, a write
to ADSCR must be performed.
NOTE: The system only provides 8-bit data storage in auto-scan code, user
must clear MODE[1:0] bits to select 8-bit truncation mode before
entering auto-scan mode.
It is recommended that user should disable the auto-scan function
before switching channel and also before entering STOP mode!
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
237
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.4.6 Re sult Justific a tion
The conversion result may be formatted in four different ways.
•
Left justified
Right justified
•
•
•
Left justified sign data mode
8-bit truncation
All four of these modes are controlled using MODE0 and MODE1 bits
located in the ADC clock control register (ADICLK).
Left justification will place the eight most significant bits (MSB) in the
corresponding ADC data register high (ADRH). This may be useful if the
result is to be treated as an 8-bit result where the least significant two
bits, located in the ADC data register low (ADRL) can be ignored.
However, you must read ADRL after ADRH or else the interlocking will
prevent all new conversions from being stored.
Right justification will place only the two MSBs in the corresponding ADC
data register high (ADRH) and the eight LSB bits in ADC data register
low (ADRL). This mode of operation typically is used when a 10-bit
unsigned result is desired.
Left justified sign data mode is similar to left justified mode with one
exception. The MSB of the 10-bit result, AD9 located in ADRH is
complemented. This mode of operation is useful when a result,
represented as a signed magnitude from mid-scale, is needed.
Finally, 8-bit truncation mode will place the eight MSBs in ADC data
register low (ADRL). The two LSBs are dropped. This mode of operation
is used when compatibility with 8-bit ADC designs are required. No
interlocking between ADRH and ADRL is present.
Technical Data
238
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Interrupts
15.4.7 Da ta Re g iste r Inte rloc king
Reading ADRH in any 10-bit mode latches the contents of ADRL until
ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read all subsequent ADC results will be lost.
This register interlocking can also be reset by a write to the ADC status
and control register, or ADC clock control register. A power-on reset or
reset will also clear the interlocking. Note that an external conversion
request will not reset the lock.
15.4.8 Monotonic ity
The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes.
15.5 Inte rrup ts
When the AIEN bit is set, the ADC module is capable of generating a
CPU interrupt after each ADC conversion or after an auto-scan
conversion cycle. A CPU interrupt is generated if the COCO bit is at
logic 0. The COCO bit is not used as a conversion complete flag when
interrupts are enabled. The interrupt vector is defined in Table 2-1 .
Vector Addresses.
15.6 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
15.6.1 Wa it Mod e
The ADC continues normal operation in wait mode. Any enabled CPU
interrupt request from the ADC can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If
the ADC is not required to bring the MCU out of wait mode, power down
the ADC by setting the ADCH[4:0] bits to logic 1’s before executing the
WAIT instruction.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
239
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.6.2 Stop Mod e
The ADC module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction.
Any pending conversion is aborted. ADC conversions resume when the
MCU exits stop mode. Allow one conversion cycle to stabilize the analog
circuitry before attempting a new ADC conversion after exiting stop
mode.
15.7 I/ O Sig na ls
The ADC module has fourteen channels, eleven channels are shared
with port A and port C I/O pins; two channels are analog pins, OPIN1 and
OPIN2, that are shared with the analog module; and one channel,
OPOUT, from the analog module.
15.7.1 ADC Volta g e In (VADIN
)
VADIN is the input voltage signal from one of the fourteen channels to the
ADC module.
15.7.2 ADC Ana log Powe r Pin (VDDA
)
The ADC analog portion uses VDDA as its power pin. Connect the VDDA
pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering may be
necessary to ensure clean VDDA for good results.
NOTE: Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
15.7.3 ADC Ana log Ground Pin (VSSA
)
The ADC analog portion uses VSSA as its ground pin. Connect the VSSA
pin to the same voltage potential as VSS.
Technical Data
240
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
15.7.4 ADC Volta g e Re fe re nc e Hig h Pin (VREFH
)
V
REFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage VREFH
.
Connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDA. There will
be a finite current associated with VREFH (see Section 24. Electrical
Specifications).
NOTE: Route VREFH carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
15.7.5 ADC Volta g e Re fe re nc e Low Pin (VREFL
)
VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin
to the same voltage potential as VSSA. There will be a finite current
associated with VREFL (see Section 24. Electrical Specifications).
15.8 I/ O Re g iste rs
These I/O registers control and monitor ADC operation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
ADC status and control register (ADSCR) — $0057
ADC clock control register (ADICLK) — $0058
ADC data register high 0 (ADRH0) — $0059
ADC data register low 0 (ADRL0) — $005A
ADC data register low 1 (ADRL1) — $005B
ADC data register low 2 (ADRL2) — $005C
ADC data register low 3 (ADRL3) — $005D
ADC auto-scan control register (ADASCR) — $005E
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
241
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.8.1 ADC Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
Function of the ADC status and control register is described here.
Address: $0057
Read: COCO
Write:
AIEN
0
ADCO
0
ADCH4
1
ADCH3
1
ADCH2
1
ADCH1
1
ADCH0
1
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 15-3. ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR)
COCO — Conversions Complete Bit
When the AIEN bit is a logic 0, the COCO is a read-only bit which is
set each time a conversion is completed. This bit is cleared whenever
the ADSCR is written, or whenever the ADC clock control register is
written, or whenever the ADC data register low, ADRLx, is read.
If the AIEN bit is logic 1, the COCO bit always read as logic 0. ADC
interrupt will be generated at the end if an ADC conversion. Reset
clears the COCO bit.
1 = Conversion completed (AIEN = 0)
0 = Conversion not completed (AIEN = 0)/CPU interrupt (AIEN=1)
AIEN — ADC Interrupt Enable Bit
When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at the end of an ADC
conversion. The interrupt signal is cleared when the data register,
ADR0, is read or the ADSCR is written. Reset clears the AIEN bit.
1 = ADC interrupt enabled
0 = ADC interrupt disabled
ADCO — ADC Continuous Conversion Bit
When set, the ADC will convert samples continuously and update the
ADC data register at the end of each conversion. Only one conversion
is allowed when this bit is cleared. Reset clears the ADCO bit.
1 = Continuous ADC conversion
0 = One ADC conversion
This bit should not be set when auto-scan mode is enabled; i.e. when
ASCAN=1.
Technical Data
242
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
ADCH[4:0] — ADC Channel Select Bits
ADCH[4:0] form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of the ADC
channels when not in auto-scan mode. The five channel select bits
are detailed in Table 15-1.
NOTE: Care should be taken when using a port pin as both an analog and a
digital input simultaneously to prevent switching noise from corrupting
the analog signal.
NOTE: Recovery from the disabled state requires one conversion cycle to
stabilize.
Table 15-1. MUX Channel Select
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
ADC Channel
ATD0
Input Select
OPIN1
OPIN2
PTA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
↓
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
↓
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
↓
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
↓
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
↓
ATD1
ATD2
ATD3
PTA1
ATD4
PTA2
ATD5
PTA3
ATD6
PTA4
ATD7
PTA5
ATD8
PTC3
ATD9
PTC4
ATD10
ATD11
ATD12
ATD13
PTC5
PTC6
PTC7
OPOUT
ATD14
↓
Reserved
ATD28
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
VREFH (see Note 2)
VREFL (see Note 2)
—
ATD29
ATD30
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
ADC powered-off
NOTES:
1. If any unused channels are selected, the resulting ADC conversion will be unknown.
2. The voltage levels supplied from internal reference nodes as specified in the table are used to verify the operation of
the ADC converter both in production test and for user applications.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
243
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.8.2 ADC Cloc k Control Re g iste r
The ADC clock control register (ADICLK) selects the clock frequency for
the ADC.
Address: $0058
Read:
ADIV2
Write:
0
0
0
R
0
ADIV1
0
ADIV0
0
ADICLK MODE1 MODE0
Reset:
0
0
0
1
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-4. ADC Clock Control Register (ADICLK)
ADIV[2:0] — ADC Clock Prescaler Bits
ADIV2, ADIV1, and ADIV0 form a 3-bit field which selects the divide
ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal ADC clock.
Table 15-2 shows the available clock configurations. The ADC clock
should be set to between 500kHz and 2MHz.
Table 15-2. ADC Clock Divide Ratio
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADIV0
ADC Clock Rate
ADC input clock ÷ 1
ADC input clock ÷ 2
ADC input clock ÷ 4
ADC input clock ÷ 8
ADC input clock ÷ 16
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
X
0
1
0
1
X
X = don’t care
ADICLK — ADC Input Clock Select Bit
ADICLK selects either bus clock or CGMXCLK as the input clock
source to generate the internal ADC clock. Reset selects CGMXCLK
as the ADC clock source.
Technical Data
244
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
If the external clock (CGMXCLK) is equal to or greater than 1MHz,
CGMXCLK can be used as the clock source for the ADC. If
CGMXCLK is less than 1MHz, use the PLL-generated bus clock as
the clock source. As long as the internal ADC clock is at fADIC, correct
operation can be guaranteed.
1 = Internal bus clock
0 = External clock, CGMXCLK
CGMXCLK or bus frequency
fADIC
=
ADIV[2:0]
MODE1 and MODE0 — Modes of Result Justification
MODE1 and MODE0 selects between four modes of operation. The
manner in which the ADC conversion results will be placed in the ADC
data registers is controlled by these modes of operation. Reset
returns right-justified mode.
Table 15-3. ADC Mode Select
MODE1
MODE0
ADC Clock Rate
8-bit truncated mode
Right justified mode
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Left justified mode
Left justified sign data mode
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
245
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.8.3 ADC Da ta Re g iste r 0 (ADRH0 a nd ADRL0)
The ADC data register 0 consist of a pair of 8-bit registers: high byte
(ADRH0), and low byte (ADRL0). This pair form a 16-bit register to store
the 10-bit ADC result for the selected ADC result justification mode.
In 8-bit truncated mode, the ADRL0 holds the eight most significant bits
(MSBs) of the 10-bit result. The ADRL0 is updated each time an ADC
conversion completes. In 8-bit truncated mode, ADRL0 contains no
interlocking with ADRH0. (See Figure 15-5 . ADRH0 and ADRL0 in 8-
Bit Truncated Mode.)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ADC Data Register High 0
(ADRH0)
$0059
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD9
R
AD8
R
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
$005A
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-5. ADRH0 and ADRL0 in 8-Bit Truncated Mode
In right justified mode the ADRH0 holds the two MSBs, and the ADRL0
holds the eight least significant bits (LSBs), of the 10-bit result. ADRH0
and ADRL0 are updated each time a single channel ADC conversion
completes. Reading ADRH0 latches the contents of ADRL0. Until
ADRL0 is read all subsequent ADC results will be lost.
(See Figure 15-6 . ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Right Justified Mode.)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
AD9
R
Bit 0
AD8
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ADC Data Register High 0
(ADRH0)
$0059
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD7
R
AD6
R
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
$005A
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-6. ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Right Justified Mode
Technical Data
246
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
In left justified mode the ADRH0 holds the eight most significant bits
(MSBs), and the ADRL0 holds the two least significant bits (LSBs), of the
10-bit result. The ADRH0 and ADRL0 are updated each time a single
channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH0 latches the
contents of ADRL0. Until ADRL0 is read all subsequent ADC results will
be lost. (See Figure 15-7 . ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left Justified Mode.)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
AD9
R
6
AD8
R
5
AD7
R
4
AD6
R
3
AD5
R
2
AD4
R
1
AD3
R
Bit 0
AD2
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ADC Data Register High 0
(ADRH0)
$0059
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD1
R
AD0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
$005A
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-7. ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left Justified Mode
In left justified sign mode the ADRH0 holds the eight MSBs with the MSB
complemented, and the ADRL0 holds the two least significant bits
(LSBs), of the 10-bit result. The ADRH0 and ADRL0 are updated each
time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH0
latches the contents of ADRL0. Until ADRL0 is read all subsequent ADC
results will be lost. (See Figure 15-8 . ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left
Justified Sign Data Mode.)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
AD9
R
6
AD8
R
5
AD7
R
4
AD6
R
3
AD5
R
2
AD4
R
1
AD3
R
Bit 0
AD2
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ADC Data Register High 0
(ADRH0)
$0059
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD1
R
AD0
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADC Data Register Low 0
(ADRL0)
$005A
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 15-8. ADRH0 and ADRL0 in Left Justified Sign Data Mode
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
247
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
15.8.4 ADC Auto-Sc a n Mod e Da ta Re g iste rs (ADRL1–ADRL3)
The ADC data registers 1 to 3 (ADRL1–ADRL3), are 8-bit registers for
conversion results in 8-bit truncated mode, for channels ATD1 to ATD3,
when the ADC is operating in auto-scan mode (MODE[1:0] = 00).
Address: ADRL1, $005B; ADRL2, $005C; and ADRL3, $005D
Read:
Write:
Reset:
AD7
R
AD6
AD5
R
AD4
R
AD3
R
AD2
R
AD1
R
AD0
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 15-9. ADC Data Register Low 1 to 3 (ADRL1–ADRL3)
15.8.5 ADC Auto-Sc a n Control Re g iste r (ADASCR)
The ADC auto-scan control register (ADASCR) enables and controls the
ADC auto-scan function.
Address: $005E
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AUTO1
AUTO0
0
ASCAN
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-10. ADC Scan Control Register (ADASCR)
AUTO[1:0] — Auto-scan Mode Channel Select Bits
AUTO1 and AUTO0 form a 2-bit field which is used to define the
number of auto-scan channels used when in auto-scan mode.
Reset clears these bits.
Table 15-4. Auto-scan Mode Channel Select
AUTO1
AUTO0
ADC Clock Rate
ATD0 only
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
ATD0 to ATD1
ATD0 to ATD2
ATD0 to ATD3
Technical Data
248
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
ASCAN — Auto-scan Mode Enable Bit
This bit enable/disable the Auto-scan mode. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Auto-scan mode is enabled
0 = Auto-scan mode is disabled
Auto-scan mode should not be enabled when ADC continuous
conversion is enabled; i.e. when ADCO=1.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Technical Data
249
Ana log -to-Dig ita l Conve rte r (ADC)
Technical Data
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
250
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 16. Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.1 Conte nts
16.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
16.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
16.4 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
16.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
16.5.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
16.5.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
16.5.2.1
16.5.2.2
16.5.2.3
16.5.2.4
16.5.2.5
16.5.2.6
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Character Transmission. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Inversion of Transmitted Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
16.5.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
16.5.3.1
16.5.3.2
16.5.3.3
16.5.3.4
16.5.3.5
16.5.3.6
16.5.3.7
16.5.3.8
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Baud Rate Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Error Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
16.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
16.7 SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.8 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.8.1 TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
251
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.8.2 RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.9.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
16.9.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
16.9.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
16.9.5 SCI Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
16.9.6 SCI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
16.9.7 SCI Baud Rate Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
16.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the serial communications interface (SCI)
module, which allows high-speed asynchronous communications with
peripheral devices and other MCUs.
NOTE: When the SCI is enabled, the TxD pin is an open-drain output and
requires a pullup resistor to be connected for proper SCI operation.
NOTE: References to DMA (direct-memory access) and associated functions
are only valid if the MCU has a DMA module. This MCU does not have
the DMA function. Any DMA-related register bits should be left in their
reset state for normal MCU operation.
16.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the SCI module include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Full-duplex operation
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
32 programmable baud rates
Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length
Separately enabled transmitter and receiver
Separate receiver and transmitter CPU interrupt requests
Programmable transmitter output polarity
Technical Data
252
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Features
•
•
Two receiver wakeup methods:
– Idle line wakeup
– Address mark wakeup
Interrupt-driven operation with eight interrupt flags:
– Transmitter empty
– Transmission complete
– Receiver full
– Idle receiver input
– Receiver overrun
– Noise error
– Framing error
– Parity error
•
•
•
•
Receiver framing error detection
Hardware parity checking
1/16 bit-time noise detection
Configuration register bit, SCIBDSRC, to allow selection of baud
rate clock source
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
253
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.4 Pin Na m e Conve ntions
The generic names of the SCI I/O pins are:
•
RxD (receive data)
TxD (transmit data)
•
SCI I/O (input/output) lines are implemented by sharing parallel I/O port
pins. The full name of an SCI input or output reflects the name of the
shared port pin. Table 16-1 shows the full names and the generic names
of the SCI I/O pins. The generic pin names appear in the text of this
section.
Table 16-1. Pin Name Conventions
Generic Pin Names:
Full Pin Names:
RxD
TxD
PTB3/SCL1/RxD
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
NOTE: When the SCI is enabled, the TxD pin is an open-drain output and
requires a pullup resistor to be connected for proper SCI operation.
16.5 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Figure 16-1 shows the structure of the SCI module. The SCI allows full-
duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication among the MCU and
remote devices, including other MCUs. The transmitter and receiver of
the SCI operate independently, although they use the same baud rate
generator. During normal operation, the CPU monitors the status of the
SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data.
The baud rate clock source for the SCI can be selected via the
configuration bit, SCIBDSRC, of the CONFIG2 register ($001D). Source
selection values are shown in Figure 16-1.
Technical Data
254
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
INTERNAL BUS
SCI DATA
REGISTER
SCI DATA
REGISTER
RECEIVE
SHIFT REGISTER
TRANSMIT
TxD
RxD
SHIFT REGISTER
TXINV
SCTIE
TCIE
SCRIE
ILIE
R8
T8
DMARE
DMATE
TE
SCTE
TC
RE
RWU
SBK
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
LOOPS
LOOPS
ENSCI
RECEIVE
CONTROL
FLAG
CONTROL
TRANSMIT
CONTROL
WAKEUP
CONTROL
SCIBDSRC
FROM
M
BKF
RPF
ENSCI
CONFIG
WAKE
ILTY
PEN
PTY
SL
A
PRE-
SCALER
BAUD
DIVIDER
CGMXCLK
IT12
÷ 4
X
B
SL = 0 => X = A
SL = 1 => X = B
DATA SELECTION
CONTROL
÷ 16
CGMXCLK is from CGM module
IT12 = f
BUS
Figure 16-1. SCI Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
255
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
LOOPS
0
6
ENSCI
0
5
TXINV
0
4
M
0
3
WAKE
0
2
ILTY
0
1
PEN
0
Bit 0
PTY
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
SCI Control Register 1
(SCC1)
$0013
SCTIE
TCIE
0
SCRIE
0
ILIE
0
TE
RE
0
RWU
0
SBK
0
SCI Control Register 2
(SCC2)
$0014
$0015
$0016
$0017
$0018
$0019
0
0
R8
T8
DMARE DMATE
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
SCI Control Register 3
(SCC3)
U
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: SCTE
Write:
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
SCI Status Register 1
(SCS1)
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
BKF
RPF
SCI Status Register 2
(SCS2)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R7
T7
R6
T6
R5
T5
R4
T4
R3
T3
R2
T2
R1
T1
R0
T0
SCI Data Register
(SCDR)
Unaffected by reset
0
0
0
0
SCP1
0
SCP0
R
0
SCR2
0
SCR1
0
SCR0
0
SCI Baud Rate Register
(SCBR)
0
= Unimplemented
R = Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 16-2. SCI I/O Register Summary
Technical Data
256
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
16.5.1 Da ta Form a t
The SCI uses the standard non-return-to-zero mark/space data format
illustrated in Figure 16-3.
8-BIT DATA FORMAT
BIT M IN SCC1 CLEAR
PARITY
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
START
BIT
STOP
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
9-BIT DATA FORMAT
BIT M IN SCC1 SET
PARITY
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
START
BIT
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
BIT 8
STOP
BIT
Figure 16-3. SCI Data Formats
16.5.2 Tra nsm itte r
Figure 16-4 shows the structure of the SCI transmitter.
The baud rate clock source for the SCI can be selected via the
configuration bit, SCIBDSRC. Source selection values are shown in
Figure 16-4.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
257
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
SCIBDSRC
FROM
CONFIG2
SL
X
CGMXCLK
IT12
A
B
SL = 0 => X = A
SL = 1 => X = B
INTERNAL BUS
PRE-
SCALER DIVIDER
BAUD
÷ 4
÷ 16
SCI DATA REGISTER
SCP1
SCP0
SCR1
SCR2
SCR0
11-BIT
TRANSMIT
SHIFT REGISTER
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
TxD
TXINV
M
PEN
PTY
PARITY
GENERATION
T8
DMATE
TRANSMITTER
CONTROL LOGIC
DMATE
SCTIE
SCTE
SCTE
SCTIE
SBK
DMATE
SCTE
SCTIE
LOOPS
ENSCI
TE
TC
TC
TCIE
TCIE
Figure 16-4. SCI Transmitter
Technical Data
258
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
16.5.2.1 Cha ra c te r Le ng th
The transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of
the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length.
When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI control register 3 (SCC3) is
the ninth bit (bit 8).
16.5.2.2 Cha ra c te r Tra nsm issio n
During an SCI transmission, the transmit shift register shifts a character
out to the TxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the write-only buffer
between the internal data bus and the transmit shift register. To initiate
an SCI transmission:
1. Enable the SCI by writing a logic 1 to the enable SCI bit (ENSCI)
in SCI control register 1 (SCC1).
2. Enable the transmitter by writing a logic 1 to the transmitter enable
bit (TE) in SCI control register 2 (SCC2).
3. Clear the SCI transmitter empty bit by first reading SCI status
register 1 (SCS1) and then writing to the SCDR.
4. Repeat step 3 for each subsequent transmission.
At the start of a transmission, transmitter control logic automatically
loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of logic 1s. After the
preamble shifts out, control logic transfers the SCDR data into the
transmit shift register. A logic 0 start bit automatically goes into the least
significant bit position of the transmit shift register. A logic 1 stop bit goes
into the most significant bit position.
The SCI transmitter empty bit, SCTE, in SCS1 becomes set when the
SCDR transfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The SCTE bit
indicates that the SCDR can accept new data from the internal data bus.
If the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 is also set, the
SCTE bit generates a transmitter CPU interrupt request.
When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a character, the TxD
pin goes to the idle condition, logic 1. If at any time software clears the
ENSCI bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1), the transmitter and receiver
relinquish control of the port pin.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
259
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.5.2.3 Bre a k Cha ra c te rs
Writing a logic 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCC2 loads the transmit
shift register with a break character. A break character contains all logic
0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Break character length depends
on the M bit in SCC1. As long as SBK is at logic 1, transmitter logic
continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After
software clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the
last break character and then transmits at least one logic 1. The
automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the
recognition of the start bit of the next character.
The SCI recognizes a break character when a start bit is followed by
eight or nine logic 0 data bits and a logic 0 where the stop bit should be.
Receiving a break character has these effects on SCI registers:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Sets the framing error bit (FE) in SCS1
Sets the SCI receiver full bit (SCRF) in SCS1
Clears the SCI data register (SCDR)
Clears the R8 bit in SCC3
Sets the break flag bit (BKF) in SCS2
May set the overrun (OR), noise flag (NF), parity error (PE), or
reception in progress flag (RPF) bits
16.5.2.4 Id le Cha ra c te rs
An idle character contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit.
Idle character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. The preamble is a
synchronizing idle character that begins every transmission.
If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the TxD pin becomes idle
after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then
setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle character to be
sent after the character currently being transmitted.
Technical Data
260
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
NOTE: When queueing an idle character, return the TE bit to logic 1 before the
stop bit of the current character shifts out to the TxD pin. Setting TE after
the stop bit appears on TxD causes data previously written to the SCDR
to be lost.
Toggle the TE bit for a queued idle character when the SCTE bit
becomes set and just before writing the next byte to the SCDR.
16.5.2.5 Inve rsion of Tra nsm itte d Outp ut
The transmit inversion bit (TXINV) in SCI control register 1 (SCC1)
reverses the polarity of transmitted data. All transmitted values, including
idle, break, start, and stop bits, are inverted when TXINV is at logic 1.
(See 16.9.1 SCI Control Register 1.)
16.5.2.6 Tra nsm itte r Inte rrup ts
These conditions can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI
transmitter:
•
SCI transmitter empty (SCTE) — The SCTE bit in SCS1 indicates
that the SCDR has transferred a character to the transmit shift
register. SCTE can generate a transmitter CPU interrupt request.
Setting the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2
enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests.
•
Transmission complete (TC) — The TC bit in SCS1 indicates that
the transmit shift register and the SCDR are empty and that no
break or idle character has been generated. The transmission
complete interrupt enable bit, TCIE, in SCC2 enables the TC bit to
generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
261
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.5.3 Re c e ive r
Figure 16-5 shows the structure of the SCI receiver.
16.5.3.1 Cha ra c te r Le ng th
The receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the
M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length.
When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in SCI control register 2 (SCC2) is the
ninth bit (bit 8). When receiving 8-bit data, bit R8 is a copy of the eighth
bit (bit 7).
16.5.3.2 Cha ra c te r Re c e p tio n
During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts characters in
from the RxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the read-only buffer
between the internal data bus and the receive shift register.
After a complete character shifts into the receive shift register, the data
portion of the character transfers to the SCDR. The SCI receiver full bit,
SCRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCS1) becomes set, indicating that the
received byte can be read. If the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE,
in SCC2 is also set, the SCRF bit generates a receiver CPU interrupt
request.
Technical Data
262
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
INTERNAL BUS
SCIBDSRC
FROM
CONFIG2
SCR1
SCR2
SCR0
SCP1
SCP0
SCI DATA REGISTER
SL
A
B
CGMXCLK
IT12
PRE-
BAUD
X
÷ 4
÷ 16
SCALER DIVIDER
11-BIT
SL = 0 => X = A
SL = 1 => X = B
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER
DATA
RECOVERY
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
RxD
ALL 0s
BKF
RPF
M
RWU
SCRF
IDLE
WAKE
ILTY
WAKEUP
LOGIC
PEN
PTY
R8
PARITY
CHECKING
IDLE
ILIE
ILIE
DMARE
SCRF
SCRIE
DMARE
SCRIE
SCRF
SCRIE
DMARE
DMARE
OR
OR
ORIE
ORIE
NF
NF
NEIE
NEIE
FE
FE
FEIE
FEIE
PE
PE
PEIE
PEIE
Figure 16-5. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
263
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.5.3.3 Da ta Sa m p ling
The receiver samples the RxD pin at the RT clock rate. The RT clock is
an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust for
baud rate mismatch, the RT clock is resynchronized at the following
times (see Figure 16-6):
•
•
After every start bit
After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0
(after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10
returns a valid logic 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and
RT10 samples returns a valid logic 0)
To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search
for a logic 0 preceded by three logic 1s. When the falling edge of a
possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16.
START BIT
LSB
RxD
START BIT
QUALIFICATION
START BIT
DATA
SAMPLES
VERIFICATION SAMPLING
RT
CLOCK
RT CLOCK
STATE
RT CLOCK
RESET
Figure 16-6. Receiver Data Sampling
Technical Data
264
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes
samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7. Table 16-2 summarizes the results of
the start bit verification samples.
Table 16-2. Start Bit Verification
RT3, RT5, and RT7
Samples
Start Bit
Verification
Noise Flag
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
Yes
No
No
No
Start bit verification is not successful if any two of the three verification
samples are logic 1s. If start bit verification is not successful, the RT
clock is reset and a new search for a start bit begins.
To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic
takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 16-3 summarizes the
results of the data bit samples.
Table 16-3. Data Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10
Samples
Data Bit
Determination
Noise Flag
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
265
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
NOTE: The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If
any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are logic 1s
following a successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and
the receiver assumes that the bit is a start bit.
To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at
RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 16-4 summarizes the results of the stop bit
samples.
Table 16-4. Stop Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10
Samples
Framing
Error Flag
Noise Flag
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
16.5.3.4 Fra m ing Erro rs
If the data recovery logic does not detect a logic 1 where the stop bit
should be in an incoming character, it sets the framing error bit, FE, in
SCS1. A break character also sets the FE bit because a break character
has no stop bit. The FE bit is set at the same time that the SCRF bit is
set.
16.5.3.5 Ba ud Ra te Tole ra nc e
A transmitting device may be operating at a baud rate below or above
the receiver baud rate. Accumulated bit time misalignment can cause
one of the three stop bit data samples to fall outside the actual stop bit.
Then a noise error occurs. If more than one of the samples is outside the
stop bit, a framing error occurs. In most applications, the baud rate
Technical Data
266
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
tolerance is much more than the degree of misalignment that is likely to
occur.
As the receiver samples an incoming character, it resynchronizes the RT
clock on any valid falling edge within the character. Resynchronization
within characters corrects misalignments between transmitter bit times
and receiver bit times.
Slow Data Tolerance
Figure 16-7 shows how much a slow received character can be
misaligned without causing a noise error or a framing error. The slow
stop bit begins at RT8 instead of RT1 but arrives in time for the stop bit
data samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
MSB
STOP
RECEIVER
RT CLOCK
DATA
SAMPLES
Figure 16-7. Slow Data
For an 8-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles.
With the misaligned character shown in Figure 16-7, the receiver counts
154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 147 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count of a slow 8-bit character with no errors is
154 – 147
× 100 = 4.54%
-------------------------
154
For a 9-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
267
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
With the misaligned character shown in Figure 16-7, the receiver counts
170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 163 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count of a slow 9-bit character with no errors is
170 – 163
× 100 = 4.12%
-------------------------
170
Fast Data Tolerance
Figure 16-8 shows how much a fast received character can be
misaligned without causing a noise error or a framing error. The fast stop
bit ends at RT10 instead of RT16 but is still there for the stop bit data
samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
STOP
IDLE OR NEXT CHARACTER
RECEIVER
RT CLOCK
DATA
SAMPLES
Figure 16-8. Fast Data
For an 8-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles.
With the misaligned character shown in Figure 16-8, the receiver counts
154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 160 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count of a fast 8-bit character with no errors is
·
154 – 160
-------------------------
154
× 100 = 3.90%
Technical Data
268
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Functional Description
For a 9-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles.
With the misaligned character shown in Figure 16-8, the receiver counts
170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is
11 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 176 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count of a fast 9-bit character with no errors is
170 – 176
× 100 = 3.53%
-------------------------
170
16.5.3.6 Re c e ive r Wa ke up
So that the MCU can ignore transmissions intended only for other
receivers in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a
standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, RWU, in SCC2 puts the
receiver into a standby state during which receiver interrupts are
disabled.
Depending on the state of the WAKE bit in SCC1, either of two
conditions on the RxD pin can bring the receiver out of the standby state:
•
Address mark — An address mark is a logic 1 in the most
significant bit position of a received character. When the WAKE bit
is set, an address mark wakes the receiver from the standby state
by clearing the RWU bit. The address mark also sets the SCI
receiver full bit, SCRF. Software can then compare the character
containing the address mark to the user-defined address of the
receiver. If they are the same, the receiver remains awake and
processes the characters that follow. If they are not the same,
software can set the RWU bit and put the receiver back into the
standby state.
•
Idle input line condition — When the WAKE bit is clear, an idle
character on the RxD pin wakes the receiver from the standby
state by clearing the RWU bit. The idle character that wakes the
receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the SCI receiver
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
269
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
full bit, SCRF. The idle line type bit, ILTY, determines whether the
receiver begins counting logic 1s as idle character bits after the
start bit or after the stop bit.
NOTE: With the WAKE bit clear, setting the RWU bit after the RxD pin has been
idle may cause the receiver to wake up immediately.
16.5.3.7 Re c e ive r Inte rrup ts
The following sources can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI
receiver:
•
SCI receiver full (SCRF) — The SCRF bit in SCS1 indicates that
the receive shift register has transferred a character to the SCDR.
SCRF can generate a receiver CPU interrupt request. Setting the
SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 enables the
SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupts.
•
Idle input (IDLE) — The IDLE bit in SCS1 indicates that 10 or 11
consecutive logic 1s shifted in from the RxD pin. The idle line
interrupt enable bit, ILIE, in SCC2 enables the IDLE bit to generate
CPU interrupt requests.
16.5.3.8 Error Inte rrup ts
The following receiver error flags in SCS1 can generate CPU interrupt
requests:
•
Receiver overrun (OR) — The OR bit indicates that the receive
shift register shifted in a new character before the previous
character was read from the SCDR. The previous character
remains in the SCDR, and the new character is lost. The overrun
interrupt enable bit, ORIE, in SCC3 enables OR to generate SCI
error CPU interrupt requests.
•
Noise flag (NF) — The NF bit is set when the SCI detects noise on
incoming data or break characters, including start, data, and stop
bits. The noise error interrupt enable bit, NEIE, in SCC3 enables
NF to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests.
Technical Data
270
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Low-Power Modes
•
•
Framing error (FE) — The FE bit in SCS1 is set when a logic 0
occurs where the receiver expects a stop bit. The framing error
interrupt enable bit, FEIE, in SCC3 enables FE to generate SCI
error CPU interrupt requests.
Parity error (PE) — The PE bit in SCS1 is set when the SCI
detects a parity error in incoming data. The parity error interrupt
enable bit, PEIE, in SCC3 enables PE to generate SCI error CPU
interrupt requests.
16.6 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
16.6.1 Wa it Mod e
The SCI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT
instruction. In wait mode, the SCI module registers are not accessible by
the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SCI module can
bring the MCU out of wait mode.
If SCI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by disabling the module before executing the WAIT
instruction.
Refer to 9.7 Low-Power Modes for information on exiting wait mode.
16.6.2 Stop Mod e
The SCI module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction.
The STOP instruction does not affect SCI register states. SCI module
operation resumes after an external interrupt.
Because the internal clock is inactive during stop mode, entering stop
mode during an SCI transmission or reception results in invalid data.
Refer to 9.7 Low-Power Modes for information on exiting stop mode.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
271
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.7 SCI During Bre a k Mod ule Inte rrup ts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in
other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in
the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear
status bits during the break state.
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a
logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it
remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE
bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write
I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some
status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does
the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during
the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the
second step clears the status bit.
16.8 I/ O Sig na ls
Port B shares two of its pins with the SCI module.
The two SCI I/O pins are:
•
•
PTB2/SDA1/TxD — Transmit data
PTB3/SCL1/RxD — Receive data
16.8.1 TxD (Tra nsm it Da ta )
When the SCI is enabled (ENSCI=1), the PTB2/SDA1/TxD pin becomes
the serial data output, TxD, from the SCI transmitter regardless of the
state of the DDRB2 bit in data direction register B (DDRB). The TxD pin
is an open-drain output and requires a pullup resistor to be connected for
proper SCI operation.
NOTE: The PTB2/SDA1/TxD pin is an open-drain pin when configured as an
output. Therefore, when configured as a general purpose output pin
(PTB2), a pullup resistor must be connected to this pin.
Technical Data
272
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
16.8.2 RxD (Re c e ive Da ta )
When the SCI is enabled (ENSCI=1), the PTB3/SCL1/RxD pin becomes
the serial data input, RxD, to the SCI receiver regardless of the state of
the DDRB3 bit in data direction register B (DDRB).
NOTE: The PTB3/SCL1/RxD pin is an open-drain pin when configured as an
output. Therefore, when configured as a general purpose output pin
(PTB3), a pullup resistor must be connected to this pin.
16.9 I/ O Re g iste rs
These I/O registers control and monitor SCI operation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
SCI control register 1 (SCC1)
SCI control register 2 (SCC2)
SCI control register 3 (SCC3)
SCI status register 1 (SCS1)
SCI status register 2 (SCS2)
SCI data register (SCDR)
SCI baud rate register (SCBR)
16.9.1 SCI Control Re g iste r 1
SCI control register 1:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Enables loop mode operation
Enables the SCI
Controls output polarity
Controls character length
Controls SCI wakeup method
Controls idle character detection
Enables parity function
Controls parity type
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
273
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
Address: $0013
Bit 7
LOOPS
0
6
ENSCI
0
5
TXINV
0
4
M
0
3
WAKE
0
2
ILTY
0
1
PEN
0
Bit 0
PTY
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 16-9. SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1)
LOOPS — Loop Mode Select Bit
This read/write bit enables loop mode operation. In loop mode the
RxD pin is disconnected from the SCI, and the transmitter output goes
into the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the receiver must be
enabled to use loop mode. Reset clears the LOOPS bit.
1 = Loop mode enabled
0 = Normal operation enabled
ENSCI — Enable SCI Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCI and the SCI baud rate generator.
Clearing ENSCI sets the SCTE and TC bits in SCI status register 1
and disables transmitter interrupts. Reset clears the ENSCI bit.
1 = SCI enabled
0 = SCI disabled
TXINV — Transmit Inversion Bit
This read/write bit reverses the polarity of transmitted data. Reset
clears the TXINV bit.
1 = Transmitter output inverted
0 = Transmitter output not inverted
NOTE: Setting the TXINV bit inverts all transmitted values, including idle, break,
start, and stop bits.
Technical Data
274
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
M — Mode (Character Length) Bit
This read/write bit determines whether SCI characters are eight or
nine bits long. (See Table 16-5.) The ninth bit can serve as an extra
stop bit, as a receiver wakeup signal, or as a parity bit. Reset clears
the M bit.
1 = 9-bit SCI characters
0 = 8-bit SCI characters
WAKE — Wakeup Condition Bit
This read/write bit determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a
logic 1 (address mark) in the most significant bit position of a received
character or an idle condition on the RxD pin. Reset clears the WAKE
bit.
1 = Address mark wakeup
0 = Idle line wakeup
ILTY — Idle Line Type Bit
This read/write bit determines when the SCI starts counting logic 1s
as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit or
after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of
logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle
character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle
character recognition, but requires properly synchronized
transmissions. Reset clears the ILTY bit.
1 = Idle character bit count begins after stop bit
0 = Idle character bit count begins after start bit
PEN — Parity Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCI parity function. (See Table 16-5.)
When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the most
significant bit position. (See Figure 16-3.) Reset clears the PEN bit.
1 = Parity function enabled
0 = Parity function disabled
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
275
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
PTY — Parity Bit
This read/write bit determines whether the SCI generates and checks
for odd parity or even parity. (See Table 16-5.) Reset clears the PTY
bit.
1 = Odd parity
0 = Even parity
NOTE: Changing the PTY bit in the middle of a transmission or reception can
generate a parity error.
Table 16-5. Character Format Selection
Control Bits
PEN and
Character Format
Start
Bits
Data
Bits
Stop
Parity
Character
Length
M
PTY
0X
0X
10
Bits
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
8
9
7
7
8
8
None
None
Even
Odd
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 bits
11 bits
10 bits
10 bits
11 bits
11 bits
11
10
Even
Odd
11
16.9.2 SCI Control Re g iste r 2
SCI control register 2:
Enables the following CPU interrupt requests:
•
– Enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the IDLE bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt
requests
Technical Data
276
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
•
•
•
•
Enables the transmitter
Enables the receiver
Enables SCI wakeup
Transmits SCI break characters
Address: $0014
Bit 7
6
TCIE
0
5
SCRIE
0
4
ILIE
0
3
TE
0
2
RE
0
1
RWU
0
Bit 0
SBK
0
Read:
SCTIE
Write:
Reset:
0
Figure 16-10. SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2)
SCTIE — SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCTE bit to generate SCI transmitter
CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCTIE bit.
1 = SCTE enabled to generate CPU interrupt
0 = SCTE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt
TCIE — Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the TC bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU
interrupt requests. Reset clears the TCIE bit.
1 = TC enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
0 = TC not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
SCRIE — SCI Receive Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCRF bit to generate SCI receiver
CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCRIE bit.
1 = SCRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt
0 = SCRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt
ILIE — Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the IDLE bit to generate SCI receiver CPU
interrupt requests. Reset clears the ILIE bit.
1 = IDLE enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
0 = IDLE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
277
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
TE — Transmitter Enable Bit
Setting this read/write bit begins the transmission by sending a
preamble of 10 or 11 logic 1s from the transmit shift register to the
TxD pin. If software clears the TE bit, the transmitter completes any
transmission in progress before the TxD returns to the idle condition
(logic 1). Clearing and then setting TE during a transmission queues
an idle character to be sent after the character currently being
transmitted. Reset clears the TE bit.
1 = Transmitter enabled
0 = Transmitter disabled
NOTE: Writing to the TE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is
clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1.
RE — Receiver Enable Bit
Setting this read/write bit enables the receiver. Clearing the RE bit
disables the receiver but does not affect receiver interrupt flag bits.
Reset clears the RE bit.
1 = Receiver enabled
0 = Receiver disabled
NOTE: Writing to the RE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is
clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1.
RWU — Receiver Wakeup Bit
This read/write bit puts the receiver in a standby state during which
receiver interrupts are disabled. The WAKE bit in SCC1 determines
whether an idle input or an address mark brings the receiver out of the
standby state and clears the RWU bit. Reset clears the RWU bit.
1 = Standby state
0 = Normal operation
Technical Data
278
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
SBK — Send Break Bit
Setting and then clearing this read/write bit transmits a break
character followed by a logic 1. The logic 1 after the break character
guarantees recognition of a valid start bit. If SBK remains set, the
transmitter continuously transmits break characters with no logic 1s
between them. Reset clears the SBK bit.
1 = Transmit break characters
0 = No break characters being transmitted
NOTE: Do not toggle the SBK bit immediately after setting the SCTE bit.
Toggling SBK before the preamble begins causes the SCI to send a
break character instead of a preamble.
16.9.3 SCI Control Re g iste r 3
SCI control register 3:
•
•
Stores the ninth SCI data bit received and the ninth SCI data bit to
be transmitted
Enables these interrupts:
– Receiver overrun interrupts
– Noise error interrupts
– Framing error interrupts
Parity error interrupts
•
Address: $0015
Bit 7
6
T8
U
5
4
3
ORIE
0
2
NEIE
0
1
FEIE
0
Bit 0
PEIE
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R8
DMARE DMATE
U
0
0
= Unimplemented
U = Unaffected
Figure 16-11. SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
279
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
R8 — Received Bit 8
When the SCI is receiving 9-bit characters, R8 is the read-only ninth
bit (bit 8) of the received character. R8 is received at the same time
that the SCDR receives the other 8 bits.
When the SCI is receiving 8-bit characters, R8 is a copy of the eighth
bit (bit 7). Reset has no effect on the R8 bit.
T8 — Transmitted Bit 8
When the SCI is transmitting 9-bit characters, T8 is the read/write
ninth bit (bit 8) of the transmitted character. T8 is loaded into the
transmit shift register at the same time that the SCDR is loaded into
the transmit shift register. Reset has no effect on the T8 bit.
DMARE — DMA Receive Enable Bit
CAUTION: The DMA module is not included on this MCU. Writing a logic 1 to
DMARE or DMATE may adversely affect MCU performance.
1 = DMA not enabled to service SCI receiver DMA service requests
generated by the SCRF bit (SCI receiver CPU interrupt
requests enabled)
0 = DMA not enabled to service SCI receiver DMA service requests
generated by the SCRF bit (SCI receiver CPU interrupt
requests enabled)
DMATE — DMA Transfer Enable Bit
CAUTION: The DMA module is not included on this MCU. Writing a logic 1 to
DMARE or DMATE may adversely affect MCU performance.
1 = SCTE DMA service requests enabled; SCTE CPU interrupt
requests disabled
0 = SCTE DMA service requests disabled; SCTE CPU interrupt
requests enabled
Technical Data
280
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
ORIE — Receiver Overrun Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the receiver overrun bit, OR.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit disabled
NEIE — Receiver Noise Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the noise error bit, NE. Reset clears NEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit disabled
FEIE — Receiver Framing Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the framing error bit, FE. Reset clears FEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit disabled
PEIE — Receiver Parity Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI receiver CPU interrupt
requests generated by the parity error bit, PE. (See 16.9.4 SCI Status
Register 1.) Reset clears PEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit disabled
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
281
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.9.4 SCI Sta tus Re g iste r 1
SCI status register 1 (SCS1) contains flags to signal these conditions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Transfer of SCDR data to transmit shift register complete
Transmission complete
Transfer of receive shift register data to SCDR complete
Receiver input idle
Receiver overrun
Noisy data
Framing error
Parity error
Address: $0016
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PE
Read: SCTE
Write:
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
Reset:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 16-12. SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1)
SCTE — SCI Transmitter Empty Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCDR transfers a
character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate an SCI
transmitter CPU interrupt request. When the SCTIE bit in SCC2 is set,
SCTE generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. In normal
operation, clear the SCTE bit by reading SCS1 with SCTE set and
then writing to SCDR. Reset sets the SCTE bit.
1 = SCDR data transferred to transmit shift register
0 = SCDR data not transferred to transmit shift register
Technical Data
282
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
TC — Transmission Complete Bit
This read-only bit is set when the SCTE bit is set, and no data,
preamble, or break character is being transmitted. TC generates an
SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request if the TCIE bit in SCC2 is also
set. TC is automatically cleared when data, preamble or break is
queued and ready to be sent. There may be up to 1.5 transmitter
clocks of latency between queueing data, preamble, and break and
the transmission actually starting. Reset sets the TC bit.
1 = No transmission in progress
0 = Transmission in progress
SCRF — SCI Receiver Full Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the data in the receive shift
register transfers to the SCI data register. SCRF can generate an SCI
receiver CPU interrupt request. When the SCRIE bit in SCC2 is set,
SCRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear
the SCRF bit by reading SCS1 with SCRF set and then reading the
SCDR. Reset clears SCRF.
1 = Received data available in SCDR
0 = Data not available in SCDR
IDLE — Receiver Idle Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when 10 or 11 consecutive logic 1s
appear on the receiver input. IDLE generates an SCI error CPU
interrupt request if the ILIE bit in SCC2 is also set. Clear the IDLE bit
by reading SCS1 with IDLE set and then reading the SCDR. After the
receiver is enabled, it must receive a valid character that sets the
SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Also, after the
IDLE bit has been cleared, a valid character must again set the SCRF
bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Reset clears the IDLE
bit.
1 = Receiver input idle
0 = Receiver input active (or idle since the IDLE bit was cleared)
OR — Receiver Overrun Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when software fails to read the
SCDR before the receive shift register receives the next character.
The OR bit generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ORIE
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
283
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
bit in SCC3 is also set. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data
already in the SCDR is not affected. Clear the OR bit by reading SCS1
with OR set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the OR bit.
1 = Receive shift register full and SCRF = 1
0 = No receiver overrun
Software latency may allow an overrun to occur between reads of
SCS1 and SCDR in the flag-clearing sequence. Figure 16-13 shows
the normal flag-clearing sequence and an example of an overrun
caused by a delayed flag-clearing sequence. The delayed read of
SCDR does not clear the OR bit because OR was not set when SCS1
was read. Byte 2 caused the overrun and is lost. The next flag-
clearing sequence reads byte 3 in the SCDR instead of byte 2.
In applications that are subject to software latency or in which it is
important to know which byte is lost due to an overrun, the flag-
clearing routine can check the OR bit in a second read of SCS1 after
reading the data register.
NF — Receiver Noise Flag Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects noise on the
RxD pin. NF generates an NF CPU interrupt request if the NEIE bit in
SCC3 is also set. Clear the NF bit by reading SCS1 and then reading
the SCDR. Reset clears the NF bit.
1 = Noise detected
0 = No noise detected
FE — Receiver Framing Error Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the
stop bit. FE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the FEIE
bit in SCC3 also is set. Clear the FE bit by reading SCS1 with FE set
and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the FE bit.
1 = Framing error detected
0 = No framing error detected
Technical Data
284
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
NORMAL FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
BYTE 4
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCDR
BYTE 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 2
READ SCDR
BYTE 3
DELAYED FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
BYTE 4
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 3
Figure 16-13. Flag Clearing Sequence
PE — Receiver Parity Error Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a parity error
in incoming data. PE generates a PE CPU interrupt request if the
PEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the PE bit by reading SCS1 with
PE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the PE bit.
1 = Parity error detected
0 = No parity error detected
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
285
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.9.5 SCI Sta tus Re g iste r 2
SCI status register 2 contains flags to signal the following conditions:
•
•
Break character detected
Incoming data
Address: $0017
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
Bit 0
RPF
Read:
BKF
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 16-14. SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2)
BKF — Break Flag Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a break
character on the RxD pin. In SCS1, the FE and SCRF bits are also
set. In 9-bit character transmissions, the R8 bit in SCC3 is cleared.
BKF does not generate a CPU interrupt request. Clear BKF by
reading SCS2 with BKF set and then reading the SCDR. Once
cleared, BKF can become set again only after logic 1s again appear
on the RxD pin followed by another break character. Reset clears the
BKF bit.
1 = Break character detected
0 = No break character detected
RPF — Reception in Progress Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the
RT1 time period of the start bit search. RPF does not generate an
interrupt request. RPF is reset after the receiver detects false start bits
(usually from noise or a baud rate mismatch) or when the receiver
detects an idle character. Polling RPF before disabling the SCI
module or entering stop mode can show whether a reception is in
progress.
1 = Reception in progress
0 = No reception in progress
Technical Data
286
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
16.9.6 SCI Da ta Re g iste r
The SCI data register (SCDR) is the buffer between the internal data bus
and the receive and transmit shift registers. Reset has no effect on data
in the SCI data register.
Address: $0018
Bit 7
R7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R6
T6
R5
T5
R4
T4
R3
T3
R2
T2
R1
T1
T7
T0
Unaffected by reset
Figure 16-15. SCI Data Register (SCDR)
R7/T7–R0/T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits
Reading the SCI data register (SCDR) accesses the read-only
received data bits, R7:R0. Writing to the SCDR writes the data to be
transmitted, T7:T0. Reset has no effect on the SCDR.
NOTE: Do not use read/modify/write instructions on the SCI data register.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
287
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
16.9.7 SCI Ba ud Ra te Re g iste r
The baud rate register (SCBR) selects the baud rate for both the receiver
and the transmitter.
Address: $0019
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
SCP1
0
4
SCP0
0
3
2
1
SCR1
0
Bit 0
SCR0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
R
SCR2
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 16-16. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR)
SCP1 and SCP0 — SCI Baud Rate Prescaler Bits
These read/write bits select the baud rate prescaler divisor as shown
in Table 16-6. Reset clears SCP1 and SCP0.
Table 16-6. SCI Baud Rate Prescaling
SCP1 and SCP0
Prescaler Divisor (PD)
00
01
10
11
1
3
4
13
SCR2–SCR0 — SCI Baud Rate Select Bits
These read/write bits select the SCI baud rate divisor as shown in
Table 16-7. Reset clears SCR2–SCR0.
Technical Data
288
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
I/O Registers
Table 16-7. SCI Baud Rate Selection
SCR2, SCR1, and SCR0
Baud Rate Divisor (BD)
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
1
2
4
8
16
32
64
128
Use this formula to calculate the SCI baud rate:
SCI clock source
baud rate = --------------------------------------------
64 × PD × BD
where:
SCI clock source = fBUS or CGMXCLK
(selected by SCIBDSRC bit in CONFIG2 register)
PD = prescaler divisor
BD = baud rate divisor
Table 16-8 shows the SCI baud rates that can be generated with a
4.9152-MHz bus clock when fBUS is selected as SCI clock source.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
Technical Data
289
Se ria l Com m unic a tions Inte rfa c e (SCI)
Table 16-8. SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples
Baud Rate
(fBUS = 4.9152 MHz)
SCP1 and
SCP0
Prescaler
Divisor (PD)
SCR2, SCR1,
and SCR0
Baud Rate
Divisor (BD)
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
01
01
01
01
01
01
01
01
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
1
1
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
1
2
76,800
38,400
19,200
9600
4800
2400
1200
600
1
4
1
8
1
16
32
64
128
1
1
1
1
3
25,600
12,800
6400
3200
1600
800
3
2
3
4
3
8
3
16
32
64
128
1
3
3
400
3
200
4
19,200
9600
4800
2400
1200
600
4
2
4
4
4
8
4
16
32
64
128
1
4
4
300
4
150
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
5908
2954
1477
739
2
4
8
16
32
64
128
369
185
92
46
Technical Data
290
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 17. Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.1 Conte nts
17.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
17.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
17.4 I/O Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
17.5 Multi-Master IIC System Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
17.6 Multi-Master IIC Bus Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
17.6.1 START Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.2 Slave Address Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.3 Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
17.6.4 Repeated START Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.5 STOP Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.6 Arbitration Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
17.6.7 Clock Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
17.6.8 Handshaking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
17.6.9 Packet Error Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17.7 MMIIC I/O Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17.7.1 MMIIC Address Register (MMADR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
17.7.2 MMIIC Control Register 1 (MMCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
17.7.3 MMIIC Control Register 2 (MMCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
17.7.4 MMIIC Status Register (MMSR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
17.7.5 MMIIC Data Transmit Register (MMDTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
17.7.6 MMIIC Data Receive Register (MMDRR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
17.7.7 MMIIC CRC Data Register (MMCRCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
17.7.8 MMIIC Frequency Divider Register (MMFDR) . . . . . . . . . .310
17.8 Program Algorithm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
17.8.1 Data Sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
17.9 SMBus Protocols with PEC and without PEC. . . . . . . . . . . . .313
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
291
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.9.1 Quick Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.2 Send Byte. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.3 Receive Byte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
17.9.4 Write Byte/Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17.9.5 Read Byte/Word. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
17.9.6 Process Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17.9.7 Block Read/Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
17.10 SMBus Protocol Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
17.2 Introd uc tion
The multi-master IIC (MMIIC) interface is a two wire, bidirectional serial
bus which provides a simple, efficient way for data exchange between
devices. The interface is designed for internal serial communication
between the MCU and other IIC devices. It has hardware generated
START and STOP signals; and byte by byte interrupt driven software
algorithm.
This bus is suitable for applications which need frequent
communications over a short distance between a number of devices. It
also provides a flexibility that allows additional devices to be connected
to the bus. The maximum data rate is 100k-bps, and the maximum
communication distance and number of devices that can be connected
is limited by a maximum bus capacitance of 400pF.
This MMIIC interface is also SMBus (System Management Bus) version
1.0 and 1.1 compatible, with hardware cyclic redundancy code (CRC)
generation, making it suitable for smart battery applications.
For connection flexibility, two channels are available:
•
•
Channel 0 — SDA0 and SCL0
Channel 1 — SDA1 and SCL1
The two channels are multiplexed; only one channel is active at any one
time.
Technical Data
292
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Features
17.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the MMIC module include:
•
•
•
Full SMBus version 1.0/1.1 compliance
Multi-master IIC bus standard
Software programmable for one of eight different serial clock
frequencies
•
•
•
•
Software controllable acknowledge bit generation
Interrupt driven byte by byte data transfer
Calling address identification interrupt
Arbitration loss detection and no-ACK awareness in master mode
and automatic mode switching from master to slave
•
Auto detection of R/W bit and switching of transmit or receive
mode accordingly
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection of START, repeated START, and STOP signals
Auto generation of START and STOP condition in master mode
Repeated start generation
Master clock generator with eight selectable baud rates
Automatic recognition of the received acknowledge bit
Busy detection
Software enabled 8-bit CRC generation/decoding
17.4 I/ O Pins
The MMIIC module uses four I/O pins, shared with standard port I/O
pins. The full name of the MMIIC I/O pins are listed in Table 17-1. The
generic pin name appear in the text that follows.
The SDA0/SCL0 and SDA1/SCL1 pins are open-drain. When configured
as general purpose output pins (PTB0–PTB3), pullup resistors must be
connected to these pins.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
293
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
Table 17-1. Pin Name Conventions
MMIIC Generic Pin Names:
Full MCU Pin Names:
PTB0/SDA0
Pin Selected for MMIIC Function By:
SDA0
SCL0
SDA1
SCL1
MMEN and SDASCL1 bits in MMCR1 ($0049)
PTB1/SCL0
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
PTB3/SCL1/RxD
ENSCI bit in SCC1 ($0013);
MMEN and SDASCL1 bits in MMCR1 ($0049)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MMEXTAD
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
MMAD7 MMAD6 MMAD5 MMAD4 MMAD3 MMAD2 MMAD1
MMIIC Address Register
(MMADR)
$0048
1
MMEN
0
0
MMIEN
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
MMCLRBB
0
MMCRCBYTE
MMTXAK REPSEN
SDASCL1
0
MMIIC Control Register 1
(MMCR1)
$0049
$004A
$004B
$004C
$004D
$004E
$004F
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMALIF MMNAKIF MMBB
MMCRCEF
MMAST MMRW
MMIIC Control Register 2
(MMCR2)
Write:
0
0
0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Unaffected
Read: MMRXIF MMTXIF MMATCH MMSRW MMRXAK MMCRCBF MMTXBE MMRXBF
MMIIC Status Register
(MMSR)
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
MMIIC Data Transmit
MMTD7 MMTD6 MMTD5 MMTD4 MMTD3 MMTD2 MMTD1 MMTD0
Register Write:
(MMDTR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMRD7 MMRD6 MMRD5 MMRD4 MMRD3 MMRD2 MMRD1 MMRD0
MMIIC Data Receive
Register Write:
(MDDRR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: MMCRCD7 MMCRCD6 MMCRCD5 MMCRCD4 MMCRCD3 MMCRCD2 MMCRCD1 MMCRCD0
Write:
MMIIC CRC Data Register
(MMCRDR)
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MMIIC Frequency Divider
MMBR2 MMBR1 MMBR0
Register Write:
(MMFDR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-1. MMIIC I/O Register Summary
Technical Data
294
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC) MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Multi-Master IIC System Configuration
17.5 Multi-Ma ste r IIC Syste m Config ura tion
The multi-master IIC system uses a serial data line SDA and a serial
clock line SCL for data transfer. All devices connected to it must have
open collector (drain) outputs and the logical-AND function is performed
on both lines by two pull-up resistors.
17.6 Multi-Ma ste r IIC Bus Protoc ol
Normally a standard communication is composed of four parts:
1. START signal,
2. slave address transmission,
3. data transfer, and
4. STOP signal.
These are described briefly in the following sections and illustrated in
Figure 17-2.
9th clock pulse
LSB
9th clock pulse
LSB
MSB
1
MSB
1
SCL
SDA
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
ACK
Data must be stable
when SCL is HIGH
No ACK
START
signal
STOP
signal
MSB
1
LSB
1
MSB
1
LSB
1
SCL
SDA
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
ACK
No ACK
Repeated
START
signal
START
signal
STOP
signal
Figure 17-2. Multi-Master IIC Bus Transmission Signal Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
295
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.6.1 START Sig na l
When the bus is free, (i.e. no master device is engaging the bus — both
SCL and SDA lines are at logic high) a master may initiate
communication by sending a START signal. As shown in Figure 17-2, a
START signal is defined as a high to low transition of SDA while SCL is
high. This signal denotes the beginning of a new data transfer (each data
transfer may contain several bytes of data) and wakes up all slaves.
17.6.2 Sla ve Ad d re ss Tra nsm ission
The first byte transferred immediately after the START signal is the slave
address transmitted by the master. This is a 7-bit calling address
followed by a R/W-bit. The R/W-bit dictates to the slave the desired
direction of the data transfer. A logic 0 indicates that the master wishes
to transmit data to the slave; a logic 1 indicates that the master wishes
to receive data from the slave.
Only the slave with a matched address will respond by sending back an
acknowledge bit by pulling SDA low on the 9th clock cycle.
(See Figure 17-2.)
17.6.3 Da ta Tra nsfe r
Once a successful slave addressing is achieved, the data transfer can
proceed byte by byte in the direction specified by the R/W-bit sent by the
calling master.
Each data byte is 8 bits. Data can be changed only when SCL is low and
must be held stable when SCL is high as shown in Figure 17-2. The
MSB is transmitted first and each byte has to be followed by an
acknowledge bit. This is signalled by the receiving device by pulling the
SDA low on the 9th clock cycle. Therefore, one complete data byte
transfer requires 9 clock cycles.
If the slave receiver does not acknowledge the master, the SDA line
should be left high by the slave. The master can then generate a STOP
signal to abort the data transfer or a START signal (repeated START) to
commence a new transfer.
Technical Data
296
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Multi-Master IIC Bus Protocol
If the master receiver does not acknowledge the slave transmitter after
a byte has been transmitted, it means an “end of data” to the slave. The
slave should release the SDA line for the master to generate a STOP or
START signal.
17.6.4 Re p e a te d START Sig na l
As shown in Figure 17-2, a repeated START signal is used to generate
START signal without first generating a STOP to terminate the
communication. This is used by the master to communicate with another
slave or with the same slave in a different mode (transmit/receive mode)
without releasing the bus.
17.6.5 STOP Sig na l
The master can terminate the communication by generating a STOP
signal to free the bus. However, the master may generate a START
signal followed by a calling command without first generating a STOP
signal. This is called repeat START. A STOP signal is defined as a low
to high transition of SDA while SCL is at logic high (see Figure 17-2).
17.6.6 Arb itra tion Proc e d ure
The interface circuit is a multi-master system which allows more than
one master to be connected. If two or more masters try to control the bus
at the same time, a clock synchronization procedure determines the bus
clock. The clock low period is equal to the longest clock low period and
the clock high period is equal to the shortest one among the masters. A
data arbitration procedure determines the priority. A master will lose
arbitration if it transmits a logic 1 while another transmits a logic 0. The
losing master will immediately switch over to slave receive mode and
stops its data and clock outputs. The transition from master to slave will
not generate a STOP condition. Meanwhile a software bit will be set by
hardware to indicates loss of arbitration.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
297
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.6.7 Cloc k Sync hroniza tion
Since wired-AND logic is performed on SCL line, a high to low transition
on the SCL line will affect the devices connected to the bus. The devices
start counting their low period once a device’s clock has gone low, it will
hold the SCL line low until the clock high state is reached. However, the
change of low to high in this device clock may not change the state of the
SCL line if another device clock is still in its low period. Therefore the
synchronized clock SCL will be held low by the device which last
releases SCL to logic high. Devices with shorter low periods enter a high
wait state during this time. When all devices concerned have counted off
their low period, the synchronized SCL line will be released and go high,
and all devices will start counting their high periods. The first device to
complete its high period will again pull the SCL line low. Figure 17-3
illustrates the clock synchronization waveforms.
Start counting high period
WAIT
SCL1
SCL2
SCL
Internal counter reset
Figure 17-3. Clock Synchronization
17.6.8 Ha nd sha king
The clock synchronization mechanism can be used as a handshake in
data transfer. A slave device may hold the SCL low after completion of
one byte data transfer and will halt the bus clock, forcing the master
clock into a wait state until the slave releases the SCL line.
Technical Data
298
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
17.6.9 Pa c ke t Error Cod e
The packet error code (PEC) for the MMIIC interface is in the form a
cyclic redundancy code (CRC). The PEC is generated by hardware for
every transmitted and received byte of data. The transmission of the
generated PEC is controlled by user software.
The CRC data register, MMCRCDR, contains the generated PEC byte,
with three other bits in the MMIIC control registers and status register
monitoring and controlling the PEC byte.
17.7 MMIIC I/ O Re g iste rs
These I/O registers control and monitor MMIIC operation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
MMIIC address register (MMADR) — $0048
MMIIC control register 1 (MMCR1) — $0049
MMIIC control register 2 (MMCR2) — $004A
MMIIC status register (MMSR) — $004B
MMIIC data transmit register (MMDTR) — $004C
MMIIC data receive register (MMDRR) — $004D
MMIIC CRC data register (MMCRCDR) — $004E
MMIIC frequency divide register (MMFDR) — $004F
17.7.1 MMIIC Ad d re ss Re g iste r (MMADR)
Address: $0048
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
MMAD7 MMAD6 MMAD5 MMAD4 MMAD3 MMAD2 MMAD1 MMEXTAD
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 17-4. MMIIC Address Register (MMADR)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
299
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
MMAD[7:1] — Multi-Master Address
These seven bits represent the MMIIC interface’s own specific slave
address when in slave mode, and the calling address when in master
mode. Software must update MMAD[7:1] as the calling address while
entering master mode and restore its own slave address after master
mode is relinquished. This register is cleared as $A0 upon reset.
MMEXTAD — Multi-Master Expanded Address
This bit is set to expand the address of the MMIIC in slave mode.
When set, the MMIIC will acknowledge the following addresses from
a calling master: $MMAD[7:1], 0000000, and 0001100.
Reset clears this bit.
1 = MMIIC responds to the following calling addresses:
$MMAD[7:1], 0000000, and 0001100.
0 = MMIIC responds to address $MMAD[7:1]
For example, when MMADR is configured as:
MMAD7 MMAD6 MMAD5 MMAD4 MMAD3 MMAD2 MMAD1 MMEXTAD
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
The MMIIC module will respond to the calling address:
Bit 7
1
6
1
5
0
4
1
3
0
2
1
Bit 1
0
or the general calling address:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
or the calling address:
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
1
3
1
2
0
Bit 1
0
Note that bit-0 of the 8-bit calling address is the MMRW bit from the
calling master.
Technical Data
300
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
17.7.2 MMIIC Control Re g iste r 1 (MMCR1)
Address: $0049
Bit 7
MMEN
0
6
MMIEN
0
5
4
0
3
2
1
MMCRCBYTE
0
Bit 0
SDASCL1
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
MMCLRBB
0
MMTXAK REPSEN
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-5. MMIIC Control Register 1 (MMCR1)
MMEN — MMIIC Enable
This bit is set to enable the Multi-master IIC module. When
MMEN = 0, module is disabled and all flags will restore to its power-
on default states. Reset clears this bit.
1 = MMIIC module enabled
0 = MMIIC module disabled
MMIEN — MMIIC Interrupt Enable
When this bit is set, the MMTXIF, MMRXIF, MMALIF, and MMNAKIF
flags are enabled to generate an interrupt request to the CPU. When
MMIEN is cleared, the these flags are prevented from generating an
interrupt request. Reset clears this bit.
1 = MMTXIF, MMRXIF, MMALIF, and/or MMNAKIF bit set will
generate interrupt request to CPU
0 = MMTXIF, MMRXIF, MMALIF, and/or MMNAKIF bit set will not
generate interrupt request to CPU
MMCLRBB — MMIIC Clear Busy Flag
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the MMBB flag.
MMCLRBB always reads as a logic 0. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Clear MMBB flag
0 = No affect on MMBB flag
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
301
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
MMTXAK — MMIIC Transmit Acknowledge Enable
This bit is set to disable the MMIIC from sending out an acknowledge
signal to the bus at the 9th clock bit after receiving 8 data bits. When
MMTXAK is cleared, an acknowledge signal will be sent at the 9th
clock bit. Reset clears this bit.
1 = MMIIC does not send acknowledge signals at 9th clock bit
0 = MMIIC sends acknowledge signal at 9th clock bit
REPSEN — Repeated Start Enable
This bit is set to enable repeated START signal to be generated when
in master mode transfer (MMAST = 1). The REPSEN bit is cleared by
hardware after the completion of repeated START signal or when the
MMAST bit is cleared. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Repeated START signal will be generated if MMAST bit is set
0 = No repeated START signal will be generated
MMCRCBYTE — MMIIC CRC Byte
In receive mode, this bit is set by software to indicate that the next
receiving byte will be the packet error checking (PEC) data.
In master receive mode, after completion of CRC generation on the
received PEC data, an acknowledge signal is sent if MMTXAK = 0; no
acknowledge is sent If MMTXAK = 1.
In slave receive mode, no acknowledge signal is sent if a CRC error
is detected on the received PEC data. If no CRC error is detected, an
acknowledge signal is sent if MMTXAK = 0; no acknowledge is sent If
MMTXAK = 1.
Under normal operation, the user software should clear MMTXAK bit
before setting MMCRCBYTE bit to ensure that an acknowledge signal
is sent when no CRC error is detected.
The MMCRCBYTE bit should not be set in transmit mode. This bit is
cleared by the next START signal. Reset also clears this bit.
1 = Next receiving byte is the packet error checking (PEC) data
0 = Next receiving byte is not PEC data
Technical Data
302
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
SDASCL1 — SDA and SCL I/O Pin Select
This bit selects either SDA0 and SCL0, or SDA1 and SCL1, for MMIIC
I/O pins when MMIIC module is enabled (MMEN = 1). If the SCI
module is enabled (ENSCI = 0), the SDA1 and SCL1 pins are not
available for MMIIC.
Reset clears SDASCL1 bit.
1 = MMIIC module uses SDA1 and SCL1 I/O pins
0 = MMIIC module uses SDA0 and SCL0 I/O pins
17.7.3 MMIIC Control Re g iste r 2 (MMCR2)
Address: $004A
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
Read: MMALIF MMNAKIF MMBB
MMCRCEF
Unaffected
MMAST MMRW
Write:
0
0
0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-6. MMIIC Control Register 2 (MMCR2)
MMALIF — Arbitration Loss Interrupt Flag
This flag is set when software attempt to set MMAST but the MMBB
has been set by detecting the start condition on the lines or when the
MMIIC is transmitting a "1" to SDA line but detected a "0" from SDA
line in master mode — an arbitration loss. This bit generates an
interrupt request to the CPU if the MMIEN bit in MMCR1 is set. This
bit is cleared by writing "0" to it or by reset.
1 = Lost arbitration in master mode
0 = No arbitration lost
MMNAKIF — No AcKnowledge Interrupt Flag (Master Mode)
This flag is only set in master mode (MMAST = 1) when there is no
acknowledge bit detected after one data byte or calling address is
transferred. This flag also clears MMAST. MMNAKIF generates an
interrupt request to CPU if the MMIEN bit in MMCR1 is set. This bit is
cleared by writing "0" to it or by reset.
1 = No acknowledge bit detected
0 = Acknowledge bit detected
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
303
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
MMBB — MMIIC Bus Busy Flag
This flag is set after a start condition is detected (bus busy), and is
cleared when a stop condition (bus idle) is detected or the MMIIC is
disabled. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Start condition detected
0 = Stop condition detected or MMIIC is disabled
MMAST — MMIIC Master Control
This bit is set to initiate a master mode transfer. In master mode, the
module generates a start condition to the SDA and SCL lines,
followed by sending the calling address stored in MMADR.
When the MMAST bit is cleared by MMNAKIF set (no acknowledge)
or by software, the module generates the stop condition to the lines
after the current byte is transmitted.
If an arbitration loss occurs (MMALIF = 1), the module reverts to slave
mode by clearing MMAST, and releasing SDA and SCL lines
immediately.
This bit is cleared by writing "0" to it or by reset.
1 = Master mode operation
0 = Slave mode operation
MMRW — MMIIC Master Read/Write
This bit is transmitted out as bit 0 of the calling address when the
module sets the MMAST bit to enter master mode. The MMRW bit
determines the transfer direction of the data bytes that follows. When
it is "1", the module is in master receive mode. When it is "0", the
module is in master transmit mode. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Master mode receive
0 = Master mode transmit
MMCRCEF — MMIIC CRC Error Flag
This flag is set when a CRC error is detected, and cleared when no
CRC error is detected. The MMCRCEF is only meaningful after
receiving a PEC data. This flag is unaffected by reset.
1 = CRC error detected on PEC byte
0 = No CRC error detected on PEC byte
Technical Data
304
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
17.7.4 MMIIC Sta tus Re g iste r (MMSR)
Address: $004B
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read: MMRXIF MMTXIF MMATCH MMSRW MMRXAK MMCRCBF MMTXBE MMRXBF
Write:
0
0
0
0
Reset:
0
0
1
0
1
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-7. MMIIC Status Register (MMSR)
MMRXIF — MMIIC Receive Interrupt Flag
This flag is set after the data receive register (MMDRR) is loaded with
a new received data. Once the MMDRR is loaded with received data,
no more received data can be loaded to the MMDRR register until the
CPU reads the data from the MMDRR to clear MMRXBF flag.
MMRXIF generates an interrupt request to CPU if the MMIEN bit in
MMCR is also set. This bit is cleared by writing "0" to it or by reset; or
when the MMEN = 0.
1 = New data in data receive register (MMDRR)
0 = No data received
MMTXIF — MMIIC Transmit Interrupt Flag
This flag is set when data in the data transmit register (MMDTR) is
downloaded to the output circuit, and that new data can be written to
the MMDTR. MMTXIF generates an interrupt request to CPU if the
MMIEN bit in MMCR is also set. This bit is cleared by writing "0" to it
or when the MMEN = 0.
1 = Data transfer completed
0 = Data transfer in progress
MMATCH — MMIIC Address Match Flag
This flag is set when the received data in the data receive register
(MMDRR) is a calling address which matches with the address or its
extended addresses (MMEXTAD = 1) specified in the address
register (MMADR). The MMATCH flag is set at the 9th clock of the
calling address and will be cleared on the 9th clock of the next
receiving data. Note: slave transmits do not clear MMATCH.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
305
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
1 = Received address matches MMADR
0 = Received address does not match
MMSRW — MMIIC Slave Read/Write Select
This bit indicates the data direction when the module is in slave mode.
It is updated after the calling address is received from a master
device. MMSRW = 1 when the calling master is reading data from the
module (slave transmit mode). MMSRW = 0 when the master is
writing data to the module (receive mode).
1 = Slave mode transmit
0 = Slave mode receive
MMRXAK — MMIIC Receive Acknowledge
When this bit is cleared, it indicates an acknowledge signal has been
received after the completion of eight data bits transmission on the
bus. When MMRXAK is set, it indicates no acknowledge signal has
been detected at the 9th clock; the module will release the SDA line
for the master to generate STOP or repeated START condition. Reset
sets this bit.
1 = No acknowledge signal received at 9th clock
0 = Acknowledge signal received at 9th clock
MMCRCBF — CRC Data Buffer Full Flag
This flag is set when the CRC data register (MMCRCDR) is loaded
with a CRC byte for the current received or transmitted data.
In transmit mode, after a byte of data has been sent (MMTXIF = 1),
the MMCRCBF will be set when the CRC byte has been generated
and ready in the MMCRCDR. The content of the MMCRCDR should
be copied to the MMDTR for transmission.
In receive mode, the MMCRCBF is set when the CRC byte has been
generated and ready in MMCRCDR, for the current byte of received
data.
The MMCRCBF bit is cleared when the CRC data register is read.
Reset also clears this bit.
1 = Data ready in CRC data register (MMCRCDR)
0 = Data not ready in CRC data register (MMCRCDR)
Technical Data
306
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
MMTXBE — MMIIC Transmit Buffer Empty
This flag indicates the status of the data transmit register (MMDTR).
When the CPU writes the data to the MMDTR, the MMTXBE flag will
be cleared. MMTXBE is set when MMDTR is emptied by a transfer of
its data to the output circuit. Reset sets this bit.
1 = Data transmit register empty
0 = Data transmit register full
MMRXBF — MMIIC Receive Buffer Full
This flag indicates the status of the data receive register (MMDRR).
When the CPU reads the data from the MMDRR, the MMRXBF flag
will be cleared. MMRXBF is set when MMDRR is full by a transfer of
data from the input circuit to the MMDRR. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Data receive register full
0 = Data receive register empty
17.7.5 MMIIC Da ta Tra nsm it Re g iste r (MMDTR)
Address: $004C
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
MMTD7 MMTD6 MMTD5 MMTD4 MMTD3 MMTD2 MMTD1 MMTD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 17-8. MMIIC Data Transmit Register (MMDTR)
When the MMIIC module is enabled, MMEN = 1, data written into this
register depends on whether module is in master or slave mode.
In slave mode, the data in MMDTR will be transferred to the output circuit
when:
•
•
the module detects a matched calling address (MMATCH = 1),
with the calling master requesting data (MMSRW = 1); or
the previous data in the output circuit has be transmitted and the
receiving master returns an acknowledge bit, indicated by a
received acknowledge bit (MMRXAK = 0).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
307
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
If the calling master does not return an acknowledge bit (MMRXAK = 1),
the module will release the SDA line for master to generate a STOP or
repeated START condition. The data in the MMDTR will not be
transferred to the output circuit until the next calling from a master. The
transmit buffer empty flag remains cleared (MMTXBE = 0).
In master mode, the data in MMDTR will be transferred to the output
circuit when:
•
the module receives an acknowledge bit (MMRXAK = 0), after
setting master transmit mode (MMRW = 0), and the calling
address has been transmitted; or
•
the previous data in the output circuit has be transmitted and the
receiving slave returns an acknowledge bit, indicated by a
received acknowledge bit (MMRXAK = 0).
If the slave does not return an acknowledge bit (MMRXAK = 1), the
master will generate a STOP or repeated START condition. The data in
the MMDTR will not be transferred to the output circuit. The transmit
buffer empty flag remains cleared (MMTXBE = 0).
The sequence of events for slave transmit and master transmit are
illustrated in Figure 17-12.
17.7.6 MMIIC Da ta Re c e ive Re g iste r (MMDRR)
Address: $004D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read: MMRD7 MMRD6 MMRD5 MMRD4 MMRD3 MMRD2 MMRD1 MMRD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-9. MMIIC Data Receive Register (MMDRR)
When the MMIIC module is enabled, MMEN = 1, data in this read-only
register depends on whether module is in master or slave mode.
In slave mode, the data in MMDRR is:
Technical Data
308
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MMIIC I/O Registers
•
•
the calling address from the master when the address match flag
is set (MMATCH = 1); or
the last data received when MMATCH = 0.
In master mode, the data in the MMDRR is:
the last data received.
•
When the MMDRR is read by the CPU, the receive buffer full flag is
cleared (MMRXBF = 0), and the next received data is loaded to the
MMDRR. Each time when new data is loaded to the MMDRR, the
MMRXIF interrupt flag is set, indicating that new data is available in
MMDRR.
The sequence of events for slave receive and master receive are
illustrated in Figure 17-12.
17.7.7 MMIIC CRC Da ta Re g iste r (MMCRCDR)
Address: $004E
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read: MMCRCD7 MMCRCD6 MMCRCD5 MMCRCD4 MMCRCD3 MMCRCD2 MMCRCD1 MMCRCD0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-10. MMIIC CRC Data Register (MMCRCDR)
When the MMIIC module is enabled, MMEN = 1, and the CRC buffer full
flag is set (MMCRCBF = 1), data in this read-only register contains the
generated CRC byte for the last byte of received or transmitted data.
A CRC byte is generated for each received and transmitted data byte
and loaded to the CRC data register. The MMCRCBF bit will be set to
indicate the CRC byte is ready in the CRC data register.
Reading the CRC data register clears the MMCRCBF bit. If the CRC
data register is not read, the MMCRCBF bit will be cleared by hardware
before the next CRC byte is loaded.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
309
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.7.8 MMIIC Fre q ue nc y Divid e r Re g iste r (MMFDR)
Address: $004F
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
MMBR2 MMBR1 MMBR0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 17-11. MMIIC Frequency Divider Register (MMFDR)
The three bits in the frequency divider register (MMFDR) selects the
divider to divide the bus clock to the desired baud rate for the MMIIC data
transfer.
Table 17-2 shows the divider values for MMBR[2:0].
Table 17-2. MMIIC Baud Rate Selection
MMIIC Baud Rates for Bus Clocks:
MMBR2
MMBR1
MMBR0
Divider
8MHz
400kHz
200kHz
100kHz
50kHz
4MHz
200kHz
100kHz
50kHz
2MHz
100kHz
1MHz
50kHz
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
20
40
50kHz
25kHz
80
25kHz
12.5kHz
6.25kHz
3.125kHz
1.5625kHz
0.78125kHz
0.3906kHz
160
320
640
1280
2560
25kHz
12.5kHz
6.25kHz
3.125kHz
1.5625kHz
0.78125kHz
25kHz
12.5kHz
6.25kHz
3.125kHz
1.5625kHz
12.5kHz
6.25kHz
3.125kHz
NOTE: The frequency of the MMIIC baud rate is only guaranteed for 100kHz to
10kHz. The divider is available for the flexibility on bus frequency
selection.
Technical Data
310
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Program Algorithm
17.8 Prog ra m Alg orithm
When the MMIIC module detects an arbitration loss in master mode, it
releases both SDA and SCL lines immediately. But if there are no further
STOP conditions detected, the module will hang up. Therefore, it is
recommended to have time-out software to recover from this condition.
The software can start the time-out counter by looking at the MMBB (bus
busy) flag and reset the counter on the completion of one byte
transmission. If a time-out has occurred, software can clear the MMEN
bit (disable MMIIC module) to release the bus, and hence clear the
MMBB flag. This is the only way to clear the MMBB flag by software if
the module hangs up due to a no STOP condition received. The MMIIC
can resume operation again by setting the MMEN bit.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
311
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.8.1 Da ta Se q ue nc e
(a) Master Transmit Mode
TX Data1
START
Address
0
ACK
ACK
TX DataN
ACK
STOP
MMTXBE=0
MMTXBE=1
MMTXIF=1
Data2 → MMDTR
MMTXBE=1
MMTXIF=1
Data3 → MMDTR
MMNAKIF=1
MMAST=0
MMTXBE=0
MMTXBE=1
MMTXIF=1
DataN+2 → MMDTR
MMRW=0
MMAST=1
Data1 → MMDTR
(b) Master Receive Mode
START
Address
1
ACK
RX Data1
ACK
RX DataN
NAK
STOP
MMRXBF=0
MMRW=1
MMAST=1
MMTXBE=0
MMNAKIF=1
MMAST=0
Data1 → MMDRR
MMRXIF=1
MMRXBF=1
DataN → MMDRR
MMRXIF=1
MMRXBF=1
(dummy data → MMDTR)
(c) Slave Transmit Mode
START
Address
1
ACK
TX Data1
ACK
TX DataN
NAK
STOP
MMTXBE=1
MMRXBF=0
MMRXIF=1
MMNAKIF=1
MMTXBE=0
MMTXBE=1
MMTXIF=1
Data2 → MMDTR
MMTXBE=1
MMTXIF=1
DataN+2 → MMDTR
MMRXBF=1
MMATCH=1
MMSRW=1
Data1 → MMDTR
(d) Slave Receive Mode
START
Address
0
ACK
RX Data1
ACK
RX DataN
ACK
STOP
Data1 → MMDRR
MMRXIF=1
MMRXBF=1
DataN → MMDRR
MMRXIF=1
MMTXBE=0
MMRXBF=0
MMRXIF=1
MMRXBF=1
MMATCH=1
MMSRW=0
MMRXBF=1
Shaded data packets indicate transmissions by the MCU
Figure 17-12. Data Transfer Sequences for Master/Slave Transmit/Receive Modes
Technical Data
312
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC) MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
SMBus Protocols with PEC and without PEC
17.9 SMBus Protoc ols with PEC a nd without PEC
Following is a description of the various MMIIC bus protocols with and
without a packet error code (PEC).
17.9.1 Quic k Com m a nd
1
7
1
1
1
Master to Slave
Slave to Master
START
Slave Address RW ACK
STOP
Start Condition
Command Bit
Acknowledge
Stop Condition
Figure 17-13. Quick Command
17.9.2 Se nd Byte
Slave Address
W
W
ACK
ACK
Command Code
Command Code
ACK
ACK
STOP
START
(a) Send Byte Protocol
Slave Address
PEC
ACK
STOP
START
(b) Send Byte Protocol with PEC
Figure 17-14. Send Byte
17.9.3 Re c e ive Byte
Data Byte
Data Byte
START
Slave Address
R
R
ACK
ACK
NAK
ACK
STOP
(a) Receive Byte Protocol
PEC
START
Slave Address
NAK
STOP
(b) Receive Byte Protocol with PEC
Figure 17-15. Receive Byte
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
313
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.9.4 Write Byte / Word
Command Code
Command Code
Command Code
Data Byte
Data Byte
START
Slave Address W ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
STOP
(a) Write Byte Protocol
PEC
START
Slave Address W ACK
ACK
ACK
STOP
STOP
(b) Write Byte Protocol with PEC
Data Byte Low
Data Byte High
START
Slave Address W ACK
(c) Write Word Protocol
START
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK Data Byte Low ACK Data Byte High ACK
ACK
STOP
PEC
(d) Write Word Protocol with PEC
Figure 17-16. Write Byte/Word
17.9.5 Re a d Byte / Word
Command Code
Command Code
Data Byte
Data Byte
START
Slave Address W ACK
ACK START
ACK START
Slave Address
Slave Address
R
R
ACK
ACK
NAK
STOP
(a) Read Byte Protocol
START
Slave Address W ACK
NAK
STOP
ACK
ACK
PEC
(b) Read Byte Protocol with PEC
Command Code
Data Byte Low
START
Slave Address W ACK
ACK START
Slave Address
Slave Address
R
R
ACK
Data Byte High
NAK
STOP
(c) Read Word Protocol
START
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK START
ACK Data Byte Low ACK
Data Byte High ACK
PEC
NAK
STOP
(d) Read Word Protocol with PEC
Figure 17-17. Read Byte/Word
Technical Data
314
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC) MOTOROLA
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
SMBus Protocols with PEC and without PEC
17.9.6 Proc e ss Ca ll
Command Code
Data Byte Low
Data Byte Low
Data Byte High
Data Byte High
STOP
START
Slave Address W ACK
Slave Address ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
NAK
ACK
START
R
(a) Process Call
Command Code
Data Byte Low
Data Byte Low
Data Byte High
Data Byte High
STOP
START
START
Slave Address W ACK
Slave Address ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
ACK
PEC
R
NAK
STOP
(b) Process Call with PEC
Figure 17-18. Process Call
17.9.7 Bloc k Re a d / Write
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK Byte Count = N ACK
ACK ACK
STOP
Data Byte 1
ACK
ACK
START
Data Byte 2
Data Byte N
(a) Block Read
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK Byte Count = N ACK
Data Byte N PEC
Data Byte 1
START
Data Byte 2
ACK
ACK
ACK
STOP
STOP
(b) Block Read with PEC
START
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK START
ACK ACK
Data Byte 2 Data Byte N
Slave Address
R
ACK Byte Count = N ACK
Data Byte 1
(c) Block Write
NAK
START
Slave Address W ACK Command Code ACK START
ACK ACK
Data Byte 2 Data Byte N
Slave Address
R
ACK Byte Count = N ACK
Data Byte 1
ACK
PEC
NAK
STOP
(d) Block Write with PEC
Figure 17-19. Block Read/Write
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC)
Technical Data
315
Multi-Ma ste r IIC Inte rfa c e (MMIIC)
17.10 SMBus Protoc ol Im p le m e nta tion
Shaded data packets indicate transmissions by the MCU
MASTER MODE
START Address
0
ACK
Command ACK START Address 1 ACK RX Data1 ACK
ACK RX DataN NAK STOP
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
Read received data
Prepare for repeated START
Generate STOP
Get ready to receive data
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
MMRXIF set
MMTXIF set
MMRXAK clear
MMRXIF set
MMTXIF set
MMRXAK clear
ACTION:
ACTION:
ACTION:
Read DataN from MMDRR
Read Data1 from MMDRR
ACTION:
1. Set MMRW
Load dummy ($FF) to MMDTR
2. Set REPSEN
3. Clear MMTXAK
4. Load dummy ($FF) to MMDTR
OPERATION:
Read received data and prepare for STOP
OPERATION:
Prepare for Master mode
FLAGS:
MMRXIF set
ACTION:
1. Load slave address to MMADR
2. Clear MMRW
ACTION:
1. Set MMTXAK
3. Load command to MMDTR
4. Set MMAST
2. Read Data(N-1) from MMDRR
3. Clear MMAST
SLAVE MODE
START Address
0
ACK
Command ACK START Address 1 ACK TX Data1 ACK
ACK TX DataN NAK STOP
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
Transmit data
Slave address match and
check for data direction
Slave address match and
get ready to transmit data
Last data sent
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
MMTXIF set
MMRXAK clear
MMTXIF set
MMRXAK set
MMRXIF set
MMATCH set
MMSRW depends on 8th
bit of calling address byte
MMRXIF set
MMATCH set
MMSRW depends on 8th
bit of calling address byte
ACTION:
ACTION:
Load dummy ($FF) to MMDTR
Load Data3 to MMDTR
ACTION:
ACTION:
1. Check MMSRW
2. Read Slave address
Check MMSRW
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
Read and decode received command
Last data is going to be sent
OPERATION:
OPERATION:
Transmit data
FLAGS:
FLAGS:
Prepare for Slave mode
MMRXIF set
MMATCH clear
MMTXIF set
MMRXAK clear
FLAGS:
ACTION:
MMTXIF set
1. Load slave address to MMADR
2. Clear MMTXAK
3. Clear MMAST
ACTION:
ACTION:
ACTION:
Load Data1 to MMDTR
Load dummy ($FF) to MMDTR
Load Data2 to MMDTR
Figure 17-20. SMBus Protocol Implementation
Technical Data
316
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 18. Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
18.1 Conte nts
18.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
18.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
18.3.1 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
18.3.2 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
18.3.3 Port A LED Control Register (LEDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
18.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
18.4.1 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
18.4.2 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
18.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
18.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
18.5.2 Data Direction Register C (DDRC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
18.5.3 Port C LED Control Register (LEDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
18.6 Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
18.6.1 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
18.6.2 Data Direction Register D (DDRD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
18.2 Introd uc tion
Thirty-one (31) bidirectional input-output (I/O) pins form four parallel
ports. All I/O pins are programmable as inputs or outputs.
NOTE: Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or
VSS. Although the I/O ports do not require termination for proper
operation, termination reduces excess current consumption and the
possibility of electrostatic damage.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
317
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
Port A Data Register
(PTA)
$0000
Unaffected by reset
PTB4 PTB3
Unaffected by reset
PTC4 PTC3
Unaffected by reset
PTD4 PTD3
Unaffected by reset
DDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0
0
PTB6
PTC6
PTD6
PTB5
PTC5
PTD5
PTB2
PTC2
PTD2
PTB1
PTC1
PTD1
PTB0
PTC0
PTD0
Port B Data Register
(PTB)
$0001
$0002
$0003
$0004
$0005
$0006
$0007
$000C
$000D
PTC7
PTD7
Port C Data Register
(PTC)
Port D Data Register
(PTD)
Data Direction Register A
(DDRA)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0
Data Direction Register B
(DDRB)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
Data Direction Register C
(DDRC)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0
Data Direction Register D
(DDRD)
0
0
0
0
0
LEDA5
0
0
LEDA4
0
0
LEDA3
0
0
0
0
Port-A LED Control
LEDA2
LEDA1
LEDA0
Register Write:
(LEDA)
Reset:
0
LEDC7
0
0
LEDC6
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Port-C LED Control
LEDC5
0
LEDC4
0
LEDC3
0
Register Write:
(LEDC)
Reset:
0
0
0
Figure 18-1. I/O Port Register Summary
Technical Data
318
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Introduction
Table 18-1. Port Control Register Bits Summary
Module Control
DDR
Port
Bit
Pin
Module
Register
Control Bit
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
DDRA0
DDRA1
DDRA2
DDRA3
DDRA4
DDRA5
DDRA6
DDRA7
DDRB0
DDRB1
DDRB2
PTA0/ATD2
PTA1/ATD3
PTA2/ATD4
ADC
ADSCR ($0057)
ADCH[4:0]
PTA3/ATD5
A
PTA4/ATD6
PTA5/ATD7
T1SC0 ($0025)
T1SC1 ($0028)
ELS0B:ELS0A
ELS1B:ELS1A
PTA6/T1CH0
PTA7/T1CH1
PTB0/SDA0(1)
PTB1/SCL0(1)
PTB2/SDA1/TxD(1)
TIM1
MMEN
SDASCL1
MBUS
MMCR1 ($0049)
SCC1 ($0013)(2)
MMCR1 ($0049)
SCI
ENSCI
MMEN
SDASCL1
PTB3/SCL1/RxD(1)
B
C
D
3
DDRB3
MBUS
4
5
6
DDRB4
DDRB5
DDRB6
T2SC0 ($0030)
T2SC1 ($0033)
—
ELS0B:ELS0A
ELS1B:ELS1A
—
PTB4/T2CH0
PTB5/T2CH1
PTB6/IRQ2
TIM2
IRQ
CONFIG2 ($001D)(1)
ANALOG
CDOEN
PCH0
0
DDRC0
PTC0/PWM0/CD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
DDRC1
DDRC2
DDRC3
DDRC4
DDRC5
DDRC6
DDRC7
DDRD0
DDRD1
DDRD2
DDRD3
DDRD4
DDRD5
DDRD6
DDRD7
PWM
ADC
PWMCR ($0051)
PCH1
PTC1/PWM1
PTC2/PWM2
PTC3/ATD8
PTC4/ATD9
PTC5/ATD10
PTC6/ATD11
PTC7/ATD12
PTD0/KBI0
PTD1/KBI1
PTD2/KBI2
PTD3/KBI3
PTD4/KBI4
PTD5/KBI5
PTD6/KBI6
PTD7/KBI7
PCH2
ADSCR ($0057)
ADCH[4:0]
KBIE0
KBIE1
KBIE2
KBIE3
KBIE4
KBIE5
KBIE6
KBIE7
KBI
KBIER ($001B)
Notes:
1. Pins are open-drain when configured as outputs. Pullup resistors must be connected when configured as outputs.
2. Register has the highest priority control on port pin.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
319
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
18.3 Port A
Port A is an 8-bit special function port that shares six of its port pins with
the analog-to-digital converter (ADC) module and two of its port pins with
the timer interface module 1 (TIM1). See Section 15. Analog-to-Digital
Converter (ADC) and Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM).
PTA5–PTA0 pins can be configured for direct LED drive.
18.3.1 Port A Da ta Re g iste r (PTA)
The port A data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port A
pins.
Address: $0000
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
Unaffected by Reset
ATD6 ATD5
Alternative Function: T1CH1
Additional Function:
T1CH0
ATD7
ATD4
ATD3
ATD2
LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive
Figure 18-2. Port A Data Register (PTA)
PTA[7:0] — Port A Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port A pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register A. Reset has no effect on port A data.
ATD[7:2] — ADC channels 2 to 7
ATD[7:2] are pins used for the input channels to the analog-to-digital
converter module. The channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], in the ADC
status and control register define which port pin will be used as an
ADC input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See
Section 14. Analog Module.
Technical Data
320
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port A
T1CH[1:0] — Timer 1 Channel I/O Bits
The T1CH1 and T1CH0 pins are the TIM1 input capture/output
compare pins. The edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA, determine
whether the PTA7/T1CH1 and PTA6/T1CH0 pins are timer channel
I/O pins or general-purpose I/O pins. See Section 11. Timer
Interface Module (TIM).
NOTE: Care must be taken when reading port A while applying analog voltages
to ATD[7:2] pins. If the appropriate ADC channel is not enabled,
excessive current drain may occur if analog voltages are applied to the
PTAx/ATDx pin, while PTA is read as a digital input. Those ports not
selected as analog input channels are considered digital I/O ports.
LED drive — Direct LED drive Pins
PTA5–PTA0 pins can be configured for direct LED drive. See 18.3.3
Port A LED Control Register (LEDA).
18.3.2 Da ta Dire c tion Re g iste r A (DDRA)
Data direction register A determines whether each port A pin is an input
or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRA bit enables the output buffer for
the corresponding port A pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer.
Address: $0004
Bit 7
DDRA7
0
6
DDRA6
0
5
4
3
2
DDRA2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3
DDRA1 DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 18-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA)
DDRA[7:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits
These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears
DDRA[7:0], configuring all port A pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
321
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
NOTE: Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before
changing data direction register A bits from 0 to 1. Figure 18-4 shows
the port A I/O logic.
READ DDRA ($0004)
WRITE DDRA ($0004)
DDRAx
RESET
WRITE PTA ($0000)
PTAx
PTAx
READ PTA ($0000)
Figure 18-4. Port A I/O Circuit
When DDRAx is a logic 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx data
latch. When DDRAx is a logic 0, reading address $0000 reads the
voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless
of the state of its data direction bit.
Table 18-2 summarizes the operation of the port A pins.
Table 18-2. Port A Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRA
Read/Write
Accesses to PTA
DDRA
Bit
PTA Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Read
Pin
Write
0
1
X(1)
X
Input, Hi-Z(2)
Output
DDRA[7:0]
PTA[7:0](3)
PTA[7:0]
DDRA[7:0]
PTA[7:0]
Notes:
1. X = don’t care.
2. Hi-Z = high impedance.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
Technical Data
322
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port B
18.3.3 Port A LED Control Re g iste r (LEDA)
The port-A LED control register (LEDA) controls the direct LED drive
capability on PTA5–PTA0 pins. Each bit is individually configurable and
requires that the data direction register, DDRD, bit be configured as an
output.
Address: $000C
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
LEDA5
0
4
LEDA4
0
3
LEDA3
0
2
LEDA2
0
1
LEDA1
0
Bit 0
LEDA0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
Figure 18-5. Port A LED Control Register (LEDA)
LEDA[5:0] — Port A LED Drive Enable Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable to enable the direct
LED drive on an output port pin.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured for direct LED drive
0 = Corresponding port A pin configured for standard drive
18.4 Port B
Port B is a 7-bit special function port that shares four of its port pins with
the multi-master IIC (MMIIC) interface module, two of its port pins with
the serial communications interface (SCI) module, two of its port pins
with the timer interface module 2 (TIM2), and one of its port pins with the
IRQ module. See Section 17. Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC),
Section 16. Serial Communications Interface (SCI), Section 11.
Timer Interface Module (TIM), and Section 19. External Interrupt
(IRQ).
NOTE: PTB3–PTB0 are open-drain pins when configured as outputs regardless
whether the pins are used as general purpose I/O pins, MMIIC pins, or
SCI pins. Therefore, when configured as general purpose output pins,
MMIIC pins, or SCI pins (the TxD pin), pullup resistors must be
connected to these pins.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
323
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
18.4.1 Port B Da ta Re g iste r (PTB)
The port B data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port B
pins.
Address: $0001
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Unaffected by reset
RxD
T2CH0
TxD
Alternative Functions:
IRQ2
T2CH1
SCL0
SDA0
SCL1
SDA1
These four pins are open-drain when configured as
output pins. Pullup resistors must be connected
when configured as outputs.
Figure 18-6. Port B Data Register (PTB)
PTB[6:0] — Port B Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port B pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register B. Reset has no effect on port B data.
SDA0, SCL0, SDA1, SCL1 — MMIIC Channels 1 and 2
SDAx and SCLx are the data and clock lines for the MMIIC module.
The multi-master enable bit, MMEN, and the MMIIC channel select
bit, SDASCL1, in the MMIIC control register 1 determine whether the
PTB0/SDA0, PTB1/SCL0, PTB2/SDA1/TxD, and PTB3/SCL1/RxD
pins are MMIIC I/O pins or general purpose I/O pins. See Section 17.
Multi-Master IIC Interface (MMIIC).
TxD, RxD — SCI Data I/O Pins
The TxD and RxD pins are the transmit data output and receive data
input for the SCI module. The enable SCI bit, ENSCI, in the SCI
control register 1 enables the PTB2/SDA1/TxD and PTB3/SCL1/RxD
pins as SCI TxD and RxD pins and overrides any control from the port
I/O or MMIIC logic. See Section 16. Serial Communications
Interface (SCI).
Technical Data
324
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port B
Table 18-3. PTB2 and PTB3 Pin Configurations
ENSCI
Bit
($0013)
MMEN
Bit
($0049)
SDASCL1
Bit
($0049)
Pin
Pin function
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
0
1
X
PTB2, PTB3
PTB2, PTB3
SDA1, SCL1
TxD, RxD
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
PTB3/SCL1/RxD
T2CH[1:0] — Timer 2 Channel I/O Bits
The T2CH1 and T2CH0 pins are the TIM2 input capture/output
compare pins. The edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA, determine
whether the PTB5/T2CH1 and PTB4/T2CH0 pins are timer channel
I/O pins or general-purpose I/O pins.See Section 11. Timer
Interface Module (TIM).
IRQ2 — External Interrupt Pin 2
IRQ2 pin is the second external interrupt input to the IRQ module.
When PTB6/IRQ2 is configured as an input by the data direction bit
bit, DDRB6, the pin is both a standard port input pin and an external
interrupt pin. See Section 19. External Interrupt (IRQ).
18.4.2 Da ta Dire c tion Re g iste r B (DDRB)
Data direction register B determines whether each port B pin is an input
or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRB bit enables the output buffer for
the corresponding port B pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer.
Address: $0005
Bit 7
0
6
DDRB6
0
5
4
3
2
DDRB2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3
DDRB1 DDRB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 18-7. Data Direction Register B (DDRB)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
325
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
DDRB[6:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits
These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears
DDRB[6:0], configuring all port B pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input
NOTE: Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before
changing data direction register B bits from 0 to 1. Figure 18-8 shows
the port B I/O logic.
READ DDRB ($0005)
WRITE DDRB ($0005)
DDRBx
RESET
WRITE PTB ($0001)
#
PTBx
PTBx
READ PTB ($0001)
# PTB3–PTB0 are open-drain pins when configured as outputs.
Figure 18-8. Port B I/O Circuit
When DDRBx is a logic 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx data
latch. When DDRBx is a logic 0, reading address $0001 reads the
voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless
of the state of its data direction bit.
Table 18-4 summarizes the operation of the port B pins.
Table 18-4. Port B Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRB
Read/Write
Accesses to PTB
DDRB
Bit
PTB Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Read
Pin
Write
0
1
X(1)
X
Input, Hi-Z(2)
Output
DDRB[6:0]
PTB[6:0](3)
PTB[6:0]
DDRB[6:0]
PTB[6:0]
Notes:
1. X = don’t care.
2. Hi-Z = high impedance.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
Technical Data
326
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port C
18.5 Port C
Port C is an 8-bit special function port that shares three of its port pins
with the pulse width modulator module, five of its port pins with the
analog-to-digital converter module, and one of its pins with the analog
module. See Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM), Section 15.
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC), and Section 14. Analog Module.
PTC7–PTC3 pins can be configured for direct LED drive.
18.5.1 Port C Da ta Re g iste r (PTC)
The port C data register contains a data latch for each of the six port C
pins.
NOTE: Bit 7 and bit 6 of PTC are not available in a 42-pin shrink dual in-line
package.
Address: $0002
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PTC7
PTC6
PTC5
PTC4
PTC3
PTC2
PTC1
PTC0
Unaffected by reset
ATD9 ATD8
Alternative Function: ATD12
ATD11
ATD10
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
CD
Additional Function: LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive
Figure 18-9. Port C Data Register (PTC)
PTC[7:0] — Port C Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port C pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register C. Reset has no effect on port C data.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
327
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
PWM[2:0] — PWM Channels 0 to 2
PWM[2:0] are pins used for the output channels from the pulse width
modulator (PWM) module. The PWM enables bit, PCH[2:0], in the
PWM control register define which port pin will be used as a PWM
output and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. The PWM0
function on PCT0/PWM0/CD pin can be overrided by the CD output
function. See Section 13. Pulse Width Modulator (PWM).
ATD[12:8] — ADC channels 8 to 12
ATD[12:8] are pins used for the input channels to the analog-to-digital
converter module. The channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], in the ADC
status and control register define which port pin will be used as an
ADC input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See
Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
NOTE: Care must be taken when reading port C while applying analog voltages
to ATD[12:8] pins. If the appropriate ADC channel is not enabled,
excessive current drain may occur if analog voltages are applied to the
PTCx/ATDx pin, while PTC is read as a digital input. Those ports not
selected as analog input channels are considered digital I/O ports.
CD — Current Detect Output Pin
The CD pin is used for the current detect output from the analog
module. The pin reflects the status of the current detect interrupt flag.
The current detect output enable bit, CDOEN, in the configuration
register 2 enables the PTC0/PWM0/CD pin as the CD output pin and
overrides any control from the port I/O or PWM logic. See Section 14.
Analog Module.
Table 18-5. PTC0 Pin Configuration
CDOEN Bit
($001D)
PCH0 Bit
($0051)
Pin
Pin function
0
0
1
0
1
PTC0
PWM0
CD
PTC0/PWM0/CD
X
LED drive — Direct LED drive Pins
PTC7–PTC3 pins can be configured for direct LED drive. See 18.5.3
Port C LED Control Register (LEDC).
Technical Data
328
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port C
18.5.2 Da ta Dire c tion Re g iste r C (DDRC)
Data direction register C determines whether each port C pin is an input
or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRC bit enables the output buffer for
the corresponding port C pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer.
Address: $0006
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 18-10. Data Direction Register B (DDRB)
DDRC[7:0] — Data Direction Register C Bits
These read/write bits control port C data direction. Reset clears
DDRC[7:0], configuring all port C pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port C pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port C pin configured as input
NOTE: Avoid glitches on port C pins by writing to the port C data register before
changing data direction register C bits from 0 to 1. Figure 18-11 shows
the port C I/O logic.
NOTE: For those devices packaged in a 42-pin shrink dual in-line package,
PTC6 and PTC7 are not connected. DDRC6 and DDRC7 should be set
to a 1 to configure PTC6 and PTC7 as outputs.
READ DDRC ($0006)
WRITE DDRC ($0006)
DDRCx
RESET
WRITE PTC ($0002)
PTCx
PTCx
READ PTC ($0002)
Figure 18-11. Port C I/O Circuit
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
329
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
When DDRCx is a logic 1, reading address $0002 reads the PTCx data
latch. When DDRCx is a logic 0, reading address $0002 reads the
voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless
of the state of its data direction bit.
Table 18-6 summarizes the operation of the port C pins.
Table 18-6. Port C Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRC
Read/Write
Accesses to PTC
DDRC
Bit
PTC Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Read
Pin
Write
(3)
0
1
X(1)
X
Input, Hi-Z(2)
Output
DDRC[7:0]
PTC[7:0]
DDRC[7:0]
PTC[7:0]
PTC[7:0]
Notes:
1. X = don’t care.
2. Hi-Z = high impedance.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
18.5.3 Port C LED Control Re g iste r (LEDC)
The port-C LED control register (LEDC) controls the direct LED drive
capability on PTC7–PTC3 pins. Each bit is individually configurable and
requires that the data direction register, DDRD, bit be configured as an
output.
Address: $000D
Bit 7
LEDC7
0
6
LEDC6
0
5
LEDC5
0
4
LEDC4
0
3
LEDC3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
Figure 18-12. Port A LED Control Register (LEDA)
LEDC[7:3] — Port C LED Drive Enable Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable to enable the direct
LED drive on an output port pin.
1 = Corresponding port C pin configured for direct LED drive
0 = Corresponding port C pin configured for standard drive
Technical Data
330
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port D
18.6 Port D
Port D is an 8-bit special function port that shares all of its pins with the
keyboard interrupt module. See Section 20. Keyboard Interrupt
Module (KBI).
18.6.1 Port D Da ta Re g iste r (PTD)
The port D data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port D
pins.
Address: $0003
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
PTD7
Write:
PTD6
PTD5
PTD4
PTD3
PTD2
PTD1
PTD0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
KBI4 KBI3
Alternative Function:
KBI7
KBI6
KBI5
KBI2
KBI1
KBI0
Figure 18-13. Port D Data Register (PTD)
PTD[7:0] — Port D Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port D pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register D. Reset has no effect on port D data.
KBI[7:0] — Keyboard Interrupt Pins
The keyboard interrupt enable bits, KBIE[7:0], in the keyboard
interrupt enable register (KBIER), enable the port D pins as external
interrupt pins. See Section 20. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
331
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
18.6.2 Da ta Dire c tion Re g iste r D (DDRD)
Data direction register D determines whether each port D pin is an input
or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRD bit enables the output buffer for
the corresponding port D pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer.
Address: $0007
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 18-14. Data Direction Register D (DDRD)
DDRD[7:0] — Data Direction Register D Bits
These read/write bits control port D data direction. Reset clears
DDRD[7:0], configuring all port D pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port D pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port D pin configured as input
NOTE: Avoid glitches on port D pins by writing to the port D data register before
changing data direction register D bits from 0 to 1. Figure 18-15 shows
the port D I/O logic.
READ DDRD ($0007)
WRITE DDRD ($0007)
DDRDx
RESET
WRITE PTD ($0003)
PTDx
PTDx
READ PTD ($0003)
Figure 18-15. Port D I/O Circuit
Technical Data
332
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port D
When DDRDx is a logic 1, reading address $0003 reads the PTDx data
latch. When DDRDx is a logic 0, reading address $0003 reads the
voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless
of the state of its data direction bit.
Table 18-7 summarizes the operation of the port D pins.
Table 18-7. Port D Pin Functions
Accesses
Accesses to PTD
DDRD
Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
to DDRD
PTD Bit
Read/Write
Read
Pin
Write
0
1
X(1)
X
Input, Hi-Z(2) DDRD[7:0]
Output DDRD[7:0]
PTD[7:0](3)
PTD[7:0]
PTD[7:0]
Notes:
1. X = don’t care.
2. Hi-Z = high impedance.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect the input.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Technical Data
333
Inp ut/ Outp ut (I/ O) Ports
Technical Data
334
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 19. Exte rna l Inte rrup t (IRQ)
19.1 Conte nts
19.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
19.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
19.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
19.5 IRQ1 and IRQ2 Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
19.6 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
19.7 IRQ Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
19.7.1 IRQ1 Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
19.7.2 IRQ2 Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
19.2 Introd uc tion
19.3 Fe a ture s
The external interrupt (IRQ) module provides two maskable interrupt
inputs: IRQ1 and IRQ2.
Features of the IRQ module include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
A dedicated external interrupt pin, IRQ1
An external interrupt pin shared with a port pin, IRQ2/PTB6
Separate IRQ interrupt control bits for IRQ1 and IRQ2
Hysteresis buffers
Programmable edge-only or edge and level interrupt sensitivity
Automatic interrupt acknowledge
Internal pullup resistor, with disable option on IRQ2
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ)
Technical Data
335
Exte rna l Inte rrup t (IRQ)
NOTE: References to either IRQ1 or IRQ2 may be made in the following text by
omitting the IRQ number. For example, IRQF may refer generically to
IRQ1F and IRQ2F, and IMASK may refer to IMASK1 and IMASK2.
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
IRQ2F
0
ACK2
0
IRQ2 Status and Control
PTBPUE6
IMASK2 MODE2
$001C
Register Write:
(INTSCR2)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
IRQ1F
0
IRQ1 Status and Control
IMASK1 MODE1
$001E
Register Write:
ACK1
0
(INTSCR1)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 19-1. External Interrupt I/O Register Summary
19.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
A logic 0 applied to the external interrupt pin can latch a CPU interrupt
request. Figure 19-2 and Figure 19-3 shows the structure of the IRQ
module.
Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ latch. An
interrupt latch remains set until one of the following actions occurs:
•
Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt
acknowledge signal that clears the latch that caused the vector
fetch.
•
Software clear — Software can clear an interrupt latch by writing
to the appropriate acknowledge bit in the interrupt status and
control register (INTSCR). Writing a logic 1 to the ACK bit clears
the IRQ latch.
•
Reset — A reset automatically clears the interrupt latch.
The external interrupt pin is falling-edge-triggered and is software-
configurable to be either falling-edge or falling-edge and low-level-
triggered. The MODE bit in the INTSCR controls the triggering sensitivity
of the IRQ pin.
Technical Data
336
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Functional Description
When an interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the interrupt remains set
until a vector fetch, software clear, or reset occurs.
When an interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level-triggered, the
interrupt remains set until both of the following occur:
•
•
Vector fetch or software clear
Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1
The vector fetch or software clear may occur before or after the interrupt
pin returns to logic 1. As long as the pin is low, the interrupt request
remains pending. A reset will clear the latch and the MODE1 control bit,
thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low.
When set, the IMASK bit in the INTSCR mask all external interrupt
requests. A latched interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt
priority logic unless the IMASK bit is clear.
NOTE: The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all
interrupt requests, including external interrupt requests.
ACK1
RESET
TO CPU FOR
VECTOR
BIL/BIH
FETCH
INSTRUCTIONS
DECODER
VDD
V
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
DD
IRQ1F
CLR
D
Q
SYNCHRO-
NIZER
IRQ1
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
CK
IRQ1
IRQ1
FF
IMASK1
MODE1
TO MODE
SELECT
LOGIC
HIGH
VOLTAGE
DETECT
Figure 19-2. IRQ1 Block Diagram
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ)
Technical Data
337
Exte rna l Inte rrup t (IRQ)
ACK2
RESET
VECTOR
FETCH
DECODER
VDD
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
V
DD
IRQ2F
PTBPUE6
CLR
D
Q
SYNCHRO-
NIZER
IRQ2
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
CK
IRQ2
IRQ2
FF
IMASK2
MODE2
Figure 19-3. IRQ2 Block Diagram
19.5 IRQ1 a nd IRQ2 Pins
A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch.
A vector fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch.
If the MODE bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge-sensitive and low-
level-sensitive. With MODE set, both of the following actions must occur
to clear IRQ:
•
Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an
interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software may
generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to
the ACK bit in the interrupt status and control register (INTSCR).
The ACK bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ pin and
require software to clear the IRQ latch. Writing to the ACK bit prior
to leaving an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious
interrupts due to noise. Setting ACK does not affect subsequent
transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling edge that occurs after writing
to the ACK bit another interrupt request. If the IRQ mask bit,
IMASK, is clear, the CPU loads the program counter with the
vector address at location defined in Table 2-1 . Vector
Addresses.
Technical Data
338
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
IRQ Module During Break Interrupts
•
Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at
logic 0, IRQ remains active.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1
may occur in any order. The interrupt request remains pending as long
as the IRQ pin is at logic 0. A reset will clear the latch and the MODE
control bit, thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low.
If the MODE bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge-sensitive only. With
MODE clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the IRQ
latch.
The IRQF bit in the INTSCR register can be used to check for pending
interrupts. The IRQF bit is not affected by the IMASK bit, which makes it
useful in applications where polling is preferred.
Use the BIH or BIL instruction to read the logic level on the IRQ1 pin.
NOTE: The BIH and BIL instructions do not read the logic level on the IRQ2 pin.
NOTE: When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by
masking interrupt requests in the interrupt routine.
The IRQ1 pin has a permanent internal pullup device connected, while
the IRQ2 pin has an optional pullup device that can be enabled or
disabled by the PTBPUE6 bit in the INTSCR2 register.
19.6 IRQ Mod ule During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables
software to clear the latch during the break state. (See Section 23.
Break Module (BRK).)
To allow software to clear the IRQ latch during a break interrupt, write a
logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it
remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect CPU interrupt flags during the break state, write a logic 0 to
the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), writing to the ACK
bit in the IRQ status and control register during the break state has no
effect on the IRQ interrupt flags.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ)
Technical Data
339
Exte rna l Inte rrup t (IRQ)
19.7 IRQ Re g iste rs
Each IRQ is controlled and monitored by an status and control register.
•
•
IRQ1 Status and Control Register — $001E
IRQ2 Status and Control Register — $001C
19.7.1 IRQ1 Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
The IRQ1 status and control register (INTSCR1) controls and monitors
operation of IRQ1. The INTSCR1 has the following functions:
•
•
•
•
Shows the state of the IRQ1 flag
Clears the IRQ1 latch
Masks IRQ1 interrupt request
Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ1 interrupt pin
Address: $001E
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
IRQ1F
IMASK1 MODE1
ACK1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 19-4. IRQ1 Status and Control Register (INTSCR1)
IRQ1F — IRQ1 Flag Bit
This read-only status bit is high when the IRQ1 interrupt is pending.
1 = IRQ1 interrupt pending
0 = IRQ1 interrupt not pending
ACK1 — IRQ1 Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ1 latch. ACK1
always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACK1.
Technical Data
340
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
IRQ Registers
IMASK1 — IRQ1 Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ1 interrupt requests.
Reset clears IMASK1.
1 = IRQ1 interrupt requests disabled
0 = IRQ1 interrupt requests enabled
MODE1 — IRQ1 Edge/Level Select Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ1 pin.
Reset clears MODE1.
1 = IRQ1 interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = IRQ1 interrupt requests on falling edges only
19.7.2 IRQ2 Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
The IRQ2 status and control register (INTSCR2) controls and monitors
operation of IRQ2. The INTSCR2 has the following functions:
•
•
•
•
•
Enables/disables the internal pullup device on IRQ2 pin
Shows the state of the IRQ2 flag
Clears the IRQ2 latch
Masks IRQ2 interrupt request
Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ2 interrupt pin
Address: $001C
Bit 7
6
PTBPUE6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
IRQ2F
IMASK2 MODE2
ACK2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 19-5. IRQ2 Status and Control Register (INTSCR2)
PTBPUE6 — IRQ2 Pin Pullup Enable Bit.
Setting this bit to logic 1 disables the pullup on PTB6/IRQ2 pin.
Reset clears this bit.
1 = IRQ2 pin internal pull-up is disabled
0 = IRQ2 pin internal pull-up is enabled
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ)
Technical Data
341
Exte rna l Inte rrup t (IRQ)
IRQ2F — IRQ2 Flag Bit
This read-only status bit is high when the IRQ2 interrupt is pending.
1 = IRQ2 interrupt pending
0 = IRQ2 interrupt not pending
ACK2 — IRQ2 Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ2 latch. ACK2
always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACK2.
IMASK2 — IRQ2 Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ2 interrupt requests.
Reset clears IMASK2.
1 = IRQ2 interrupt requests disabled
0 = IRQ2 interrupt requests enabled
MODE2 — IRQ2 Edge/Level Select Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ2 pin.
Reset clears MODE2.
1 = IRQ2 interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = IRQ2 interrupt requests on falling edges only
Technical Data
342
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 20. Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Mod ule (KBI)
20.1 Conte nts
20.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .343
20.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
20.4 I/O Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
20.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
20.5.1 Keyboard Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
20.6 Keyboard Interrupt Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
20.6.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
20.6.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.8 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.9 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
20.10 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
20.2 Introd uc tion
The keyboard interrupt module (KBI) provides eight independently
maskable external interrupts which are accessible via PTD0–PTD7.
When a port pin is enabled for keyboard interrupt function, an internal
30kΩ pullup device is also enabled on the pin.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Technical Data
343
Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Mod ule (KBI)
20.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the keyboard interrupt module include the following:
•
•
Eight keyboard interrupt pins with pullup devices
Separate keyboard interrupt enable bits and one keyboard
interrupt mask
•
•
Programmable edge-only or edge- and level- interrupt sensitivity
Exit from low-lower modes
Addr.
Register Name
Keyboard Status
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
IMASKK MODEK
$001A
and Control Register Write:
(KBSCR)
Reset:
0
KBIE7
0
0
KBIE6
0
0
KBIE5
0
0
KBIE4
0
0
KBIE3
0
0
KBIE1
0
0
KBIE0
0
Read:
KBIE2
0
Keyboard Interrupt Enable
Write:
$001B
Register (KBIER)
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 20-1. KBI I/O Register Summary
20.4 I/ O Pins
The eight keyboard interrupt pins are shared with standard port I/O pins.
The full name of the KBI pins are listed in Table 20-1. The generic pin
name appear in the text that follows.
Table 20-1. Pin Name Conventions
KBI
Pin Selected for KBI Function by
Full MCU Pin Name
Generic Pin Name
KBIEx Bit in KBIER
KBI0–KBI7
PTD0/KBI0–PTD7/KBI7
KBIE0–KBIE7
Technical Data
344
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Functional Description
20.5 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
INTERNAL BUS
VECTOR FETCH
DECODER
KBI0
ACKK
V
DD
KEYF
RESET
CLR
.
D
Q
SYNCHRONIZER
Keyboard
Interrupt
Request
KBIE0
.
TO PULLUP ENABLE
.
CK
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT FF
IMASKK
KBI7
MODEK
KBIE7
TO PULLUP ENABLE
Figure 20-2. Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram
Writing to the KBIE7–KBIE0 bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register
independently enables or disables each port D pin as a keyboard
interrupt pin. Enabling a keyboard interrupt pin in port D also enables its
internal pull-up device. A logic 0 applied to an enabled keyboard
interrupt pin latches a keyboard interrupt request.
A keyboard interrupt is latched when one or more keyboard pins goes
low after all were high. The MODEK bit in the keyboard status and
control register controls the triggering mode of the keyboard interrupt.
•
If the keyboard interrupt is edge-sensitive only, a falling edge on a
keyboard pin does not latch an interrupt request if another
keyboard pin is already low. To prevent losing an interrupt request
on one pin because another pin is still low, software can disable
the latter pin while it is low.
•
If the keyboard interrupt is falling edge- and low level-sensitive, an
interrupt request is present as long as any keyboard pin is low.
If the MODEK bit is set, the keyboard interrupt pins are both falling edge-
and low level-sensitive, and both of the following actions must occur to
clear a keyboard interrupt request:
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Technical Data
345
Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Mod ule (KBI)
•
Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an
interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the interrupt request.
Software may generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by
writing a logic 1 to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control
register KBSCR. The ACKK bit is useful in applications that poll
the keyboard interrupt pins and require software to clear the
keyboard interrupt request. Writing to the ACKK bit prior to leaving
an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious interrupts
due to noise. Setting ACKK does not affect subsequent transitions
on the keyboard interrupt pins. A falling edge that occurs after
writing to the ACKK bit latches another interrupt request. If the
keyboard interrupt mask bit, IMASKK, is clear, the CPU loads the
program counter with the vector address at locations $FFE0 and
$FFE1.
•
Return of all enabled keyboard interrupt pins to logic 1 — As long
as any enabled keyboard interrupt pin is at logic 0, the keyboard
interrupt remains set.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of all enabled keyboard
interrupt pins to logic 1 may occur in any order.
If the MODEK bit is clear, the keyboard interrupt pin is falling-edge-
sensitive only. With MODEK clear, a vector fetch or software clear
immediately clears the keyboard interrupt request.
Reset clears the keyboard interrupt request and the MODEK bit, clearing
the interrupt request even if a keyboard interrupt pin stays at logic 0.
The keyboard flag bit (KEYF) in the keyboard status and control register
can be used to see if a pending interrupt exists. The KEYF bit is not
affected by the keyboard interrupt mask bit (IMASKK) which makes it
useful in applications where polling is preferred.
To determine the logic level on a keyboard interrupt pin, use the data
direction register to configure the pin as an input and read the data
register.
NOTE: Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIEx) forces the corresponding
keyboard interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction
register. However, the data direction register bit must be a logic 0 for
software to read the pin.
Technical Data
346
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Keyboard Interrupt Registers
20.5.1 Ke yboa rd Initia liza tion
When a keyboard interrupt pin is enabled, it takes time for the internal
pull-up to reach a logic 1. Therefore a false interrupt can occur as soon
as the pin is enabled.
To prevent a false interrupt on keyboard initialization:
1. Mask keyboard interrupts by setting the IMASKK bit in the
keyboard status and control register.
2. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the
keyboard interrupt enable register.
3. Write to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register
to clear any false interrupts.
4. Clear the IMASKK bit.
An interrupt signal on an edge-triggered pin can be acknowledged
immediately after enabling the pin. An interrupt signal on an edge- and
level-triggered interrupt pin must be acknowledged after a delay that
depends on the external load.
Another way to avoid a false interrupt:
1. Configure the keyboard pins as outputs by setting the appropriate
DDR bits in data direction register.
2. Write logic 1s to the appropriate data register bits.
3. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the
keyboard interrupt enable register.
20.6 Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Re g iste rs
Two registers control the operation of the keyboard interrupt module:
•
•
Keyboard Status and Control Register — $001A
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register — $001B
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Technical Data
347
Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Mod ule (KBI)
20.6.1 Ke yboa rd Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
•
•
•
•
Flags keyboard interrupt requests
Acknowledges keyboard interrupt requests
Masks keyboard interrupt requests
Controls keyboard interrupt triggering sensitivity
Address: $001A
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
IMASKK MODEK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 20-3. Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR)
KEYF — Keyboard Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set when a keyboard interrupt is pending.
Reset clears the KEYF bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt pending
0 = No keyboard interrupt pending
ACKK — Keyboard Acknowledge Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the keyboard interrupt
request. ACKK always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACKK.
IMASKK — Keyboard Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit prevents the output of the
keyboard interrupt mask from generating interrupt requests. Reset
clears the IMASKK bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests masked
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests not masked
MODEK — Keyboard Triggering Sensitivity Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the keyboard
interrupt pins. Reset clears MODEK.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges only
Technical Data
348
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Low-Power Modes
20.6.2 Ke yboa rd Inte rrup t Ena b le Re g iste r
The port-D keyboard interrupt enable register enables or disables each
port-D pin to operate as a keyboard interrupt pin.
Address: $001B
Bit 7
KBIE7
0
6
KBIE6
0
5
KBIE5
0
4
KBIE4
0
3
KBIE3
0
2
KBIE2
0
1
KBIE1
0
Bit 0
KBIE0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 20-4. Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER)
KBIE7–KBIE0 — Keyboard Interrupt Enable Bits
Each of these read/write bits enables the corresponding keyboard
interrupt pin to latch interrupt requests. Reset clears the keyboard
interrupt enable register.
1 = KBIx pin enabled as keyboard interrupt pin
0 = KBIx pin not enabled as keyboard interrupt pin
20.7 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
20.8 Wa it Mod e
The keyboard interrupt module remains active in wait mode. Clearing the
IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register enables keyboard
interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of wait mode.
20.9 Stop Mod e
The keyboard interrupt module remains active in stop mode. Clearing
the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register enables
keyboard interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of stop mode.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Technical Data
349
Ke yb oa rd Inte rrup t Mod ule (KBI)
20.10 Ke yb oa rd Mod ule During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the keyboard
interrupt latch can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the
SIM break flag control register (BFCR) enables software to clear status
bits during the break state.
To allow software to clear the keyboard interrupt latch during a break
interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the
break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect the latch during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE
bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), writing to the keyboard
acknowledge bit (ACKK) in the keyboard status and control register
during the break state has no effect.
Technical Data
350
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 21. Com p ute r Op e ra ting Prop e rly (COP)
21.1 Conte nts
21.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
21.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
21.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.1 ICLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.2 STOP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.3 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.4 Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
21.4.5 Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.6 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.7 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.4.8 COPRS (COP Rate Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
21.5 COP Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.7 Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
21.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
21.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
21.9 COP Module During Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
21.2 Introd uc tion
The computer operating properly (COP) module contains a free-running
counter that generates a reset if allowed to overflow. The COP module
helps software recover from runaway code. Prevent a COP reset by
clearing the COP counter periodically. The COP module can be disabled
through the COPD bit in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1).
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Technical Data
351
Com p ute r Op e ra ting Prop e rly (COP)
21.3 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Figure 21-1 shows the structure of the COP module.
RESET CIRCUIT
12-BIT COP PRESCALER
ICLK
RESET STATUS REGISTER
STOP INSTRUCTION
INTERNAL RESET SOURCES
RESET VECTOR FETCH
COPCTL WRITE
COP CLOCK
6-BIT COP COUNTER
COPEN (FROM SIM)
COP DISABLE
(COPD FROM CONFIG1)
RESET
CLEAR
COPCTL WRITE
COP COUNTER
COP RATE SEL
(COPRS FROM CONFIG1)
Figure 21-1. COP Block Diagram
The COP counter is a free-running 6-bit counter preceded by a 12-bit
prescaler counter. If not cleared by software, the COP counter overflows
and generates an asynchronous reset after 218 – 24 or 213 – 24 ICLK
cycles, depending on the state of the COP rate select bit, COPRS, in the
CONFIG1 register. With a 213 – 24 ICLK cycle overflow option, a 24-kHz
ICLK gives a COP timeout period of 341ms. Writing any value to location
$FFFF before an overflow occurs prevents a COP reset by clearing the
COP counter and stages 12 through 5 of the prescaler.
NOTE: Service the COP immediately after reset and before entering or after
exiting STOP Mode to guarantee the maximum time before the first COP
counter overflow.
Technical Data
352
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
I/O Signals
A COP reset pulls the RST pin low for 32 ICLK cycles and sets the COP
bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR).
In monitor mode, the COP is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ1 is held
at VTST. During the break state, VTST on the RST pin disables the COP.
NOTE: Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an
interrupt subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP
from generating a reset even while the main program is not working
properly.
21.4 I/ O Sig na ls
The following paragraphs describe the signals shown in Figure 21-1.
21.4.1 ICLK
ICLK is the internal oscillator output signal. ICLK frequency is
approximately equal to 24kHz. See Section 24. Electrical
Specifications for ICLK parameters.
21.4.2 STOP Instruc tion
The STOP instruction clears the COP prescaler.
21.4.3 COPCTL Write
Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 21.5 COP
Control Register) clears the COP counter and clears bits 12 through 5
of the prescaler. Reading the COP control register returns the low byte
of the reset vector.
21.4.4 Powe r-On Re se t
The power-on reset (POR) circuit clears the COP prescaler 4096 ICLK
cycles after power-up.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Technical Data
353
Com p ute r Op e ra ting Prop e rly (COP)
21.4.5 Inte rna l Re se t
An internal reset clears the COP prescaler and the COP counter.
21.4.6 Re se t Ve c tor Fe tc h
A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data
bus. A reset vector fetch clears the COP prescaler.
21.4.7 COPD (COP Disa b le )
The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the
CONFIG1 register. (See Figure 21-2 and Section 5. Configuration
and Mask Option Registers (CONFIG & MOR).)
21.4.8 COPRS (COP Ra te Se le c t)
The COPRS signal reflects the state of the COP rate select bit (COPRS)
in the CONFIG1 register.
Address: $001F
Bit 7
COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3 SSREC
0*
6
5
4
3
2
1
STOP
0
Bit 0
COPD
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
* Reset by POR only.
Figure 21-2. Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1)
COPRS — COP Rate Select
COPRS selects the COP time-out period. Reset clears COPRS.
1 = COP time out period = 213 – 24 ICLK cycles
0 = COP time out period = 218 – 24 ICLK cycles
COPD — COP Disable Bit
COPD disables the COP module.
1 = COP module disabled
0 = COP module enabled
Technical Data
354
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
COP Control Register
21.5 COP Control Re g iste r
The COP control register is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the
reset vector. Writing any value to $FFFF clears the COP counter and
starts a new timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low
byte of the reset vector.
Address: $FFFF
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Low byte of reset vector
Clear COP counter
Unaffected by reset
Figure 21-3. COP Control Register (COPCTL)
21.6 Inte rrup ts
The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests.
21.7 Monitor Mod e
When monitor mode is entered with VTST on the IRQ1 pin, the COP is
disabled as long as VTST remains on the IRQ1 pin or the RST pin. When
monitor mode is entered by having blank reset vectors and not having
V
TST on the IRQ1 pin, the COP is automatically disabled until a POR
occurs.
21.8 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Technical Data
355
Com p ute r Op e ra ting Prop e rly (COP)
21.8.1 Wa it Mod e
The COP remains active during wait mode. To prevent a COP reset
during wait mode, periodically clear the COP counter in a CPU interrupt
routine.
21.8.2 Stop Mod e
Stop mode turns off the ICLK input to the COP and clears the COP
prescaler. Service the COP immediately before entering or after exiting
stop mode to ensure a full COP timeout period after entering or exiting
stop mode.
To prevent inadvertently turning off the COP with a STOP instruction, a
configuration option is available that disables the STOP instruction.
When the STOP bit in the configuration register has the STOP
instruction is disabled, execution of a STOP instruction results in an
illegal opcode reset.
21.9 COP Mod ule During Bre a k Mod e
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on
the RST pin.
Technical Data
356
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP) MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 22. Low-Volta g e Inhib it (LVI)
22.1 Conte nts
22.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
22.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
22.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .358
22.4.1 Polled LVI Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .359
22.4.2 Forced Reset Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.4.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.4.4 LVI Trip Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
22.5 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
22.6 LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
22.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
22.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
22.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
22.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module, which
monitors the voltage on the VDD pin and can force a reset when the VDD
voltage falls below the LVI trip falling voltage, VTRIPF
.
22.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the LVI module include:
•
•
•
Programmable LVI reset
Selectable LVI trip voltage
Programmable stop mode operation
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Technical Data
357
Low-Volta g e Inhib it (LVI)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read: LVIOUT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Low-Voltage Inhibit Status
$FE0F
Register Write:
(LVISR)
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 22-1. LVI I/O Register Summary
22.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
Figure 22-2 shows the structure of the LVI module. The LVI is enabled
out of reset. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference circuit and
comparator. Clearing the LVI power disable bit, LVIPWRD, enables the
LVI to monitor VDD voltage. Clearing the LVI reset disable bit, LVIRSTD,
enables the LVI module to generate a reset when VDD falls below a
voltage, VTRIPF. Setting the LVI enable in stop mode bit, LVISTOP,
enables the LVI to operate in stop mode. Setting the LVI 5V or 3V trip
point bit, LVI5OR3, enables the trip point voltage, VTRIPF, to be
configured for 5V operation. Clearing the LVI5OR3 bit enables the trip
point voltage, VTRIPF, to be configured for 3V operation. The actual trip
points are shown in Section 24. Electrical Specifications.
V
DD
STOP INSTRUCTION
LVISTOP
FROM CONFIG1
FROM CONFIG1
LVIRSTD
LVIPWRD
FROM CONFIG
V
V
> V
≤ V
= 0
= 1
LVI RESET
LOW V
DD
DD
TRIPR
DD
DETECTOR
TRIPF
LVIOUT
LVI5OR3
TO LVISR
FROM CONFIG1
Figure 22-2. LVI Module Block Diagram
Technical Data
358
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Functional Description
NOTE: After a power-on reset (POR) the LVI’s default mode of operation is 3V.
If a 5V system is used, the user must set the LVI5OR3 bit to raise the
trip point to 5V operation. Note that this must be done after every power-
on reset since the default will revert back to 3V mode after each power-
on reset. If the VDD supply is below the 5V mode trip voltage but above
the 3V mode trip voltage when POR is released, the MCU will operate
because VTRIPF defaults to 3V mode after a POR. So, in a 5V system
care must be taken to ensure that VDD is above the 5V mode trip voltage
after POR is released.
NOTE: If the user requires 5V mode and sets the LVI5OR3 bit after a power-on
reset while the VDD supply is not above the VTRIPF for 5V mode, the
MCU will immediately go into reset. The LVI in this case will hold the
MCU in reset until either VDD goes above the rising 5V trip point, VTRIPR
,
which will release reset or VDD decreases to approximately 0V which will
re-trigger the power-on reset and reset the trip point to 3V operation.
LVISTOP, LVIPWRD, LVI5OR3, and LVIRSTD are in the configuration
register 1 (CONFIG1). See Section 5. Configuration and Mask Option
Registers (CONFIG & MOR) for details of the LVI’s configuration bits.
Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises
above a voltage, VTRIPR, which causes the MCU to exit reset. See
9.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset for details of the interaction
between the SIM and the LVI. The output of the comparator controls the
state of the LVIOUT flag in the LVI status register (LVISR).
An LVI reset also drives the RST pin low to provide low-voltage
protection to external peripheral devices.
22.4.1 Polle d LVI Op e ra tion
In applications that can operate at VDD levels below the VTRIPF level,
software can monitor VDD by polling the LVIOUT bit. In the configuration
register 1 (CONFIG1), the LVIPWRD bit must be at logic 0 to enable the
LVI module, and the LVIRSTD bit must be at logic 1 to disable LVI
resets.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Technical Data
359
Low-Volta g e Inhib it (LVI)
22.4.2 Forc e d Re se t Op e ra tion
In applications that require VDD to remain above the VTRIPF level,
enabling LVI resets allows the LVI module to reset the MCU when VDD
falls below the VTRIPF level. In the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1),
the LVIPWRD and LVIRSTD bits must be at logic 0 to enable the LVI
module and to enable LVI resets.
22.4.3 Volta g e Hyste re sis Prote c tion
Once the LVI has triggered (by having VDD fall below VTRIPF), the LVI
will maintain a reset condition until VDD rises above the rising trip point
voltage, VTRIPR. This prevents a condition in which the MCU is
continually entering and exiting reset if VDD is approximately equal to
VTRIPF. VTRIPR is greater than VTRIPF by the hysteresis voltage, VHYS
.
22.4.4 LVI Trip Se le c tion
The LVI5OR3 bit in the CONFIG1 register selects whether the LVI is
configured for 5V or 3V protection.
NOTE: The MCU is guaranteed to operate at a minimum supply voltage. The trip
point (VTRIPF [5 V] or VTRIPF [3 V]) may be lower than this.
(See Section 24. Electrical Specifications for the actual trip point
voltages.)
Technical Data
360
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
LVI Status Register
22.5 LVI Sta tus Re g iste r
The LVI status register (LVISR) indicates if the VDD voltage was
detected below the VTRIPF level.
Address: $FE0F
Bit 7
Read: LVIOUT
Write:
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 22-3. LVI Status Register
LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit
This read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the
V
TRIPF trip voltage (see Table 22-1). Reset clears the LVIOUT bit.
Table 22-1. LVIOUT Bit Indication
VDD
LVIOUT
VDD > VTRIPR
0
VDD < VTRIPF
1
VTRIPF < VDD < VTRIPR
Previous value
22.6 LVI Inte rrup ts
The LVI module does not generate interrupt requests.
22.7 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Technical Data
361
Low-Volta g e Inhib it (LVI)
22.7.1 Wa it Mod e
If enabled, the LVI module remains active in wait mode. If enabled to
generate resets, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU
out of wait mode.
22.7.2 Stop Mod e
If enabled in stop mode (LVISTOP = 1), the LVI module remains active
in stop mode. If enabled to generate resets (LVIRSTD = 0), the LVI
module can generate a reset and bring the MCU out of stop mode.
Technical Data
362
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 23. Bre a k Mod ule (BRK)
23.1 Conte nts
23.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
23.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
23.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
23.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
23.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6.1 Break Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
23.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23.6.3 SIM Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
23.6.4 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
23.2 Introd uc tion
This section describes the break module. The break module can
generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow at a defined
address to enter a background program.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK)
Technical Data
363
Bre a k Mod ule (BRK)
23.3 Fe a ture s
Features of the break module include:
•
•
•
•
Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during the break interrupt
CPU-generated break interrupts
Software-generated break interrupts
COP disabling during break interrupts
23.4 Func tiona l De sc rip tion
When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break
address registers, the break module issues a breakpoint signal to the
CPU. The CPU then loads the instruction register with a software
interrupt instruction (SWI) after completion of the current CPU
instruction. The program counter vectors to $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC
and $FEFD in monitor mode).
The following events can cause a break interrupt to occur:
•
•
A CPU-generated address (the address in the program counter)
matches the contents of the break address registers.
Software writes a logic 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and
control register.
When a CPU-generated address matches the contents of the break
address registers, the break interrupt begins after the CPU completes its
current instruction. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break
routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal
operation. Figure 23-1 shows the structure of the break module.
Technical Data
364
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Functional Description
IAB15–IAB8
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH
8-BIT COMPARATOR
IAB15–IAB0
CONTROL
BREAK
8-BIT COMPARATOR
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW
IAB7–IAB0
Figure 23-1. Break Module Block Diagram
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SBSW
Note
0
Bit 0
Read:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SIM Break Status Register
(SBSR)
$FE00
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BCFE
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SIM Break Flag Control
Register (SBFCR)
$FE03
$FE0C
$FE0D
$FE0E
Bit 15
0
14
13
0
12
0
11
0
10
0
9
0
1
Bit 8
0
Break Address Register
High (BRKH)
0
Bit 7
0
6
5
4
3
2
Bit 0
Break Address Register
Low (BRKL)
0
BRKA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BRKE
0
Break Status and Control
Register (BRKSCR)
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 23-2. Break Module I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK)
Technical Data
365
Bre a k Mod ule (BRK)
23.4.1 Fla g Prote c tion During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables
software to clear status bits during the break state.
23.4.2 CPU During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The CPU starts a break interrupt by:
•
•
Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD
($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode)
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in
progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of
a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
23.4.3 TIM1 a nd TIM2 During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
A break interrupt stops the timer counters.
23.4.4 COP During Bre a k Inte rrup ts
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on
the RST pin.
23.5 Low-Powe r Mod e s
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-
consumption standby modes.
23.5.1 Wa it Mod e
If enabled, the break module is active in wait mode. In the break routine,
the user can subtract one from the return address on the stack if SBSW
is set (see Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM)). Clear the
SBSW bit by writing logic 0 to it.
Technical Data
366
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Break Module Registers
23.5.2 Stop Mod e
A break interrupt causes exit from stop mode and sets the SBSW bit in
the break status register.
23.6 Bre a k Mod ule Re g iste rs
These registers control and monitor operation of the break module:
•
•
•
•
•
Break status and control register (BRKSCR)
Break address register high (BRKH)
Break address register low (BRKL)
SIM break status register (SBSR)
SIM break flag control register (SBFCR)
23.6.1 Bre a k Sta tus a nd Control Re g iste r
The break status and control register (BRKSCR) contains break module
enable and status bits.
Address: $FE0E
Bit 7
BRKE
0
6
BRKA
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 23-3. Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR)
BRKE — Break Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches.
Clear BRKE by writing a logic 0 to bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit.
1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match
0 = Breaks disabled on 16-bit address match
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK)
Technical Data
367
Bre a k Mod ule (BRK)
BRKA — Break Active Bit
This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address
match occurs. Writing a logic 1 to BRKA generates a break interrupt.
Clear BRKA by writing a logic 0 to it before exiting the break routine.
Reset clears the BRKA bit.
1 = (When read) Break address match
0 = (When read) No break address match
23.6.2 Bre a k Ad d re ss Re g iste rs
The break address registers (BRKH and BRKL) contain the high and low
bytes of the desired breakpoint address. Reset clears the break address
registers.
Address: $FE0C
Bit 7
Bit 15
0
6
14
0
5
13
0
4
12
0
3
11
0
2
10
0
1
9
0
Bit 0
Bit 8
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 23-4. Break Address Register High (BRKH)
Address: $FE0D
Bit 7
6
6
0
5
5
0
4
4
0
3
3
0
2
2
0
1
1
0
Bit 0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Bit 7
Write:
Reset:
0
Figure 23-5. Break Address Register Low (BRKL)
23.6.3 SIM Bre a k Sta tus Re g iste r
The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a
break caused an exit from wait mode. The flag is useful in applications
requiring a return to wait mode after exiting from a break interrupt.
Technical Data
368
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Break Module Registers
Address: $FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SBSW
Note
0
Bit 0
R
Read:
R
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
R
=Reserved
Figure 23-6. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
SBSW — Break Wait Bit
This status bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from wait
mode or stop mode. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears
SBSW.
1 = Stop mode or wait mode was exited by break interrupt
0 = Stop mode or wait mode was not exited by break interrupt
SBSW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can
modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. The
following code is an example.
;This code works if the H register has been pushed onto the stack in the break
;service routine software. This code should be executed at the end of the break
;service routine software.
HIBYTE
LOBYTE
EQU
EQU
5
6
;
If not SBSW, do RTI
BRCLR
SBSW,SBSR, RETURN
;See if wait mode or stop mode was exited by
;break.
TST
BNE
DEC
DEC
LOBYTE,SP
DOLO
;If RETURNLO is not zero,
;then just decrement low byte.
;Else deal with high byte, too.
;Point to WAIT/STOP opcode.
;Restore H register.
HIBYTE,SP
LOBYTE,SP
DOLO
RETURN
PULH
RTI
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
369
Bre a k Mod ule (BRK)
23.6.4 SIM Bre a k Fla g Control Re g iste r
The SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables
software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
Address: $FE03
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
R
=Reserved
Figure 23-7. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing
status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits
during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
Technical Data
370
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 24. Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.1 Conte nts
24.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
24.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
24.4 Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24.5 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
24.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
24.7 3.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
24.8 5.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24.9 3.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
24.10 5.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
24.11 3.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
24.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
24.13 3.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
24.14 Analog Module Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.1 Temperature Sensor Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.2 Current Detection Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . .382
24.14.3 Two-Stage Amplifier Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . .382
24.15 Timer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
24.16 MMIIC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
24.17 CGM Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
24.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
371
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.2 Introd uc tion
This section contains electrical and timing specifications.
24.3 Ab solute Ma xim um Ra ting s
Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the MCU can be
exposed without permanently damaging it.
NOTE: This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum
ratings. Refer to 24.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics for
guaranteed operating conditions.
Table 24-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1)
Characteristic
Supply voltage
Symbol
Value
Unit
VDD
–0.3 to +6.0
V
Input voltage
All pins (except IRQ1)
IRQ1 pin
VSS–0.3 to VDD +0.3
VIN
V
VSS–0.3 to 8.5
Maximum current per pin
excluding VDD and VSS
I
±25
mA
Maximum current out of VSS
Maximum current into VDD
IMVSS
IMVDD
TSTG
100
100
mA
mA
°C
Storage temperature
–55 to +150
Notes:
1. Voltages referenced to VSS
.
NOTE: This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due
to high static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal
precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. For proper
operation, it is recommended that VIN and VOUT be constrained to the
range VSS ≤ (VIN or VOUT) ≤ VDD. Reliability of operation is enhanced if
unused inputs are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for
example, either VSS or VDD.)
Technical Data
372
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Functional Operating Range
24.4 Func tiona l Op e ra ting Ra ng e
Table 24-2. Operating Range
Characteristic
Symbol
Value
– 40 to +125
Unit
TA
Operating temperature range
– 40 to +85
°C
—
3V ± 10%
5V ± 10%
VDD
Operating voltage range
V
5V ± 10%
24.5 The rm a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-3. Thermal Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Value
Unit
Thermal resistance
42-pin SDIP
48-pin LQFP
60
80
°C/W
°C/W
θJA
PI/O
I/O pin power dissipation
Power dissipation(1)
User determined
W
W
PD = (IDD × VDD) + PI/O
K/(TJ + 273 °C)
=
PD
PD x (TA + 273 °C)
+ PD2 × θJA
Constant(2)
K
W/°C
°C
TJ
TA + (PD × θJA)
Average junction temperature
Notes:
1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature.
2. K constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and measured PD.
With this value of K, PD and TJ can be determined for any value of TA.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
373
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.6 5.0V DC Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-4. 5V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage (ILOAD = –2.0 mA)
VOH
VDD–0.8
—
—
V
PTA[0:7], PTB[4:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7]
Output low voltage (ILOAD = 1.6mA)
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7]
VOL
—
—
—
0.4
V
LED sink current (VDrain = 4.0V)
PTA[0:5], PTC[3:7]
IOL
–15
—
mA
Input high voltage
VIH
0.7 × VDD
VDD
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7], RST, IRQ1,
IRQ2, OSC1.
—
—
V
V
Input low voltage
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7], RST, IRQ1,
IRQ2, OSC1
VIL
VSS
0.3 × VDD
VDD supply current
Run(3), fOP = 8.0 MHz
—
—
24
18
40
30
mA
mA
with ADC on
with ADC off
Wait(4), fOP = 8.0 MHz
—
7.5
15
mA
Stop(5)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
50
12
9
150
40
30
10
180
50
40
15
200
60
50
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
25°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense, LVI)
25°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense)
25°C (with OSC, TBM)
IDD
1
25°C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
–40°C to 85°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense, LVI)
–40°C to 85°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense)
–40°C to 85°C (with OSC, TBM)
–40°C to 85°C
–40°C to 125°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense, LVI)
–40°C to 125°C (with OSC, TBM, current sense)
–40°C to 125°C (with OSC, TBM)
–40°C to 125°C
25
IIL
Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current
Input current
—
—
—
—
± 10
± 1
µA
µA
IIN
COUT
CIN
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
POR re-arm voltage(6)
VPOR
0
—
100
mV
Technical Data
374
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics
Table 24-4. 5V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
POR rise-time ramp rate(7)
Symbol
Min
0.035
Typ(2)
Max
—
Unit
V/ms
V
RPOR
—
VTST
1.4 × VDD
Monitor mode entry voltage
—
8
Pullup resistors(8)
PTD[0:7] configured as KBI[0:7]
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2
RPU1
RPU2
24
24
35
35
42
42
kΩ
kΩ
VLVII5
VLVII5
VSCMTL
Low-voltage inhibit, trip falling voltage
Low-voltage inhibit, trip rising voltage
3.80
3.95
4.15
4.30
4.45
4.60
V
V
Schmitt trigger input low level trip voltage
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2, KBI[0:7]
—
—
1.21
1.65
—
—
V
V
Schmitt trigger input high level trip voltage
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2, KBI[0:7]
VSCMTH
Notes:
1. VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than
100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects run IDD
.
Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on
all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD
.
5. STOP IDD measured with OSC1 grounded, no port pins sourcing current.
6. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
7. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum
VDD is reached.
8. RPU1 and RPU2 are measured at VDD = 5.0V
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
375
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.7 3.0V DC Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-5. 3V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage (ILOAD = –1.0mA)
PTA[0:7], PTB[4:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7]
VOH
VDD–0.4
—
—
V
Output low voltage (ILOAD = 0.8mA)
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7]
VOL
—
—
—
0.4
V
LED sink current (VDrain = 2.0V)
PTA[0:5], PTC[3:7]
VOL
–5
—
mA
Input high voltage
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7], RST, IRQ1,
IRQ2, OSC1
VIH
0.7 × VDD
VDD
—
—
V
V
Input low voltage
PTA[0:7], PTB[0:6], PTC[0:7], PTD[0:7], RST, IRQ1,
IRQ2, OSC1
VIL
VSS
0.3 × VDD
VDD supply current
Run(3), fOP = 4.0 MHz
with ADC on
with ADC off
Wait(4), fOP = 4.0 MHz
—
—
7
5
16
12
mA
mA
—
2.5
6
mA
Stop(5)
IDD
25°C (with OSC, TBM, LVI)
25°C (with OSC, TBM)
25°C
–40°C to 85°C (with OSC, TBM, LVI)
–40°C to 85°C (with OSC, TBM)
–40°C to 85°C
—
—
—
—
—
—
27
5
0.5
—
—
—
80
12
5
100
15
5
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
µA
IIL
Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current
Input current
—
—
—
—
± 10
± 1
µA
µA
IIN
COUT
CIN
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
POR re-arm voltage(6)
VPOR
RPOR
VHI
0
—
—
—
100
—
mV
V/ms
V
POR rise-time ramp rate(7)
Monitor mode entry voltage
0.035
1.4 × VDD
2.0 × VDD
Pullup resistors(8)
PTD[0:7] configured as KBI[0:7]
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2
RPU1
RPU2
24
24
35
35
42
42
kΩ
kΩ
Technical Data
376
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
5.0V Control Timing
Table 24-5. 3V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Low-voltage inhibit, trip voltage
(No hysteresis implemented for 3V LVI)
VLVI3
2.32
2.49
2.68
V
Schmitt trigger input low level trip voltage
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2, KBI[0:7]
VSCMTL
VSCMTH
—
—
0.8
1.2
—
—
V
V
Schmitt trigger input high level trip voltage
RST, IRQ1, IRQ2, KBI[0:7]
Notes:
1. VDD = 2.7 to 3.3 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than
100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects run IDD
.
Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on
all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD
.
5. STOP IDD measured with OSC1 grounded, no port pins sourcing current.
6. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
7. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum
VDD is reached.
8. RPU1 and RPU2 are measured at VDD = 5.0V.
24.8 5.0V Control Tim ing
Table 24-6. 5V Control Timing
Characteristic(1)
Internal operating frequency(2)
Symbol
Min
—
Max
8.0
—
Unit
MHz
ns
fOP
RST input pulse width low(3)
tIRL
750
Notes:
1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted.
2. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this
information.
3. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset.
24.9 3.0V Control Tim ing
Table 24-7. 3V Control Timing
Characteristic(1)
Internal operating frequency(2)
Symbol
Min
—
Max
4.0
—
Unit
MHz
µs
fOP
RST input pulse width low(3)
tIRL
1.5
Notes:
1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted.
2. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this
information.
3. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
377
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.10 5.0V Osc illa tor Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-8. 5V Oscillator Specifications
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
fICLK
Internal oscillator clock frequency
19.2k
24k
28.8k
Hz
External reference clock to OSC1(1)
Crystal reference frequency(2)
fOSC
dc
—
20M
Hz
Hz
fXCLK
CL
32.768k
—
4.9152M
Crystal load capacitance(3)
Crystal fixed capacitance
Crystal tuning capacitance
Feedback bias resistor
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
C1
2 × CL (25p)
2 × CL (25p)
10M
F
F
C2
RB
Ω
Ω
Series resistor(4)
RS
100k
fRCCLK
REXT
External RC clock frequency
External resistor
2M
—
See Figure 24-1
10
18M
Hz
Ω
CEXT
External capacitor
—
—
pF
Notes:
1. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%.
2. Fundamental mode crystals only.
3. Consult crystal manufacturer’s data.
4. Not Required for high frequency crystals.
5
4
3
2
1
0
MCU
CEXT = 10 pF
5V @ 25
°
C
OSC1
V
DD
REXT
CEXT
fRCCLK = fOP × 4
0
2
4
6
8
10
Resistor REXT (kΩ)
Figure 24-1. RC vs. Bus Frequency (5V @25°C)
Technical Data
378
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
3.0V Oscillator Characteristics
24.11 3.0V Osc illa tor Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-9. 3V Oscillator Specifications
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
fICLK
Internal oscillator clock frequency
13.8k
17.2k
20.6k
Hz
External reference clock to OSC1(1)
Crystal reference frequency(2)
fOSC
dc
—
16M
Hz
Hz
fXCLK
CL
32.768k
—
4.9152M
Crystal load capacitance(3)
Crystal fixed capacitance
Crystal tuning capacitance
Feedback bias resistor
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
C1
2 × CL (25p)
2 × CL (25p)
10M
F
F
C2
RB
Ω
Ω
Series resistor(4)
RS
100k
fRCCLK
REXT
External RC clock frequency
External resistor
2M
—
See Figure 24-2
10
10M
Hz
Ω
CEXT
External capacitor
—
—
pF
Notes:
1. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%.
2. Fundamental mode crystals only.
3. Consult crystal manufacturer’s data.
4. Not Required for high frequency crystals.
3
2.5
2
MCU
CEXT = 10 pF
3V @ 25
°
C
OSC1
1.5
1
V
DD
REXT
CEXT
0.5
0
fRCCLK = fOP × 4
0
5
10
15
20
Resistor REXT (kΩ)
Figure 24-2. RC vs. Bus Frequency (3V @25°C)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
379
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.12 5.0V ADC Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-10. 5V ADC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Notes
V
DDA is an dedicated pin and
should be tied to VDD on the
PCB with proper decoupling.
VDDA
Supply voltage
4.5
5.5
V
VADIN
BAD
VDDA
10
VADIN ≤ VDDA
Input range
Resolution
0
V
10
bits
Includes quantization.
±0.5 LSB = ±1 ADC step.
AAD
Absolute accuracy
—
± 1.5
LSB
fADIC
RAD
tADIC = 1/fADIC
ADC internal clock
Conversion range
500k
2M
Hz
V
VREFL
VREFH
ADC voltage
reference high
VREFH
VREFL
tADC
V
DDA + 0.1
—
V
V
ADC voltage
reference low
VSSA – 0.1
—
17
—
tADIC
cycles
Conversion time
Sample time
16
5
tADIC
cycles
tADS
MAD
ZADI
FADI
Monotonicity
Guaranteed
VADIN = VREFL
ADIN = VREFH
Zero input reading
Full-scale reading
Input capacitance
Input impedance
000
3FD
—
001
3FF
20
HEX
HEX
pF
V
CADI
RADI
IVREF
Not tested.
20M
—
—
Ω
VREFH/VREFL
1.6
mA
Not tested.
Technical Data
380
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
3.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics
24.13 3.0V ADC Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-11. 3V ADC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Notes
V
DDA is an dedicated pin and
should be tied to VDD on the
PCB with proper decoupling.
VDDA
Supply voltage
2.7
3.3
V
VADIN
BAD
VDDA
10
VADIN ≤ VDDA
Input range
Resolution
0
V
10
bits
Includes quantization.
±0.5 LSB = ±1 ADC step.
AAD
Absolute accuracy
—
± 1.5
LSB
fADIC
RAD
tADIC = 1/fADIC
ADC internal clock
Conversion range
500 k
2 M
Hz
V
VREFL
VREFH
ADC voltage
reference high
VREFH
VREFL
tADC
V
DDA + 0.1
—
V
V
ADC voltage
reference low
VSSA – 0.1
—
17
—
tADIC
cycles
Conversion time
Sample time
16
5
tADIC
cycles
tADS
MAD
ZADI
FADI
Monotonicity
Guaranteed
VADIN = VREFL
ADIN = VREFH
Zero input reading
Full-scale reading
Input capacitance
Input impedance
000
3FD
—
001
3FF
20
HEX
HEX
pF
V
CADI
RADI
IVREF
Not tested.
20M
—
—
Ω
Measured at 5V
Not tested.
VREFH/VREFL
1.6
mA
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
381
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.14 Ana log Mod ule Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
24.14.1 Te m p e ra ture Se nsor Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-12. Temperature Sensor Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Temperature range
Temperature slope
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
–20
—
70
°C
V
DD=5V ± 10%, GAINA=2, GAINB=6
DD=3V ± 10%, GAINA=2, GAINB=4
1.275
1.048
1.338
1.089
1.372
1.146
ADC steps/°C
V
24.14.2 Curre nt De te c tion Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-13. Current Detection Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Trip point(1)
VDET
–6
—
+12
mV
Notes:
1. The current detect comparator is designed for VDD=5V ± 10% only.
24.14.3 Two-Sta g e Am p lifie r Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-14. Two-Stage Amplifier Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Amplifier input signal hold time
Amplifier response time
Symbol
Min
Typ
10 + [(GAINA – 1) × 2]
70 + (8×GAINA) + (6×GAINB)
Max
Unit
tAMH
t
AM cycles(1)
tAMR
tAM cycles
Amplifier gain tolerance
VDD=5V ± 10%, GAINA=4, GAINB=16
VIN = 10mV to 30mV
VIN = 30mV to 65mV
–3.5
–1.5
—
—
+3.5
+1.5
VDD=5V ± 10%, GAINA=6, GAINB=16
VIN = 10mV to 30mV
VIN = 30mV to 44mV
–3.5
–1.5
—
—
+3.5
+1.5
%
VDD=3V ± 10%, GAINA=4, GAINB=16
VIN = 10mV to 38mV
VDD=3V ± 10%, GAINA=6, GAINB=16
VIN = 10mV to 24mV
–3.5
–3.5
—
—
+3.5
+3.5
Notes:
1. tAM is the AMCLK.
Technical Data
382
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Timer Interface Module Characteristics
24.15 Tim e r Inte rfa c e Mod ule Cha ra c te ristic s
Characteristic
Symbol
, t
Min
Max
Unit
t
tcyc
Input capture pulse width
1
—
TIH TIL
24.16 MMIIC Ele c tric a l Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-15. MMIIC DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Input low
Symbol
VIL
Min
–0.5
2.1
Typ
Max
0.8
Unit
V
Comments
Data, clock input low.
Data, clock input high.
VIH
Input high
5.5
V
Data, clock output low;
@IPULLUP,MAX
VOL
Output low
Input leakage
0.4
V
ILEAK
± 5
µA
Input leakage current
Current through pull-up
resistor or current source.
See note.(2)
IPULLUP
Pullup current
100
350
µA
Notes:
1. VDD = 2.7 to 5.5Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. The IPULLUP (max) specification is determined primarily by the need to accommodate a maximum of 1.1kΩ equivalent se-
ries resistor of removable SMBus devices, such as the smart battery, while maintaining the VOL (max) of the bus.
SDA
SCL
t
t
t
t
t
t
t
SU.STO
HD.STA
LOW
HIGH
SU.DAT
HD.DAT
SU.STA
Figure 24-3. MMIIC Signal Timings
See Table 24-16 for MMIIC timing parameters.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
383
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
Table 24-16. MMIIC Interface Input/Output Signal Timing
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max Unit
Comments
fSMB
Operating frequency
10
100
kHz MMIIC operating frequency
Bus free time between STOP and
START condition
tBUF
Bus free time
4.7
4.0
4.7
µs
Hold time after (repeated) START
condition. After this period, the
first clock is generated.
tHD.STA
Repeated start hold time.
Repeated start setup time.
µs
µs
Repeated START condition setup
time.
tSU.STA
tSU.STO
tHD.DAT
tSU.DAT
tTIMEOUT
tLOW
Stop setup time
Hold time
4.0
300
250
25
µs Stop condition setup time.
ns Data hold time.
Setup time
ns Data setup time.
Clock low time-out.(1)
ms
Clock low time-out
Clock low
35
4.7
4.0
µs Clock low period
Clock high period.(2)
tHIGH
Clock high
µs
Cumulative clock low extend time
(slave device)(3)
tLOW.SEXT
Slave clock low extend time
25
10
ms
Cumulative clock low extend time
(master device) (4)
tLOW.MEXT
Master clock low extend time
Fall time
ms
Clock/Data Fall Time(5)
ns
tF
300
Clock/Data Rise Time(5)
ns
tR
Rise time
1000
Notes:
1. Devices participating in a transfer will timeout when any clock low exceeds the value of TTIMEOUT min. of 25ms. Devices
that have detected a timeout condition must reset the communication no later than TTIMEOUT max of 35ms. The maximum
value specified must be adhered to by both a master and a slave as it incorporates the cumulative limit for both a master
(10 ms) and a slave (25 ms).
Software should turn-off the MMIIC module to release the SDA and SCL lines.
2. THIGH MAX provides a simple guaranteed method for devices to detect the idle conditions.
3. TLOW.SEXT is the cumulative time a slave device is allowed to extend the clock cycles in one message from the initial start
to the stop. If a slave device exceeds this time, it is expected to release both its clock and data lines and reset itself.
4. TLOW.MEXT is the cumulative time a master device is allowed to extend its clock cycles within each byte of a message as
defined from start-to-ack, ack-to-ack, or ack-to-stop.
5. Rise and fall time is defined as follows: TR = (VILMAX – 0.15) to (VIHMIN + 0.15), TF = 0.9×VDD to (VILMAX – 0.15).
Technical Data
384
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
CGM Electrical Specifications
24.17 CGM Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
Characteristic
Reference frequency
Symbol
Min
30
—
Typ
32.768
38.4
—
Max
100
—
Unit
kHz
kHz
Hz
fRDV
fNOM
fVRS
L
Range nominal multiplies
VCO center-of-range frequency
VCO range linear range multiplier
VCO power-of-two-range multiplier
VCO multiply factor
38.4k
1
40.0M
255
4
—
2E
N
1
—
1
—
4095
8
2P
R
VCO prescale multiplier
Reference divider factor
VCO operating frequency
Manual acquisition time
1
—
1
1
15
fVCLK
38.4k
—
—
40.0M
50
Hz
ms
ms
tLOCK
tLOCK
tLOCK
—
Automatic lock time
—
—
50
Automatic lock time
Wake up from stop with OSC enabled(1)
—
10
15
ms
Hz
fRCLK
0.025% ×
2P N/4
×
PLL jitter(2)
fJ
0
—
Notes:
1. Test condition: VDD = 5.0Vdc / 3.0Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc. Reference frequency = 32.768kHz, locking to 4MHz bus frequency.
2. Deviation of average bus frequency over 2ms. N = VCO multiplier.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications
Technical Data
385
Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
24.18 FLASH Me m ory Cha ra c te ristic s
Table 24-17. FLASH Memory Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic
Data retention voltage
Symbol
Min.
Max.
Unit
V
VRDR
1.3
—
Number of rows per page
Number of bytes per page
2
Rows
Bytes
128
(1)
Read bus clock frequency
Page erase time
32k
1
8M
Hz
ms
fRead
(2)
—
tErase
(3)
Mass erase time
4
10
5
—
—
—
—
—
40
30
30
—
ms
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
ns
ns
µs
tMErase
tnvs
tnvh
tnvhl
tpgs
tProg
tads
tadh
PGM/ERASE to HVEN setup time
High-voltage hold time
High-voltage hold time (mass erase)
Program hold time
100
5
Program time
30
—
—
1
Address/data setup time
Address/data hold time
Recovery time
(4)
trcv
(5)
Cumulative HV period
—
10k
10k
10
25
—
—
—
ms
thv
Row erase endurance(6)
—
—
—
Cycles
Cycles
Years
Row program endurance(7)
Data retention time(8)
Notes:
1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read.
2. If the page erase time is longer than tErase (Min.), there is no erase-disturb, but it reduces the endurance of the FLASH
memory.
3. If the mass erase time is longer than tMErase (Min.), there is no erase-disturb, but is reduces the endurance of the FLASH
memory.
4. It is defined as the time it needs before the FLASH can be read after turning off the high voltage charge pump, by clearing
HVEN to logic 0.
5. thv is the cumulative high voltage programming time to the same row before next erase, and the same address can not be
programmed twice before next erase.
6. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at least this many
erase/program cycles.
7. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at least this many
erase/program cycle.
8. The FLASH is guaranteed to retain data over the entire operating temperature range for at least the minimum time
specified.
Technical Data
386
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 25. Me c ha nic a l Sp e c ific a tions
25.1 Conte nts
25.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
25.3 48-Pin Plastic Low Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
25.4 42-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP). . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
25.2 Introd uc tion
This section gives the dimensions for:
•
•
48-pin plastic low quad flat pack (case 932-02)
42-pin shrink dual in-line package (case 858-01)
The following figure shows the latest package drawing at the time of this
publication. To make sure that you have the latest package
specifications, contact one of the following:
•
•
Local Motorola Sales Office
World Wide Web at http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
Follow the World Wide Web on-line instructions to retrieve the current
mechanical specifications.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Mechanical Specifications
Technical Data
387
Me c ha nic a l Sp e c ific a tions
25.3 48-Pin Pla stic Low Qua d Fla t Pa c k (LQFP)
4X
NOTES:
0.200 AB T–U
Z
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ASME
Y14.5M, 1994.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
3. DATUM PLANE AB IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM OF
LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD
WHERE THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT
THE BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE.
4. DATUMS T, U, AND Z TO BE DETERMINED AT
DATUM PLANE AB.
DETAIL Y
9
A
P
A1
48
37
5. DIMENSIONS S AND V TO BE DETERMINED AT
SEATING PLANE AC.
1
36
6. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS
0.250 PER SIDE. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO
INCLUDE MOLD MISMATCH AND ARE
DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE AB.
7. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION. DAMBAR PROTRUSION SHALL
NOT CAUSE THE D DIMENSION TO EXCEED
0.350.
T
U
B
V
AE
AE
B1
V1
8. MINIMUM SOLDER PLATE THICKNESS SHALL BE
0.0076.
12
25
9. EXACT SHAPE OF EACH CORNER IS OPTIONAL.
MILLIMETERS
13
24
DIM
A
MIN
MAX
Z
7.000 BSC
A1
B
B1
C
D
E
3.500 BSC
7.000 BSC
3.500 BSC
S1
T, U, Z
1.400
1.600
0.270
1.450
0.230
S
0.170
1.350
0.170
DETAIL Y
4X
F
G
0.200 AC T–U
Z
0.500 BSC
H
J
K
L
0.050
0.090
0.500
1°
0.150
0.200
0.700
5°
0.080 AC
M
N
P
R
S
S1
V
V1
W
AA
12° REF
G
AB
AC
0.090
0.150
0.160
0.250 BSC
0.250
9.000 BSC
4.500 BSC
9.000 BSC
4.500 BSC
0.200 REF
1.000 REF
AD
M°
BASE METAL
TOP & BOTTOM
R
N
J
E
C
H
F
D
M
0.080
AC T–U Z
SECTION AE–AE
W
L°
K
DETAIL AD
AA
Figure 25-1. 48-Pin Plastic Low Quad Flat Pack (LQFP)
Technical Data
388
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Mechanical Specifications MOTOROLA
Mechanical Specifications
42-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP)
25.4 42-Pin Shrink Dua l In-Line Pa c ka g e (SDIP)
NOTES:
–A–
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
Y14.5M, 1982.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
3. DIMENSION L TO CENTER OF LEAD WHEN
FORMED PARALLEL.
4. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
FLASH. MAXIMUM MOLD FLASH 0.25 (0.010).
42
1
22
21
–B–
INCHES
MILLIMETERS
DIM
A
B
C
D
F
MIN
MAX
1.465
0.560
0.200
0.022
0.046
MIN
36.45
13.72
3.94
0.36
0.81
MAX
37.21
14.22
5.08
0.56
1.17
L
1.435
0.540
0.155
0.014
0.032
H
C
K
G
H
J
K
L
0.070 BSC
0.300 BSC
1.778 BSC
7.62 BSC
0.008
0.115
0.015
0.135
0.20
2.92
0.38
3.43
–T–
SEATING
PLANE
0.600 BSC
15.24 BSC
N
G
M
N
0°
0.020
15°
0.040
0 °
0.51
15°
1.02
M
F
J 42 PL
D 42 PL
M
S
0.25 (0.010)
T B
M
S
0.25 (0.010)
T A
Figure 25-2. 42-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP)
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Mechanical Specifications
Technical Data
389
Me c ha nic a l Sp e c ific a tions
Technical Data
390
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Mechanical Specifications MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Se c tion 26. Ord e ring Inform a tion
26.1 Conte nts
26.2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
26.3 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
26.2 Introd uc tion
This section contains ordering numbers for the MC68HC908SR12.
26.3 MC Ord e r Num b e rs
Table 26-1. MC Order Numbers
Operating
temperature range
MC order number
Package
MC68HC908SR12CB
MC68HC908SR12MB(2)
MC68HC908SR12CFA
–40 °C to +85 °C
–40 °C to +125 °C
–40 °C to +85 °C
42-Pin SDIP(1)
48-pin LQFP(3)
MC68HC908SR12MFA(2)
–40 °C to +125 °C
Notes:
1. SDIP = Shrink Dual In-Line Package.
2. Temperature grade "M" is available for 5V operating voltage only.
3. LQFP = Low Quad Flat Pack.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MOTOROLA Ordering Information
Technical Data
391
Ord e ring Inform a tion
Technical Data
392
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Ordering Information MOTOROLA
Te c hnic a l Da ta — MC68HC908SR12• MC68HC08SR12
Ap p e nd ix A. MC68HC08SR12
A.1 Conte nts
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
A.7
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Mask Option Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Reserved Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
A.8
A.8.1
Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
A.9
ROM Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
393
MOTOROLA
MC68HC08SR12
MC68HC08SR12
A.2 Introd uc tion
This section introduces the MC68HC08SR12, the ROM part equivalent
to the MC68HC908SR12. The entire data book apply to this ROM
device, with exceptions outlined in this appendix.
Table A-1. Summary of MC68HC08SR12 and MC68HC908SR12 Differences
MC68HC08SR12
12,288 bytes ROM
MC68HC908SR12
12,288 bytes FLASH
38 bytes FLASH
Memory ($C000–$EFFF)
User vectors ($FFDA–$FFFF)
38 bytes ROM
Mask option register; defined
by programming FLASH
location $FF80.
Mask option register; defined
by mask; read only.
$FF80 — MOR
Register at $FF80
$FF80 — MOR
FLASH related registers.
$FE08 — FLCR
$FF09 — FLBPR
Not used;
locations are reserved.
Registers at $FE08 and $FF09
Used for testing purposes
only.
Used for testing and FLASH
programming/erasing.
Monitor ROM ($FE10–$FF7F)
A.3 MCU Bloc k Dia g ra m
Figure A-1 shows the block diagram of the MC68HC08SR12.
A.4 Me m ory Ma p
The MC68HC08SR12 has 12,288 bytes of user ROM from $C000 to
$EFFF, and 38 bytes of user ROM vectors from $FFDA to $FFFF. On
the MC68HC908SR12, these memory locations are FLASH memory.
Figure A-2 shows the memory map of the MC68HC08SR12
Technical Data
394
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MC68HC08SR12
MOTOROLA
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
PTA7/T1CH1
PTA6/T1CH0
CPU
REGISTERS
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT (ALU)
2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE 1
‡
PTA5/ATD7 – PTA0/ATD2
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 96 BYTES
2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE 2
USER ROM — 12,288 BYTES
USER RAM — 512 BYTES
PTB6/IRQ2
TIMEBASE
MODULE
PTB5/T2CH1
PTB4/T2CH0
†
PTB3//SCL1/RxD
MONITOR ROM — 368 BYTES
†
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS
INTERFACE MODULE
PTB2/SDA1/TxD
†
PTB1/SCL0
†
USER ROM VECTORS — 38 BYTES
PTB0/SDA0
MULTI-MASTER IIC (SMBUS)
INTERFACE MODULE
OSCILLATORS AND
CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE
‡ #
PTC7/ATD12
‡ #
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR
PTC6/ATD11
‡
PULSE WIDTH MODULATOR
MODULE
PTC5/ATD10
RC OSCILLATOR
OSC1
‡
PTC4/ATD9
‡
PTC3/ATD8
X-TAL OSCILLATOR
OSC2
PTC2/PWM2
8-BIT KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT MODULE
PHASE-LOCKED LOOP
PTC1/PWM1
CGMXFC
* RST
PTC0/PWM0/CD
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
COMPUTER OPERATING
PROPERLY MODULE
PTD7/KBI7 – PTD0/KBI0 ***
* IRQ1
EXTERNAL IRQ
MODULE
LOW-VOLTAGE
INHIBIT MODULE
** IRQ2
OPIN1/ATD0
OPIN2/ATD1
ANALOG
MODULE
#
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
V
SSAM
V
REFH
10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER MODULE
* Pin contains integrated pullup device.
** Pin contains configurable pullup device.
*** Pin contains integrated pullup device for KBI functions.
† Pin is open-drain when configured as output.
‡ High current drive pin (for LED).
V
REFL
V
DD
V
SS
POWER
V
V
DDA
# Pin not bonded on 42-pin SDIP.
SSA
Shaded blocks indicate differences to MC68HC908SR12
Figure A-1. MC68HC08SR12 Block Diagram
MC68HC08SR12
$0000
↓
$005F
I/O Registers
96 Bytes
$0060
↓
$025F
RAM
512 Bytes
$0260
↓
$BFFF
Unimplemented
48,544 Bytes
$C000
↓
$EFFF
ROM
12,288 Bytes
$F000
↓
$FDFF
Unimplemented
3,584 Bytes
$FE00
$FE01
$FE02
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
$FE07
$FE08
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
$FE0C
$FE0D
$FE0E
$FE0F
SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
Reserved
SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1)
Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2)
Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Break Address Register High (BRKH)
Break Address Register Low (BRKL)
Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR)
LVI Status Register (LVISR)
$FE10
↓
$FF7F
Monitor ROM
368 Bytes
$FF80
Mask Option Register
$FF81
↓
$FFD9
Reserved
89 Bytes
$FFDA
↓
$FFFF
ROM Vectors
38 Bytes
Figure A-2. MC68HC08SR12 Memory Map
Technical Data
396
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MC68HC08SR12 MOTOROLA
MC68HC08SR12
A.5 Ma sk Op tion Re g iste r
The mask option register (MOR) at $FF80 is a read-only register on the
MC68HC08SR12. It is defined by a mask option (hard-wired connection)
specified at the same time as the ROM code submission.
On the MC68HC908SR12, the MOR is a byte located in FLASH
memory, and is written by a FLASH programming routine.
A.6 Re se rve d Re g iste rs
The two registers at $FE08 and $FF09 are reserved locations on the
MC68HC08SR12.
On the MC68HC908SR12, these two locations are the FLASH control
register and the FLASH block protect register respectively.
A.7 Monitor ROM
The monitor program (monitor ROM, $FE10–$FF7F) on the
MC68HC08SR12 is for device testing only.
A.8 Ele c tric a l Sp e c ific a tions
Electrical specifications for the MC68HC908SR12 apply to the
MC68HC08SR12, except for the parameters indicated below.
A.8.1 Me m ory Cha ra c te ristic s
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
VRDR
RAM data retention voltage
Notes:
1.3
—
V
Since MC68HC08SR12 is a ROM device, FLASH memory electrical characteristics do not apply.
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
Technical Data
397
MOTOROLA
MC68HC08SR12
MC68HC08SR12
A.9 ROM Ord e r Num b e rs
These part numbers are generic numbers only. To place an order, ROM
code must be submitted to the ROM Processing Center (RPC).
Table A-2. MC68HC08SR12 Order Numbers
Operating
MC order number
Package
temperature range
–40 °C to +85 °C
–40 °C to +125 °C
–40 °C to +85 °C
–40 °C to +125 °C
MC68HC08SR12CB
MC68HC08SR12MB(2)
MC68HC08SR12CFA
MC68HC08SR12MFA(2)
Notes:
42-Pin SDIP(1)
48-pin LQFP(3)
1. SDIP = Shrink Dual In-Line Package.
2. Temperature grade "M" is available for 5V operating voltage only.
3. LQFP = Low Quad Flat Pack.
Technical Data
398
MC68HC908SR12•MC68HC08SR12 — Rev. 4.0
MC68HC08SR12
MOTOROLA
HOW TO REACH US:
USA/EUROPE/LOCATIONS NOT LISTED:
Motorola Literature Distribution;
P.O. Box 5405, Denver, Colorado 80217
1-303-675-2140 or 1-800-441-2447
JAPAN:
Motorola Japan Ltd.; SPS, Technical Information Center,
3-20-1, Minami-Azabu Minato-ku, Tokyo 106-8573 Japan
81-3-3440-3569
ASIA/PACIFIC:
Motorola Semiconductors H.K. Ltd.;
Silicon Harbour Centre, 2 Dai King Street,
Tai Po Industrial Estate, Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong
852-26668334
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software
implementers to use Motorola products. There are no express or implied copyright
licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or
integrated circuits based on the information in this document.
TECHNICAL INFORMATION CENTER:
1-800-521-6274
HOME PAGE:
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products
herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically
disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental
damages. “Typical” parameters which may be provided in Motorola data sheets
and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual
performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including “Typicals”
must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts.
Motorola does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of
others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as
components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other
applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which
the failure of the Motorola product could create a situation where personal injury or
death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such
unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola
and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless
against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees
arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated
with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Motorola
was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors
Motorola and the Stylized M Logo are registered in the U.S. Patent and Trademark
Office. digital dna is a trademark of Motorola, Inc. All other product or service
names are the property of their respective owners. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal
Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
© Motorola, Inc. 2002
MC68HC908SR12/D
mit Q
Search
Motorola : Semiconductors : Microcontrollers : Products : 8-Bit (M68HC05, M68HC08, M68HC11) : M68HC08 Family : 68HC908SR12
68HC908SR12 : Microcontroller
Page Contents
The MC68HC908SR12 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08 Family of 8-
bit microcontroller units (MCUs). The M68HC08 Family is based on the customer-specific
integrated circuit (CSIC) design strategy. All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08
central processor unit (PU08) and are available with a variety of modules, memory, sizes and
types, and package types.
●
●
●
●
Features
Parametrics
Documentation
Development
Tools/Boards
Design Tools
●
●
Orderable Parts
68HC908SR12 Features
Other Info
●
●
●
FAQs
●
●
●
High-performance M68HC08 architecture
Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 Families
Maximum internal bus frequency:
Literature Services
Acceleration, Pressure,
Alarm IC, and Smoke
IC Sensors
❍
8-MHz at 5V operating voltage
4-MHz at 3V operating voltage
❍
●
●
●
●
●
Automotive
●
Clock inputs options:
Consumer & Industrial
Microcontrollers
Motor Control
❍
RC-oscillator
❍
32kHz crystal-oscillator with 3MHz internal phase-lock-loop
●
●
●
12k-bytes user program FLASH memory with security feature
512 bytes of on-chip RAM
Two 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface modules (TIM1 and TIM2) with selectable input
capture, output compare, and PWM capability on each channel
3rd Party Design Help
[top]
68HC908SR12 Parametrics
Bus Frequency
(Max)
RAM Flash
(Bytes) (KBytes)
Operating Voltage
(Volts)
Timer
I/O
A/D
PWM
Serial Availability
IIC, SCI Production
[top]
(MHz)
Dual 2-CH, 16-
Bit, IC, OC or Up to 31
PWM
14-CH 10-
Bit
512
12
See Timer
3.3, 5.0
8.0
68HC908SR12 Documentation
Application Note
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
Designing for Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
with HCMOS Microcontrollers
AN1050/D
pdf
82
0
1/01/2000
AN1218/D
AN1219/D
AN1219SW
HC05 to HC08 Optimization
pdf
pdf
zip
347
177
77
2
1
0
1/01/1993
1/01/1997
1/01/1995
M68HC08 Integer Math Routines
Software Files for AN1219 zipped
-
-
-
Hamming Error Control Coding Techniques with the
HC08 MCU
AN1221/D
AN1221SW
AN1222/D
AN1222SW
AN1259/D
pdf
zip
pdf
zip
pdf
63
55
24
20
78
0
0
0
0
0
1/01/1993
1/01/1995
1/01/1993
1/01/1995
1/01/1995
Software Files for AN1221 zipped
Arithmetic Waveform Synthesis with the HC05/08
MCUs
Software Files for AN1222 zipped
System Design and Layout Techniques for Noise
Reduction in MCU-Based Systems
Designing for Electromagnetic Compatibility with
Single-Chip Microcontrollers
AN1263/D
AN1274/D
AN1705/D
pdf
pdf
pdf
104
47
0
0
0
1/01/1995
1/01/1996
1/01/1999
HC08 SCI Operation with Various Input Clocks
Noise Reduction Techniques for Microcontroller-
Based Systems
67
Resetting Microcontrollers During Power
Transitions
AN1744/D
AN1752/D
AN1771/D
pdf
pdf
pdf
80
0
1
0
1/01/1998
5/07/2001
1/01/1998
Data Structures for 8-Bit Microcontrollers
213
250
Precision Sine-Wave Tone Synthesis Using 8-Bit
MCUs
AN1775/D
AN1783/D
Expanding Digital Input with an A/D Converter
Determining MCU Oscillator Start-Up Parameters
pdf
pdf
86
48
1
1
1/01/1998
1/01/1999
Software SCI Routines with the 16-Bit Timer
Module
AN1818/D
pdf
84
0
1/01/1999
AN1820/D
AN1820SW
AN1837/D
AN1843/D
Software I2C Communications
pdf
zip
pdf
pdf
55
2
0
0
0
0
1/01/1999
1/01/1998
3/27/2000
9/13/2000
Software files for AN1820 zipped
Non-Volatile Memory Technology Overview
Vacuum Cleaner Reference Platform
-
116
326
Embedding Microcontrollers in Domestic
Refrigeration Appliances
AN1853/D
pdf
221
0
6/22/2000
AN2093/D
AN2103/D
Creating Efficient C Code for the MC68HC08
Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Demonstration
Connecting an M68HC08 Family Microcontroller to
pdf
pdf
36
0
0
1/01/2000
953
12/01/2000
AN2120/D
an Internet Service Provider (ISP) Using the Point-to- pdf
Point Protocol (PPP)
741
0
5/20/2001
AN2120SW
AN2149/D
Software for AN2120, zip format
zip
31
1.0
0
7/31/2002
5/30/2001
-
Compressor Induction Motor Stall and Rotation
Detection using Microcontrollers
pdf
127
Digital Direct Current Ignition System Using HC08
Microcontrollers
AN2159/D
pdf
129
0
11/20/2001
AN2159SW
AN2295/D
AN2295SW
AN2159SW
zip
pdf
zip
182
324
210
1
1
1
3/08/2002
10/04/2002
10/07/2002
-
-
Developer's Serial Bootloader for M68HC08
Software for AN2295
Designing for Board Level Electromagnetic
Compatibility
AN2321/D
AN2342/D
pdf 1628
pdf 156
0
0
8/15/2002
9/25/2002
Opto Isolation Circuits For In Circuit Debugging of
68HC9(S)12 and 68HC908 Microcontrollers
Brochure
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
8-16 Bit Microcontrollers Product
Portfolio
8-16BITPAK/D
BR1822
html
pdf
1
0
-
10/15/2002
-
Embedded Flash MCU Overview
174
65
-
-
68HC08 Family: High Performance
and Flexibility
BR68HC08FAMAM/D
pdf
1
4/04/2002
CodeWarrior™ Development Studio
for 68HC08, Special Edition Brochure
CWDEVSTUDFACT
pdf
pdf
49
0
1
4/22/2002
4/03/2002
Embedded Flash: Changing the
Technology World for the Better
FLYREMBEDFLASH/D
621
Data Sheets
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
pdf 4534 2/08/2002
68HC908SR12, 68HC08SR12 Technical
Data
MC68HC908SR12/D
4
Engineering Bulletin
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
In-Circuit Programming of FLASH Memory Using the
Monitor Mode for the MC68HC908SR12
EB311/D
pdf
pdf
pdf
164
45
0
1
1
0
0
0
6/25/2001
6/22/2000
4/15/2002
5/09/2002
6/19/2002
8/13/2002
RAM Data Retention Considerations for Motorola
Microcontrollers
EB349/D
EB389/D
EB390/D
EB396/D
EB398/D
TOF Consideration when Measuring a Long Input
Capture Event
55
Porting the AN2120/D UDP/IP Code to the Avnet
Evaluation Board
pdf 1501
Use of OSC2/XTAL as a Clock Output on Motorola
Microcontrollers
pdf
pdf
49
87
Techniques to Protect MCU Applications Against
Malfunction Due to Code Run-Away
Interrupt Handling Considerations When Modifying
EEPROM on HC08 Microcontrollers
EB608/D
pdf
96
0
8/14/2002
Miscellaneous
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified
pdf 58 4/03/2002
Order Availability
68HC908SR12PB/D
8-bit Microcontroller
1
Product Change Notices
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
PCN7701
PCN7703
PCN7776
QFP 10X10 ASSY MOVE FROM SHC TO BAT3
LQFP 7X7 ASSY MOVE FROM SHC TO BAT3
ADDITIONAL 7X7 LQFP CAPACITY
htm
htm
htm
16
14
9
-
-
7/09/2002
7/01/2002
7/29/2002
-
-
-
O
Reference Manual
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
ADCRM/AD
Analog-to-Digital Reference Manual
pdf
pdf 2666
pdf 463
231
0
3
1
1/01/1996
4/03/2002
2/23/2000
CPU08RM Central Processor Unit Reference
Manual
CPU08RM/AD
DMA08RM/D
Direct Memory Access Reference Manual
-
Passive Infrared (PIR) Intruder Detection Using
the MC68HC908JK1/3, Incorporating Remote
Control Adjustment Using the
DRM001/D
pdf 2504
0
2/20/2001
MC68HC908GP32
USB08 Universal Serial Bus Evaluation Board
DRM002/D
Using the MC68HC908JB8 Designer Reference pdf 1845
Manual
0
2
4/12/2001
M68HC08RG/D
TIM08RM/AD
HC08 Family Reference Guide
pdf
142
4/08/2002
1/10/1996
-
TIM08 Timer Interface Module Reference
Manual
pdf
771 1.0
Selector Guide
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
SG1006/D
SG1011/D
Microcontrollers SPS Sales Guide
pdf
pdf
600
259
0
1
9/26/2002
9/26/2002
Software and Development Tools Sales Guide
Application Selector Guide Index and Cross-
Reference.
SG2000CR/D
pdf
62
0
6/24/2002
Application Summary - Home Appliances -
Dishwashers. Microcontrollers enable the
electronic control which is used to provide a range
of dishwasher appliance features.
SG2037/D
pdf
77
0
6/24/2002
Application Summary - Home Appliances. Dryers.
New dryer features make this application more
energy efficient and better able to meet consumer
demands for improved control.
SG2044/D
pdf
90
0
6/24/2002
Users Guide
ID
Name
Format Size K Rev # Date Last Modified Order Availability
CodeWarrior™ Development Studio for
68HC08 Quick Start Guide
CDSWHC08QS
pdf 2847 2.1
pdf 1368
9/20/2002
1/01/1996
-
-
M68EML08SR12 Evaluation Module
Users Manual
M68EML08SR12UM/D
2
[top]
68HC908SR12 Development Tools/Boards
ID
Name
Vendor ID
METROWERKS
METROWERKS
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
METROWERKS
Order Availability
M68MULTILINK08
M68CYCLONE08
M68EML08SR12
KITMMDS08SR12
KITMMEVS08SR12
M68ICS08SR
MON08 Multilink
MON08 Cyclone
Emulation Module
Modular Development System (MMDS) Kits
Modular Evaluation System (MMEVS)
M68ICS08SR Development Tool Kit
CDCWSEHC08
CodeWarrior Development Studio for 68HC08 Special Edition
-
CodeWarrior Development Studio for Motorola HC08
Microcontrollers Professional Edition
CWHC08PRO
CWHC08STD
METROWERKS
METROWERKS
CodeWarrior Development Studio for Motorola HC08
Microcontrollers Standard Edition
[top]
Design Tools
Software
ID
Name
Vendor ID
AISYS
Format
exe
Size K
19653
Rev #
2.3
HC08DRIVEWAYSW
Aisys Driveway for 68HC08
Software/Application Software/Code Examples
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format Size K Rev #
HC08 Software Example: Subroutine that delays for a whole number
of milliseconds
HC08DELAYSW
MOTOROLA zip
MOTOROLA zip
2
-
-
HC08 Software Example: Library containing software examples in
assembly for 68HC08
HC08EXSW
14
[top]
Orderable Parts Information
Budgetary
Price
QTY 1000+
($US)
Package
Order
Availability
Life Cycle Description (code)
PartNumber
Info
Remarks
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP-
UP(1)
KMC908SR12CB
KMC908SR12MB
KXC908SR12CB
-40 to +85 C
$4.00
$4.40
-
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
-40 to +125
C
-
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
REMOVED FROM ACTIVE
PORTFOLIO(8)
-40 to +85 C
-
-
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
-40 to +125
C
KXC908SR12MB
MC68HC908SR12CB
MC68HC908SR12MB
KMC908SR12CFA
KMC908SR12MFA
KXC908SR12CFA
KXC908SR12MFA
PRODUCT RAPID GROWTH(2)
-
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP-
UP(1)
-40 to +85 C
$3.51
$4.40
$4.00
$4.40
-
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
-40 to +125
C
7x7 mm
Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP-
UP(1)
-40 to +85 C
7x7 mm
Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
-40 to +125
C
7x7 mm
Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
REMOVED FROM ACTIVE
PORTFOLIO(8)
-40 to +85 C
-
-
7x7 mm
Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP--40 to +125
UP(1)
-
C
7x7 mm
MC68HC908SR12CFA Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP-
UP(1)
-40 to +85 C
$4.00
7x7 mm
MC68HC908SR12MFA Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
-40 to +125
C
$4.40
Shrink DIP
(70 mil
spacing)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP--40 to +125
XC68HC908SR12MB
-
-
UP(1)
C
7x7 mm
REMOVED FROM ACTIVE
PORTFOLIO(8)
-40 to +125
C
XC68HC908SR12MFA Quad Flat
Pack (QFP)
PRODUCT NEWLY INTRO'D/RAMP-
UP(1)
MC68HC9SR12CFAR2
MC68HC9SR12MFAR2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
[top]
Motorola Home | Semiconductors | Login | Support | Contact Us | Site Map
Products | Documentation | Tools | Design Resources | Applications
Search
Advanced | Parametric | Part Number | FAQ
Select Country
Motorola Home | Semiconductors Home | Contact Us
Products | Design Support | Register | Login
Semiconductors
Motorola > Semiconductors >
68HC908SR12 : Microcontroller
Page Contents:
The MC68HC908SR12 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08 Family of 8-bit
microcontroller units (MCUs). The M68HC08 Family is based on the customer-specific integrated circuit
(CSIC) design strategy. All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08 central processor unit (PU08)
and are available with a variety of modules, memory, sizes and types, and package types.
Features
Documentation
Tools
Applications
Rich Media
Block Diagram
Orderable Parts
Related Links
68HC908SR12 Features
Other Info:
●
●
●
High-performance M68HC08 architecture
Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 Families
Maximum internal bus frequency:
FAQs
3rd Party Design Help
Training
❍
8-MHz at 5V operating voltage
4-MHz at 3V operating voltage
❍
3rd Party Tool
Vendors
●
Clock inputs options:
❍
RC-oscillator
❍
32kHz crystal-oscillator with 3MHz internal phase-lock-loop
Rate this Page
●
●
●
12k-bytes user program FLASH memory with security feature
512 bytes of on-chip RAM
Two 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface modules (TIM1 and TIM2) with selectable input capture,
output compare, and PWM capability on each channel
--
-
0
+
++
Submit
Care to Comment?
Return to Top
68HC908SR12 Documentation
Documentation
Application Note
Size Rev Date Last
Order
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
Designing for Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) with
HCMOS Microcontrollers
MOTOROLA
pdf
AN1050_D
AN1218/D
AN1219/D
AN1219SW
AN1221/D
AN1221SW
AN1222/D
82
0
1/01/2000
1/01/1993
1/01/1997
1/01/1995
1/01/1993
1/01/1995
1/01/1993
-
MOTOROLA
pdf
HC05 to HC08 Optimization
347
177
77
2
1
0
0
0
0
MOTOROLA
pdf
M68HC08 Integer Math Routines
Software Files for AN1219 zipped
MOTOROLA
zip
-
-
Hamming Error Control Coding Techniques with the HC08 MOTOROLA
MCU
pdf
zip
pdf
63
MOTOROLA
Software Files for AN1221 zipped
55
MOTOROLA
Arithmetic Waveform Synthesis with the HC05/08 MCUs
24
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
AN1222SW
AN1259/D
AN1263/D
AN1274/D
AN1516/D
AN1705/D
AN1744/D
AN1752/D
AN1771/D
AN1775/D
AN1783/D
AN1818/D
AN1820/D
AN1820SW
AN1837/D
AN1853/D
AN2093/D
AN2103/D
Software Files for AN1222 zipped
zip
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
zip
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
20
78
0
0
0
0
2
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1/01/1995
1/01/1995
1/01/1995
1/01/1996
1/24/2003
1/01/1999
1/01/1998
5/07/2001
1/01/1998
1/01/1998
1/01/1999
1/01/1999
1/01/1999
1/01/1998
3/27/2000
6/22/2000
-
System Design and Layout Techniques for Noise
Reduction in MCU-Based Systems
Designing for Electromagnetic Compatibility with Single-
Chip Microcontrollers
104
47
HC08 SCI Operation with Various Input Clocks
Liquid Level Control Using a Motorola Pressure Sensor
77
Noise Reduction Techniques for Microcontroller-Based
Systems
67
Resetting Microcontrollers During Power Transitions
Data Structures for 8-Bit Microcontrollers
Precision Sine-Wave Tone Synthesis Using 8-Bit MCUs
Expanding Digital Input with an A/D Converter
Determining MCU Oscillator Start-Up Parameters
Software SCI Routines with the 16-Bit Timer Module
Software I2C Communications
80
213
250
86
48
84
55
Software files for AN1820 zipped
2
-
Non-Volatile Memory Technology Overview
116
221
36
Embedding Microcontrollers in Domestic Refrigeration
Appliances
Creating Efficient C Code for the MC68HC08
Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Demonstration
1/01/2000
12/01/2000
953
Connecting an M68HC08 Family Microcontroller to an
Internet Service Provider (ISP) Using the Point-to-Point
Protocol (PPP)
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
AN2120/D
pdf
741
0
5/20/2001
AN2120SW
AN2149/D
AN2159/D
AN2159SW
AN2295
Software for AN2120, zip format
zip
pdf
pdf
zip
pdf
zip
pdf
pdf
pdf
31 1.0 7/31/2002
-
Compressor Induction Motor Stall and Rotation Detection MOTOROLA
using Microcontrollers
127
129
182
738
0
0
1
4
5/30/2001
Digital Direct Current Ignition System Using HC08
Microcontrollers
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
11/20/2001
AN2159SW
3/08/2002
-
-
10/29/2003
Developer's Serial Bootloader for M68HC08
Software for AN2295
10/21/2003
AN2295SW
AN2321/D
AN2342
725 4.0
1628
0
Designing for Board Level Electromagnetic Compatibility
8/15/2002
9/25/2002
2/21/2003
Opto Isolation Circuits For In Circuit Debugging of
68HC9(S)12 and 68HC908 Microcontrollers
155
297
0
0
AN2438/D
ADC Definitions and Specifications
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
10/15/2003
10/21/2003
AN2504
On-Chip FLASH Programming API for CodeWarrior
Software files for application note AN2504
pdf
zip
pdf
530
59
0
0
1
AN2504SW
AN2571
-
Converting Demos in Standard Software Drivers for HC908 MOTOROLA
Derivatives
430
9/11/2003
Brochure
ID
Size Rev Date Last
Order
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
MOTOROLA
pdf
174
BR1822
Embedded Flash MCU Overview
68HC08 Family: High Performance and Flexibility
-
-
MOTOROLA
pdf
5/21/2003
BR68HC08FAMAM/D
FLYREMBEDFLASH/D
57
68
2
2
Embedded Flash: Changing the Technology World for MOTOROLA
the Better
5/21/2003
pdf
Data Sheets
ID
Size Rev Date Last
Order
Availability
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified
4534
MC68HC908SR12/D
68HC908SR12, 68HC08SR12 Technical Data MOTOROLA
pdf
4
2/08/2002
Engineering Bulletin
Size Rev Date Last
Order
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
In-Circuit Programming of FLASH Memory Using the
Monitor Mode for the MC68HC908SR12
MOTOROLA
pdf
6/25/2001
EB311/D
EB349/D
EB389/D
EB390/D
EB396/D
EB398
164
0
RAM Data Retention Considerations for Motorola
Microcontrollers
MOTOROLA
pdf
6/22/2000
4/15/2002
5/09/2002
6/19/2002
8/13/2002
8/14/2002
45
1
1
0
0
0
0
TOF Consideration when Measuring a Long Input Capture MOTOROLA
Event
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
55
Porting the AN2120/D UDP/IP Code to the Avnet
Evaluation Board
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
1501
Use of OSC2/XTAL as a Clock Output on Motorola
Microcontrollers
49
0
Techniques to Protect MCU Applications Against
Malfunction Due to Code Run-Away
Interrupt Handling Considerations When Modifying
EEPROM on HC08 Microcontrollers
EB608/D
96
Fact Sheets
ID
Date Last
Modified
Name
Vendor ID
Format Size K Rev #
Order Availability
68HC908SR12PB/D
8-bit Microcontroller
Development Studio
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
pdf
pdf
58
48
1
2
4/03/2002
5/13/2002
CWDEVSTUDFACTHC08
-
Product Change Notices
Size Rev Date Last
Order
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
16
14
9
#
Modified Availability
PCN7701
PCN7703
PCN7776
PCN8382
PCN8397
PCN8698
PCN8901
QFP 10X10 ASSY MOVE FROM SHC TO BAT3
LQFP 7X7 ASSY MOVE FROM SHC TO BAT3
ADDITIONAL 7X7 LQFP CAPACITY
MOTOROLA htm
MOTOROLA htm
MOTOROLA htm
MOTOROLA htm
MOTOROLA htm
-
7/09/2002
7/01/2002
7/29/2002
12/19/2002
12/20/2002
3/31/2003
5/21/2003
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
0
0
0
0
FINAL MFG CONTRACT TEST QUALIFICATION
NEW MASKSET L06H OF 908SR12 IN TSC6
CARBON FIBER ITW QFP TRAY CONVERSION
5
4
MOTOROLA htm 100
BINDING STRAP CHANGE FOR QFP PRODUCTS MOTOROLA htm
5
Reference Manual
ID
Size Rev Date Last
Order
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
MOTOROLA
pdf
1/01/1996
ADCRM/AD
Analog-to-Digital Reference Manual
CPU08RM Central Processor Unit Reference Manual
231
2666
0
MOTOROLA
pdf
4/03/2002
2/20/2001
CPU08RM/AD
3
0
0
Passive Infrared (PIR) Intruder Detection Using the
MC68HC908JK1/3, Incorporating Remote Control
Adjustment Using the MC68HC908GP32
MOTOROLA
pdf
2504
1845
DRM001/D
USB08 Universal Serial Bus Evaluation Board Using the
MC68HC908JB8 Designer Reference Manual
MOTOROLA
pdf
4/12/2001
1/10/1996
DRM002/D
MOTOROLA
pdf
TIM08RM/AD
TIM08 Timer Interface Module Reference Manual
771 1.0
Selector Guide
ID
Size Rev Date Last
Order
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
MOTOROLA
pdf
579
10/24/2003
SG1002
SG1006
SG1010
SG1011
SG2000CR
SG2037
SG2039
Analog Selector Guide - Quarter 4, 2003
Microcontrollers Selector Guide - Quarter 4, 2003
Sensors Selector Guide - Quarter 4, 2003
0
MOTOROLA
pdf
826
219
287
10/24/2003
10/24/2003
10/24/2003
11/11/2003
0
0
0
3
2
0
MOTOROLA
pdf
Software and Development Tools Selector Guide - Quarter MOTOROLA
4, 2003
pdf
pdf
pdf
pdf
MOTOROLA
Application Selector Guide Index and Cross-Reference.
95
0
Application Selector Guide - Home Appliances
DISHWASHERS
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
6/17/2003
6/17/2003
Application Selector Guide - Vacuum Cleaners Vacuum
Cleaners
0
Application Summary - Home Appliances. Dryers. New
dryer features make this application more energy efficient MOTOROLA
and better able to meet consumer demands for improved
control.
12/16/2002
SG2044
pdf
0
1
Users Guide
ID
Size Rev Date Last
Order
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
Modified Availability
CodeWarrior™ Development Studio for 68HC08 Quick MOTOROLA
Start Guide
2847
9/20/2002
-
CDSWHC08QS
pdf
pdf
2.1
M68EML08SR12UM/D
MOTOROLA
1368
1/01/1996
-
M68EML08SR12 Evaluation Module Users Manual
2
Return to Top
68HC908SR12 Tools
Hardware Tools
Emulators/Probes/Wigglers
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
IC10000
IC20000
IC40000
ISYS
ISYS
ISYS
iC1000 PowerEmulator
iC2000 PowerEmulator
iC4000 ActiveEmulator
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
In-Circuit, Real-Time Debugger/Programmer for Motorola 68HC08
Family (USB)
INDART-HC08/D
SOFTEC
-
-
-
-
Evaluation/Development Boards and Systems
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID
Format Size K Rev #
KITMMDS08SR12
KITMMEVS08SR12
M68CBL05B
Modular Development System (MMDS) Kits
Modular Evaluation System (MMEVS)
Low-noise Flex Cable
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
MOTOROLA
METROWERKS
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
M68CBL05C
Low-noise Flex Cable
M68EML08SR12
M68ICS08SR
Emulation Module
M68ICS08SR Development Tool Kit
MON08 Cyclone
M68CYCLONE08
M68MULTILINK08
METROWERKS
OZTECH
MON08 Multilink
-
-
-
-
-
-
OZTEC-08 STARTER KIT
OZTEC-08 Starter Kit
-
Programmers
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format Size K Rev # Order Availability
MP8011A
POWERLAB
T9600
SOFTEC
SYSGEN
SYSGEN
Gang Programmer Base Unit
Universal Programmer
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
High-speed universal gang programmer
Software
Application Software
Code Examples
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
HC08 Software Example: Subroutine that delays for a whole
number of milliseconds
MOTOROLA
zip
HC08DELAYSW
HC08EXSW
2
-
-
HC08 Software Example: Library containing software
examples in assembly for 68HC08
MOTOROLA
zip
14
-
-
Device Drivers
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
HC908 SGF NVM Standard Software Drivers
Program/erase software driver for 0.5um SGF NVM (flash and
EEPROM) in HC908
HC908SGF50NVMSSD
MOTOROLA
1387 3.0.0
zip
-
Operating Systems
ID
Name
Vendor ID
Format
Size K
Rev #
Order Availability
CMX-TINY+
CMX
CMX-Tiny+
-
-
-
-
Software Tools
Assemblers
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
ADX-08 Macro Assembler-Linker and IDE
Vendor ID Format
K
#
ADX-08
AVOCET
COSMIC
-
-
-
-
-
AX6808 relocatable and absolute macro assembler for HC08 and
HCS08
AX6808
-
-
-
Compilers
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format Size K Rev # Order Availability
CX6808S
COSMIC
IMAGE
CX6808 C Cross Compiler for HC08 and HCS08
ICC08 V6 STD
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ICC08
Debuggers
ID
Size Rev
Order
Availability
Name
ZAP 6808 MON08 Debugger and Flash Programmer
Vendor ID Format
K
#
ZAP 6808 MON08 debugger uses the 68HC08’s on-chip monitor
interface to provide a real-time ANSI C and assembly source level
debugger including FLASH programming, FLASH security and
hardware breakpoint support.
ZAP 6808 MON08
MOTOROLA
-
-
-
-
ZAP 6808 MMDS
COSMIC
ZAP 6808 MMDS Debugger
-
-
-
-
ZAP 6808 SIM
NOICE08
COSMIC
IMAGE
ZAP 6808 Simulator Debugger
NoICE08
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
IDE (Integrated Development Environment)
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID
Format
K
#
CDCWSEHC08
CWHC08PRO
METROWERKS
METROWERKS
CodeWarrior Development Studio™ for HC(S)08 Special Edition
-
-
-
-
-
CodeWarrior Development Studio for Motorola HC08
Microcontrollers Professional Edition
-
-
CodeWarrior Development Studio for Motorola HC08
Microcontrollers Standard Edition
CWHC08STD
CX6808LT4
IDEA08
METROWERKS
COSMIC
COSMIC
ISYS
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
HC08 Development Tool Suite 4K Lite (FREE)
-
-
-
IDEA08 integrated development environment for HC08 and HCS08
IC-SW-OPR
winIDEA
Return to Top
Applications
Consumer Electronics
Home Appliances
Dryers
Refrigerators and Freezers
Vacuum Cleaners
Return to Top
Rich Media
Rich Media
Webcast
Size Rev
Order
Availability
ID
Name
Vendor ID Format
K
#
CodeWarrior Development Tools for 68HC08 and HCS12
Microcontrollers.
Listen to our webcast for an overview of some of the challenges
that developers face and an explanation of the CodeWarrior
tools that help to address these challenges.
RMWC_CODEWARRIOR
MOTOROLA
html
4
0.0
-
-
8-bit Microcontroller Overview and Q-Family of Flash
Microcontrollers
Listen to our companion webcasts to learn about Motorola's
recent 8-bit products and services-especially the HC08 Q-
Family-that offer maximum design flexibility while helping you
get to market fast.
MOTOROLA
htm
RMWC_QFAMILY
5
1.1
Return to Top
Orderable Parts Information
Budgetary
Tape
Package Info and
Reel
Price
QTY 1000+
($US)
Additional
Info
Order
Availability
Life Cycle Description (code)
PartNumber
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
PSDIP 42
more
more
more
more
more
more
more
more
KMC908SR12CB
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
$4.00
$4.00
$4.40
$4.40
$4.00
$4.00
$4.40
$4.40
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
KMC908SR12CFA
KMC908SR12MB
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
PSDIP 42
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
KMC908SR12MFA
MC68HC908SR12CB
MC68HC908SR12CFA
MC68HC908SR12MB
MC68HC908SR12MFA
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
PSDIP 42
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
PSDIP 42
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
more
more
MC68HC9SR12CFAR2
MC68HC9SR12MFAR2
Yes
Yes
-
-
-
-
LQFP 48
7*7*1.4P0.5
PRODUCT STABLE
GROWTH/MATURITY(3)
NOTE: Are you looking for an obsolete orderable part? Click HERE to check our distributors' inventory.
Return to Top
Related Links
Microcontrollers
Motor Control
Sensors
Return to Top
http://www.motorola.com/ | Site Map | Contact Motorola | Terms of Use | Privacy Practices
© Copyright 1994-2003 Motorola, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
相关型号:
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明